Maintenance Fanuc 16
Maintenance Fanuc 16
GE Fanuc CNC
Series 16/160/18/180-Model B
Maintenance Manual
www.cnccenter.com
GE Fanuc Automation
Computer Numerical Control Products
Maintenance Manual
GFZ-62445E/03
January 1995
PREFACE
B62445E/03
PREFACE
Description of
this manual
PREFACE
B62445E/03
This manual can be used with the following models. The abbreviated
names may be used.
Applicable models
Pruduct name
Abbreviation
16TB
160TB
16MB
160MB
18TB
180TB
18MB
T series or
T series (twopath
control)*1
M series or M series (twopath
control)*1
om
T series or
T series (twopath
control)*1
r.c
M series
180MB
ce
nt
e
Note
Some function described in this manual may not be applied
to some products.
For details, refer to the DESCRIPTIONS manual
(B62442E)
Related manuals
.c
nc
The table below lists manuals related to MODEL B of Series 16, Series
18, Series 160 and Series 180.
In the table, this manual is marked with an asterisk(*).
Specification
number
DESCRIPTIONS
B62442E
B62443E
B62443E1
B62444E
B62454E
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
B62445E
PARAMETER MANUAL
B62450E
B61803E1
B66102E
B62444E1
B62154E
B62153E
PREFACE
B62445E/03
Specification
number
CONVERSATIONAL AUTOMATIC PROGRAMMING FUNCTION I FOR LATHE (Series 18TB) OPERATORS MANUAL
B61804E1
om
Document name
Major contents
B65142E
r.c
D Specification
D Characteristics
D External dimensions
ce
nt
e
D Connections
D Specification
B65152E
Major usage
D Selection of motor
D Connection of motor
D Characteristics
D External dimensions
D Connections
D Specifications and
functions
nc
.c
D Installation
D Selection of
amplifier
D Connection of
amplifier
D Connections
D Start up the system
(Hardware)
D Troubleshooting
D Troubleshooting
D Maintenance of motor
B65165E
D Start up procedure
D Maintenance of
motor
D Initial setting
B65150E
D Setting parameters
D Description of parameters
D Initial setting
B65160E
D Setting parameters
D Description of parameters
Table of Contents
B62445E/03
1.2
Soft Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
24
24
26
26
27
27
27
27
28
28
29
29
OPERATION HISTORY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
1.6.1
1.6.2
1.6.3
1.6.4
1.6.5
1.7
Parameter Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting the Input Signal or Output Signal to be Recorded in the Operation History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Inputting and Outputting the Operation History Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30
31
35
44
50
nc
1.6
Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Deletion of External Operator Messages Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ce
nt
e
1.5
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Clearing Alarm History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Alarm Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
r.c
1.4
Display Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuration of PCBs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Software Configuration Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Module Configuration Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
om
1.3
HELP FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
1.7.1
1.7.2
NC STATE DISPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
WAVE FORM DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
1.9
1.10
.c
1.8
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Display Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Setting Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Waveform Diagnostic Parameter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Graphic of Wave Diagnosis Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Data Sampling for Storage Type Waveform Diagnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Outputting Waveform Diagnosis Data (Storage Type) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.10.1
1.10.2
1.10.3
1.10.4
1.10.5
1.11
OPERATING MONITOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
1.11.1
1.12
1.13
1.14
69
70
73
75
77
Display Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
LIST OF OPERATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
WARNING SCREEN DISPLAYED WHEN AN OPTION IS CHANGED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
WARNING SCREEN DISPLAYED WHEN SYSTEM SOFTWARE IS REPLACED
(SYSTEM LABEL CHECK ERROR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
2. HARDWARE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
2.1
STRUCTURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
c1
TABLE OF CONTENTS
2.2
B62445E/03
GENERAL OF HARDWARE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
2.2.1
2.3
Series 16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
2.4
INTERMACHINE CONNECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
CRT/MDI Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Reader/Puncher Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
2.4.3
2.4.4
2.4.5
2.4.6
2.4.7
om
2.4.1
2.4.2
2.4.11
2.4.12
2.4.13
2.4.14
2.4.15
2.4.16
ce
nt
e
2.5
r.c
2.4.8
2.4.9
2.4.10
2.5.4
2.5.5
2.5.6
2.5.7
2.5.8
.c
I/O Cards with Power Supply (Power C) (Sink Type Output) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
I/O Cards with Power Supply (Power C) (Source Type Output) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Background Graphic Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
2.5.9
2.5.10
2.5.11
nc
2.5.1
2.5.2
2.5.3
2.6
2.6.3
2.6.4
2.6.5
2.6.1
2.6.2
2.7
2.7.1
Removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
2.7.2
Insertion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
2.8
2.8.2
2.9
2.10
2.11
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B62445E/03
2.12
2.13
2.14
3.3
186
187
188
188
189
189
190
190
192
192
193
193
194
om
r.c
3.2.1
3.2.2
3.2.3
3.2.4
3.2.5
3.2.6
3.2.7
3.2.8
3.2.9
3.2.10
3.2.11
3.2.12
3.2.13
ce
nt
e
3.1
3.2
195
197
197
202
.c
3.6
nc
3.4
3.5
4.2.1
4.2.2
4.2.3
4.2.4
4.2.5
4.3
4.3.1
4.3.2
4.3.3
4.3.4
4.3.5
4.4
4.5
212
213
214
214
217
Display Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PMCLAD Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PMCDGN Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory Display (M.SRCH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PMCRAM Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
218
219
223
227
231
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B62445E/03
5.3
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
Associated Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
om
5.4
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
6.3
ce
nt
e
6.2
r.c
6.1
269
269
270
272
274
.c
6.5
Display Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spindle Setting Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spindle Tuning Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spindle Monitor Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Correspondence Between Operation Mode and Parameters on Spindle Tuning Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
nc
6.4
7.1
7.1.1
7.1.2
7.1.3
7.2
7.2.1
7.2.2
7.2.3
7.3
7.4
7.5
7.6
287
288
289
292
8. TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
8.1
c4
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B62445E/03
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
w
w
298
301
305
309
312
321
323
326
335
336
338
339
342
343
344
345
347
349
350
351
353
365
366
367
368
369
372
377
378
381
384
386
390
391
392
394
395
397
398
399
om
8.2
8.3
8.4
8.5
8.6
8.7
8.8
8.9
8.10
8.11
8.12
8.13
8.14
8.15
8.16
8.17
8.18
8.19
8.20
8.21
8.22
8.23
8.24
8.25
8.26
8.27
8.28
8.29
8.30
8.31
8.32
8.33
8.34
8.35
8.36
8.37
8.38
8.39
8.40
8.41
TABLE OF CONTENTS
413
414
415
416
417
418
419
420
421
om
10.2
10.3
10.4
10.5
10.6
10.7
10.8
10.9
10.10
B62445E/03
APPENDIXES
r.c
ce
nt
e
A.1
A.2
A.3
A.4
A.5
426
426
427
428
429
432
456
463
468
nc
B.1
B.2
B.3
B.4
.c
C.1
D.1
D.1.2
D.1.3
D.1.1
D.2
D.2.1
D.2.2
D.2.4
D.2.5
D.2.6
D.2.7
D.2.8
D.3
D.2.3
B62445E/03
om
1.2
POWER IS TURNED ON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
SYSTEM CONFIGURATION SCREEN . . . . . . . . . 24
1.4
1.5
r.c
1.3
ce
nt
e
RECORD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
1.6
OPERATION HISTORY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
1.7
HELP FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
1.8
1.9
NC STATE DISPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
nc
.c
1.1
FUNCTION KEYS
AND SOFT KEYS
1.1.1
B62445E/03
Operations and soft key display staturs for each function key are described
below:
Soft Keys
om
Indicates screens
ce
nt
e
r.c
*1 Press function keys to switch between screens that are used frequently.
nc
*2 Some soft keys are not displayed depending on the option configuration.
.c
*3 In some cases, the continuous menu key is omitted when the 14 CRT
display or 8.4/9.5/LCD is used.
B62445E/03
POSITION SCREEN
POS
POS
[ABS]
[PTSPRE]
[EXEC]
[RUNPRE]
[(OPRT)]
om
[EXEC]
[REL]
[(OPRT)]
(Axis or numeral)
[ORIGIN]
[PRESET]
[ALLEXE]
[Axis name]
[EXEC]
[RUNPRE]
[EXEC]
[(OPRT)]
(Axis or numeral)
[ORIGIN]
[PRESET]
[ALLEXE]
[Axis name]
[EXEC]
nc
[PTSPRE]
[RUNPRE]
[EXEC]
.c
Handle interruption
[PTSPRE]
[EXEC]
[RUNPRE]
[(OPRT)]
[EXEC]
[HNDL]
Monitor screen
[MONI]
[(OPRT)]
[EXEC]
ce
nt
e
[PTSPRE]
r.c
[PTSPRE]
[EXEC]
[RUNPRE]
[EXEC]
[EXEC]
PROGRAM SCREEN
B62445E/03
PROG
1/2
PROG
(1)
[P TYPE]
[Q TYPE]
[ABS]
[REL]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
ce
nt
e
[F SRH]
om
[BGEDT]
[O number]
[N number]
[REWIND]
[(OPRT)]
r.c
[PRGRM]
[(OPRT)]
[BGEDT]
[O number]
[N number]
[REWIND]
nc
[P TYPE]
[Q TYPE]
[F SRH]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
.c
[BGEDT]
[(OPRT)]
[CURRNT]
[BGEDT]
[NEXT]
[RSTR]
[(OPRT)]
[BGEDT]
B62445E/03
2/2
(2)
[FL.SDL]
[PRGRM]
[SELECT]
[File No. ]
[EXEC]
[(OPRT)]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
r.c
[SCHDUL]
[F SET]
om
[DIR]
[INPUT]
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
(Schedule data)
PROGRAM SCREEN
B62445E/03
PROG
1/2
PROG
[(OPRT)]
[BGEDT]
(O number)
(Address)
(Address)
[REWIND]
[F SRH]
[O SRH]
[SRH]
[SRH]
[CAN]
(N number)
[EXEC]
[CHAIN] (The cursor moves to the end of a program.)
[STOP]
[CAN]
(O number)
[EXEC]
[STOP]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
(O number)
[CAN]
[EXEC]
(N number)
[COPY]
[CRSR ]
(O number)
[EXEC]
[ CRSR]
[ BTTM]
[ALL]
[MOVE]
[CRSR]
(O number)
[EXEC]
[ CRSR]
[ BTTM]
[ALL]
[MERGE]
[ CRSR]
(O number)
[EXEC]
[ BTTM]
ce
nt
e
[READ]
r.c
[PRGRM]
om
Program display
[PUNCH]
[DELETE]
[CHANGE]
(Address)
(Address)
.c
nc
[EXEDT]
[BEFORE]
[AFTER]
[SKIP]
[1EXEC]
[EXEC]
B62445E/03
2/2
(1)
Program directory display
[BGEDT]
(O number)
[READ]
[PUNCH]
[CHAIN]
[STOP]
[CAN]
(O number)
[STOP]
[CAN]
(O number)
[EXEC]
[EXEC]
[LINE]
[CHAMF]
[CNR.R]
[INPUT]
ce
nt
e
[C.A.P.]
om
[(OPRT)]
r.c
[LIB]
INSERT
nc
[C.A.P.]
[INPUT]
.c
[(OPRT)]
[FLOPPY]
[F SET]
[F SET]
[O SET]
[F SET]
[O SET]
[F SET]
PROGRAM SCREEN
B62445E/03
PROG
PROG
[BGEDT]
[(OPRT)]
[(OPRT)]
[BGEDT]
[START]
ce
nt
e
(Address)
(Address)
[REWIND]
[BGEDT]
[(OPRT)]
r.c
[PRGRM]
om
Program display
[BGEDT]
nc
[(OPRT)]
[(OPRT)]
[BGEDT]
[RSTR]
.c
B62445E/03
PROGRAM SCREEN
PROG
PROG
[PRGRM]
[BGEDT]
[(OPRT)]
om
Program display
[BGEDT]
[(OPRT)]
r.c
[CURRNT]
[(OPRT)]
[BGEDT]
.c
nc
[(OPRT)]
ce
nt
e
[NEXT]
PROGRAM SCREEN
B62445E/03
PROG
PROG
Program display
[BGEDT]
[BGEDT]
(O number)
(Address)
(Address)
[REWIND]
[BGEDT]
(O number)
.c
nc
[LIB]
[O SRH]
[SRH]
[SRH]
ce
nt
e
[MDI]
om
[(OPRT)]
r.c
[PRGRM]
10
B62445E/03
PROGRAM SCREEN
PROG
1/2
PROG
[(OPRT)]
[BGEND]
(O number)
(Address)
(Address)
[REWIND]
[F SRH]
[CAN]
(N number)
[EXEC]
[CHAIN] (The cursor moves to the end of a program.)
[STOP]
[CAN]
(O number)
[EXEC]
[STOP]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
(O number)
[CAN]
[EXEC]
(N number)
[COPY]
[CRSR ]
(O number)
[EXEC]
[ CRSR]
[ BTTM]
[ALL]
[MOVE]
[CRSR ]
(O number)
[EXEC]
[ CRSR]
[ BTTM]
[ALL]
[MERGE]
[ CRSR]
(O number)
[EXEC]
[ BTTM]
ce
nt
e
[READ]
[O SRH]
[SRH]
[SRH]
r.c
[PRGRM]
om
Program display
[PUNCH]
[DELETE]
[CHANGE]
w
w
11
(Address)
[BEFORE]
(Address)
.c
nc
[EXEDT]
[AFTER]
[SKIP]
[1EXEC]
[EXEC]
B62445E/03
2/2
(1)
[READ]
[PUNCH]
[O SRH]
[CHAIN]
[STOP]
[CAN]
(O number)
[STOP]
[CAN]
(O number)
(Data)
[PRGRM]
[DIR]
[F SRH]
[READ]
[PUNCH]
w
w
[EXEC]
[LINE]
[CHAMF]
[CNR.R]
[INPUT]
[(OPRT)]
.c
[FLOPPY]
nc
[EXEC]
ce
nt
e
[C.A.P.]
om
[(OPRT)]
r.c
[LIB]
[DELETE]
12
(Numeral)
[CAN]
[EXEC]
(Numeral)
(Numeral)
[STOP]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
(Numeral)
(Numeral)
[STOP]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
(Numeral)
[CAN]
[EXEC]
[F SET]
[F SET]
[O SET]
[F SET]
[O SET]
[F SET]
B62445E/03
1/2
OFFSET
SETTING
[(OPRT)]
(Number)
[NO SRH]
(Axis name and numeral)
[INP.C.]
(Axis name)
(Numeral)
[+INPUT]
(Numeral)
[INPUT]
[CLEAR]
[PUNCH]
Setting screen
[(OPRT)]
(Number)
[ON:1]
[OFF:0]
(Numeral)
(Numeral)
[NO SRH]
[+INPUT]
[INPUT]
nc
[SETING]
[ALL]
[WEAR]
[GEOM]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
ce
nt
e
[READ]
(Number)
[NO SRH]
(Axis name and numeral)
(Numeral)
[+INPUT]
(Numeral)
[INPUT]
.c
[WORK]
[NO SRH]
[INP.C.]
[INPUT]
[PUNCH]
[(OPRT)]
[MACRO]
[MEASUR]
r.c
[WEAR]
[GEOM]
[OFFSET]
om
[CAN]
[EXEC]
13
[MEASUR]
B62445E/03
2/2
(1)
Menu programming screen
[MENU]
[(OPRT)]
(Number)
[SELECT]
om
[OPR]
[TOOLLF]
[(OPRT)]
(Number)
[CLEAR]
[WEAR]
[GEOM]
ce
nt
e
(Numeral)
[NO SRH]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
[INPUT]
[(OPRT)]
(Number)
[NO SRH]
(Axis name and numeral)
[INP.C.]
(Axis name)
[+INPUT]
(Numeral)
(Numeral)
[INPUT]
nc
[CLEAR]
[READ]
.c
[PUNCH]
[(OPRT)]
(Numeral)
(Numeral)
[+INPUT]
[INPUT]
[WK.SHFT]
r.c
14
[ALL]
[WEAR]
[GEOM]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
[MEASUR]
B62445E/03
OFFSET
SETTING
OFFSET
SETTING
(Number)
(Axis name)
(Numeral)
(Numeral)
[(OPRT)]
[NO SRH]
[INP.C.]
[+INPUT]
[INPUT]
Setting screen
(Number)
[ON:1]
[OFF:0]
(Numeral)
(Numeral)
[(OPRT)]
[NO SRH]
[+INPUT]
[INPUT]
ce
nt
e
[SETING]
(Number)
(Numeral)
(Numeral)
[NO SRH]
[+INPUT]
[INPUT]
nc
[WORK]
(Number)
(Axis name)
(Numeral)
.c
[MACRO]
[NO SRH]
[INP.C.]
[INPUT]
[PUNCH]
(Number)
[SELECT]
[MENU]
[OPR]
[(OPRT)]
r.c
[OFFSET]
om
(Number)
[CLEAR]
(Numeral)
[NO SRH]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
[INPUT]
15
SYSTEM SCREEN
B62445E/03
SYSTEM
1/3
SYSTEM
Parameter screen
[NO SRH]
[+INPUT]
[INPUT]
[PUNCH]
Diagnosis screen
[CAN]
[EXEC]
(Number)
[(OPRT)]
PMC screen
[PMC]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
ce
nt
e
[READ]
[DGNOS]
om
(Number)
[ON:1]
[OFF:0]
(Numeral)
(Numeral)
[(OPRT)]
r.c
[PARAM]
[SEARCH]
[NO SRH]
[TOP]
[BOTTOM]
[SRCH]
[WSRCH]
[NSRCH]
.c
nc
[PMCLAD]
INPUT
[FSRCH]
[ADRESS]/[SYMBOL]
[TRIGER]
[TRGON]
[TRGOFF]
[START]
[DUMP]
[WINDOW]
(1)
(2)
(Continued on the next page)
(3)
[SEARCH]
[DPARA]/[NDPARA]
[TRGSRC]
[INIT]
[DIVIDE]
[CANCEL]
[DELETE]
[SELECT]
[WIDTH]
[BYTE]
[WORD]
[D.WORD]
16
B62445E/03
(3)
2/3
[DUMP]
[PMCDGN]
[SEARCH]
[BYTE]
[WORD]
[D.WORD]
[DRARA]/[NDPARA]
[TITLE]
[STATUS]
[SEARCH]
[ALARM]
[TRACE]
[T.DISP]/[TRCPRM]
[EXEC]
[M.SRCH]
[ANALYS]
With
PMCRC
only
[SEARCH]
[INPUT]
[SCOPE]
[DELETE]
[INIT]
[SGNPRM]
[START]/[STOP]
[TSRCH]
[ADRESS]/[SYMBOL]
[EXCHG]
[SELECT]
[CANCEL]
ce
nt
e
[ADRESS]/[SYMBOL]
[PMCPRM]
[TIMER]
[COUNTR]
[KEEPRL]
[DATA]
[SETTING]
[G.DATA]
[C.DATA]
[G.CONT]
[GSRCH]
[SEARCH]
[NO.SRH]
[INIT]
[YES]/[MANUAL]/[ROM]
[NO]/[AUTO]/[RAM]
nc
[STOP]/[RUN]
[I/O]
om
(2)
r.c
(1)
.c
[EXEC]
[CANCEL]
(No.)
[SPEED]
[INPUT]
[INIT]
[MDI]/[ROM]
[SYSTEM]
(4)
(Continued on the next page)
17
[TO]
[EXEC]
B62445E/03
3/3
(4)
Pitch error compensation screen
(No.)
[ON:1]
[OFF:0]
(Numeral)
(Numeral)
[NO SRH]
[+INPUT]
[INPUT]
[READ]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
[PUNCH]
[CAN]
[EXEC]
[SV.TRC]
[ON:1]
[OFF:0]
(Numeral)
[TRACE]
[TRNSF]
[(OPRT)]
[ON:1]
[OFF:0]
[INPUT]
[(OPRT)]
nc
[SP.PRM]
[(OPRT)]
.c
[W.DGNS]
INPUT
[INPUT]
ce
nt
e
[SV.PRM]
om
[(OPRT)]
r.c
[PITCH]
[STSRT]
[TIME]
[TIME]
[HDOBL]
[HHALF]
[STSRT]
[CH1]
[CH1]
[VDOBL]
[VHALF]
[STSRT]
[CH2]
[CH2]
[VDOBL]
[VHALF]
18
B62445E/03
MESSAGE SCREEN
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
om
[ALARM]
r.c
[MSG]
[CLEAR]
ce
nt
e
[HISTRY]
HELP SCREEN
nc
HELP
[(OPRT)]
[SELECT]
.c
[1 ALAM]
[(OPRT)]
[SELECT]
[3 PARA]
19
HELP
B62445E/03
GRAPH
Mode 0
[GRAPH]
[(OPRT)]
[HEAD]
[ERASE]
[PROCES]
[EXEC]
[STOP]
[ZOOM]
[(OPRT)]
[ACT]
[HI/LO]
A.ST/Path graphics
GRAPH
Mode 1 to 3
om
[NORMAL]
r.c
[(OPRT)]
ce
nt
e
[G.PRM]
A.ST/Path graphics
[(OPRT)]
[NORMAL]
[ENTRY]
[A.PRM]
[(OPRT)]
[NORMAL]
[ENTRY]
[GRAPH]
[(OPRT)]
[HEAD]
[ERASE]
[PROCES]
[EXEC]
[STOP]
[SIDE]
[FRONT]
[OPEN]
[ZOOM]
[EXEC]
[HI/LO]
[(OPRT)]
.c
nc
[G.PRM]
20
B62445E/03
GRAPH
[EXEC]
[(OPRT)]
[AUTO]
[STSRT]
[STOP]
[REWIND]
[CLEAR]
[ZOOM]
[(OPRT)]
[EXEC]
[]
[]
[]
[]
Solid graphics
GRAPH
ce
nt
e
[POS]
Solid graphics
nc
[PARAM]
.c
[BLANK]
[EXEC]
[(OPRT)]
[ANEW]
[+ROT]
[ROT]
[+TILT]
[TILT]
[(OPRT)]
[A.ST]]
[F.ST]
[STOP]
[REWIND]
[(OPRT)]
[ANEW]
[+ROT]
[ROT]
[+TILT]
[TILT]
[REVIEW]
[PARAM]
[3PLN]
r.c
[PARAM]
om
[
]
[]
[]
[]
[]
[(OPRT)]
21
B62445E/03
1.2
SCREEN DISPLAYED
IMMEDIATELY AFTER
POWER IS TURNED
ON
1.2.1
Types of PCBs mounted on the slots are displayed.
If a hardware trouble or an incorrect mounting is found, this screen is
displayed.
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
0: 003E4000
1: 30464202
2: 00504303
3:
4:
5:
nc
.c
D Module ID
90 :
B2 :
A7 :
AD :
AE :
3F :
90 :
46 :
5F :
A8 :
B1 :
6D :
45 :
9A :
f f j j
Internal slot number
Module function (software ID)
Type of PCB (module ID)
B62445E/03
D Software ID
40
41
42
4E
45
50
46
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
Main CPU
Option 3 board
Builtin I/O card
49
4A
43
4F
: CAP II
: Remote buffer
: Sub CPU
:
Graphic
Additional 4axis control (FS16 option 2)
Graphic (CAP II)
om
1.2.2
r.c
B0A101
: 906001
xxxxxx
yyyyyy
zzzzzz
ce
nt
e
SERVO
SUB :
OMM :
PMC :
Digital servo
ROM
Sub CPU
(Remote buffer)
Order made
macro/macro
compiler
PMC
nc
1.2.3
CNC control
software
.c
Configuration Display
of Software
B0A101
SERVO
SUB :
OMM :
PMC :
: 906001
xxxxxx
yyyyyy
zzzzzz
CNC control
software
Digital servo
ROM
Sub CPU
(Remote buffer)
Order made
macro/macro
compiler
PMC
23
1.3
SYSTEM
CONFIGURATION
SCREEN
1.3.1
After the system has been installed correctly, you can find the PCBs
installed and the softwares integrated on the system configuration screen.
(1) Press
Display Method
B62445E/03
SYSTEM
key.
om
1.3.2
ce
nt
e
Configuration of PCBs
D Screen
PAGE
PAGE
r.c
.c
nc
SLOT
00
0D
02
03
ID
40
45
4A
41
SERIES
B0A1
600E
B401
4068
VERSION
0006
0003
0001
0001
PAGE01
Software version
of module with
CPU
Software ID (type)
Module ID
Slot No.
(80X8F is 2nd side)
24
B62445E/03
90 :
B2 :
A7 :
AD :
AE :
3F :
90 :
46 :
5F :
A8 :
B1 :
6D :
45 :
9A :
D Software ID
40
41
42
4E
45
50
46
Main CPU
49 : CAP II
Option 3 board
4A : Remote buffer
Builtin I/O card
43 : Sub CPU
MAP
4F :
Graphic
Additional 4axis control (FS16 option 2)
Graphic (CAPII)
r.c
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
om
D Module ID
25
B62445E/03
1.3.3
Kind of software
Software series
Software Configuration
Screen
SYSTEM CONFIG(SOFTWARE)
SERVO
PMC
LADDER
MACRO
BD11
FC1A
F41A
9050
4062
FS16
BBBB
0001
FC2A
F42A
0001
0001
0001
bbbb
Software version
F81A
F01A
F82A
F02A
Software
configuration
om
SYSTEM
Character written on
PMC title screen
1.3.4
ce
nt
e
r.c
Character written
on macro compiler
and on CAP.
Module Configuration
Screen
(1)
SYSTEM CONFIG(MODULE)
.c
nc
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
(2)
6MB
6MB
___
PMP+SLC
9ICRT
MOUNTED
___
MOUNTED
___
(4)
(3)
Contents of display
(1) Slot number (The number is corresponding to PCB configuration
screen)
(2) Type of PCB mounted
(3) Type of mounted module or hardware
(4) Mounted or not, or type of module
Pressing the PAGE key displays the system configuration screen of
other PCBs.
*Refer to Construction of Control Unit PCB for correspondence
with each module and display.
26
B62445E/03
1.4
ALARM HISTORY
SCREEN
1.4.1
General
1.4.2
Screen Display
(1) Press
MESSAGE
key .
om
(2) Press soft key [HISTRY] and an alarm history screen is displayed.
or
PAGE
key.
r.c
PAGE
O1234 N12345
nc
ce
nt
e
91/04/18 20:56:26
506 OVERTRAVEL : +X
91/04/18 19:58:11
000 TURN OFF POWER
91/04/18 19:52:45
000 TURN OFF POWER
91/04/18 19:48:43
300 APC ALARM : XAXIS ZERO RETURN REQUEST
91/04/18 18:10:10
507 OVERTRAVEL : +B
1.4.3
(2) Press soft key [(CLEAR], then the alarm history is cleared.
1.4.4
][ (OPE) ]
.c
When an external alarm (No. 1000 to 1999) or a macro alarm (No. 3000
to 3999) is output, the alarm history function can record both the alarm
number and message if so specified in the following parameter. If
recording of the message is not set or if no message is input, only an
external alarm or macro alarm is displayed.
Alarm Display
#7
#6
#5
3112
#4
#3
EAH
#2
#1
#0
1.5
B62445E/03
1.5.1
MESSAGE
function key.
Screen Display
(2) Press the rightmost soft key [>>].
[ALARM] [MGS] [HISTRY] [
om
EXTERNAL
OPERATOR
MESSAGES
RECORD
] [ (OPRT) ]>>
r.c
O1234 N12345
PAGE : 1
ce
nt
e
MESSAGE HISTORY
93/04/01 17:25:00
No. ****
nc
Up to 255 characters
1.5.2
or
Display range
][
.c
PAGE
PAGE
Deletion of External
Operator Messages
Record
(1) The recorded external operator message can be deleted by setting the
MMC bit (bit 0 of parameter 3113) to 1.
Pressing the [CLEAR] soft key erases all the records of the external
operator message.
(2) The MS1 and MS0 bits (bits 7 and 6 of parameter 3113) specify the
number of records to be displayed on the external operator message
history screen. When the bits are changed, all external operator
message records retained up to that point are erased.
28
B62445E/03
1.5.3
Parameter
3113
#7
MS1
#6
MS0
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
MHC
om
Number of records
255
200
10
100
18
50
32
ce
nt
e
#7
#5
nc
3112
MS0
r.c
MS1
#4
#3
#2
OMH
#1
#0
1.5.4
.c
Notes
Note) After setting this parameter, briefly turn the power off, then on
again.
29
1.6
B62445E/03
This function displays the key and signal operations performed by the NC
operator upon the occurrence of a fault or the output of an NC alarm,
together with the corresponding NC alarms.
This function records the following data:
OPERATION HISTORY
1.6.1
Parameter Setting
#7
OHS
#6
#5
#4
OPH
#3
#2
#1
#0
#1
#0
r.c
3106
om
ce
nt
e
#6
#5
OPH
#4
#3
#2
nc
3112
.c
3122
30
B62445E/03
1.6.2
Screen Display
D Displaying the operation
history
SYSTEM
function key.
om
(2) Press the continue menu key [ ]. The [OPEHIS] [(OPRT)] soft key
are displayed.
(3) Press the [OPEHIS] soft key twice. The operation history screen is
displayed.
ce
nt
e
No.DATA
01 92/06/03
02 08:40:00
03 <DELETE>
04 F0000.6
05 MEM
06 G0009.0
07 G0009.1
08 G0009.2
09 ST
10 ST
O1234 N12345
Page : 123
No.DATA
No.DATA
11 F0000.7 21 F0001.0
12 F0000.5 22 <POS>
13 F0001.0 23 <PROG>
14 F0000.5 24 <RESET>
15 P/S0010
25 EDIT
16 92/06/03
26 O
17 09:27:49
27 1
18 <PROG>
28 2
19 <RESET> 29 3
20 F0000.7 30 4
r.c
OPERATION HISTORY
][
08:20:52
][PG.SRH]
nc
On the operation history screen, the soft keys are configured as shown
below:
] [ PARAM ] [DGNOS] [PMC] [SYSTEM] [(OPE)]
[W.DGNS] [
[ OPEHIS ] [SGSEL] [
[ TOP ]
.c
[BOTTOM][
[ ]
push
] [OPEHIS] [(OPE)]
[ ]
push
] [
] [(OPE)]
[ ]
push
] [
] [PG.SRH] [ ]
(4) To display the next part of the operation history, press the page down
PAGE
key
or
B62445E/03
1 Function key:
POS
PROG
OFFSET
SETTING
om
3 Page/cursor key:
PAGE
r.c
, etc.
ce
nt
e
5 Other key:
RESET
CAN
RESET
nc
.c
32
B62445E/03
MD4
REF
DNC1
MDI
MEM
RMT
om
MD1
NOMODE
EDT
r.c
H/INC
JOG
REF
TJOG
ce
nt
e
THND
Input signal
Name displayed
RV2
100%
50%
nc
RV1
25%
F0%
.c
(3) NC alarms
NC alarms are displayed in reverse video.
P/S alarms, system alarms, and external alarms are displayed together
with their numbers.
For other types of alarms, only the alarm type is displayed. (No details
are displayed.)
For twopath control, the operations of path 2 are displayed in the
same way, but preceded by S_.
Example) P/S0050, SV_ALM, S_APC_ALM
(4) Time stamp (date and time)
The following time data (date and time) is recorded:
1 Date and time of poweron
2 Date and time of poweroff
3 Date and time when an NC alarm occurs
4 The clock time is recorded at predetermined intervals, together
with each new calendar day.
33
B62445E/03
r.c
om
If a system alarm occurs, the date and time are not recorded.
3) At predetermined intervals, the clock time is displayed in reverse
video. Set the interval in minutes in parameter No. 3122. If zero
is set, the time is stamped at tenminute intervals.
09:15:30 ==== Hour:Minute:Second
Each new calendar day is displayed in reverse video.
92/01/20 ==== Year/Month/Day
SYSTEM
function key.
(2) Press the continue menu key [ ]. The [OPEHIS] (operation history)
soft key is displayed.
(3) Press the [OPEHIS] soft key, then press the [SGSEL] soft key. The
operation history signal selection screen is displayed.
nc
ce
nt
e
Note
The clock time is recorded for a specified interval only when
data is stored within that interval.
.c
34
O1000 N02000
No.
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
ADDRES
G0000
G0004
G0008
G0003
G0043
SIGNAL
00000001
00000011
00000111
00001111
01100000
********
********
********
********
********
00:00:00
] [
] [ (OPE) ]
B62445E/03
1.6.3
(1) On the operation history signal selection screen, press the [(OPE)] soft
key.
OP_HIS SIGNAL SELECT
No.
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
ADDRES SIGNAL
********
********
********
********
********
********
********
********
********
********
r.c
O1000 N02000
om
ce
nt
e
*** 00:00:00
ON:1 ][ OFF:0 ][
or
position.
(3) Key in a signal type (X, G, F, or Y) and an address, then press the
INPUT
key.
Example) G0004
INPUT
.c
nc
or
B62445E/03
om
Notes
1 A cross ( ) indicates that a signal will not be recorded.
Also, any signal for which an address is not specified will not
be recorded, either.
2 A circle () indicates that a signal can be recorded.
3 A signal indicated by its symbol name will also be displayed
by its symbol name.
MTPMC
:
X127
G000
#7
f
#6
f
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
ce
nt
e
X000
#7
f
r.c
1. M/T addresses
#1
f
#0
f
#6
f
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
#1
f
#0
f
FIN
PMCCNC
:
G004
nc
G003
TFIN
SFIN
MFIN
G006
*ABS
SRN
G007
RLSOT
EXLM
*FLUP
ST
STLK
G008
ERS
RRW
*SP
*ESP
*IT
G009
G013
G014
G015
G018
G019
RT
.c
G005
36
B62445E/03
#7
f
#6
f
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
#1
f
#0
f
G042
G043
G044
MLK
BDT1
G045
BDT9
BDT8
BDT7
BDT6
BDT5
BDT4
BDT3
BDT2
G046
DRN
KEY4
KEY3
KEY2
KEY1
SBK
G047
G060
G061
G062
G099
G100
+J8
G101
RGTA
+J7
+J6
+J5
+J4
+J3
+J2
+J1
nc
r.c
ce
nt
e
om
G020
G102
J8
J7
J6
J5
J4
J3
J2
J1
G103
.c
G106
MI8
MI7
MI6
MI5
MI4
MI3
MI2
MI1
G107
G108
MLK8
MLK7
MLK6
MLK5
MLK4
MLK3
MLK2
MLK1
G109
G110
+LM8
+LM7
+LM6
+LM5
+LM4
+LM3
+LM2
+LM1
G111
G112
LM8
LM7
LM6
LM5
LM4
LM3
LM2
LM1
G113
G114
*+L8
*+L7
*+L6
*+L5
*+L4
*+L3
*+L2
*+L1
G105
37
B62445E/03
#7
f
#6
f
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
#1
f
#0
f
G116
*L8
*L7
*L6
*L5
*L4
*L3
*L2
*L1
G117
G118
*+ED8
*+ED7
*+ED6
*+ED5
*+ED4
*+ED3
*+ED2
*+ED1
G119
G120
*ED8
*ED7
*ED6
*ED5
*ED4
G121
G125
G126
SVF8
SVF7
SVF6
SVF5
G127
G129
G130
*IT8
G131
G132
G133
om
G115
*ED3
*ED2
*ED1
SVF4
SVF3
SVF2
SVF1
*IT7
*IT6
*IT5
*IT4
*IT3
*IT2
*IT1
+MIT4
+MIT3
+MIT2
+MIT1
G134
MIT4
MIT3
MIT2
MIT1
G135
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
G255
r.c
PMCMT
Y000
#7
f
#6
f
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
#1
f
#0
f
Y127
CNCPMC
F000
#7
f
#6
f
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
#1
f
#0
f
F255
38
B62445E/03
#7
f
#6
f
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
#1
f
#0
f
X127
#1
f
#0
f
#7
f
#6
f
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
G003
G004
FIN
G005
G006
G007
RLSOT
EXLM
*FLUP
G008
ERS
RRW
*SP
*ESP
G009
G013
G014
SFIN
MFIN
*ABS
SRN
ST
STLK
*IT
nc
TFIN
ce
nt
e
r.c
G000
om
G015
G018
.c
RT
G020
G042
G043
G044
MLK
BDT1
G045
BDT9
BDT8
BDT7
BDT6
BDT5
BDT4
BDT3
BDT2
G046
DRN
KEY4
KEY3
KEY2
KEY1
SBK
G047
G060
G019
39
B62445E/03
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
RGTA
G062
G099
G100
+J8
+J7
+J6
+J5
+J4
+J3
+J2
+J1
G101
G102
J8
J7
J6
J5
J4
J3
J2
J1
G103
G105
G106
MI8
G107
G108
MLK8
G109
G110
+LM8
r.c
f
MI7
MI6
MI5
MI4
MI3
MI2
SMI1
MLK7
MLK6
MLK5
MLK4
MLK3
MLK2
MLK1
+LM7
+LM6
+LM5
+LM4
+LM3
+LM2
+LM1
nc
ce
nt
e
om
#7
G061
G112
LM8
LM7
LM6
LM5
LM4
LM3
LM2
LM1
.c
G111
G114
*+L8
*+L7
*+L6
*+L5
*+L4
*+L3
*+L2
*+L1
G115
G116
*L8
*L7
*L6
*L5
*L4
*L3
*L2
*L1
G117
G118
*+ED8
*+ED7
*+ED6
*+ED5
*+ED4
*+ED3
*+ED2
*+ED1
G119
G120
*ED8
*ED7
*ED6
*ED5
*ED4
*ED3
*ED2
*ED1
G121
G125
G113
40
B62445E/03
#7
SVF8
#6
SVF7
#5
SVF6
#4
SVF5
#3
SVF4
#2
SVF3
#1
SVF2
#0
SVF1
G127
G129
G130
*IT8
*IT7
*IT6
*IT5
*IT4
*IT3
*IT2
*IT1
G131
G132
+MIT4
G133
G134
G135
G255
G1000
#7
f
G1003
G1004
G1005
G1006
+MIT3
+MIT2
+MIT1
r.c
MIT4
MIT3
MIT2
MIT1
ce
nt
e
om
G126
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
#1
f
#0
f
FIN
TFIN
SFIN
MFIN
*ABS
SRN
RLSOT
EXLM
*FLUP
ST
STLK
G1008
ERS
RRW
*SP
*ESP
*IT
G1009
G1013
G1014
G1015
G1018
G1019
RT
.c
nc
G1007
41
B62445E/03
#7
f
#6
f
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
#1
f
#0
f
G1042
G1043
G1044
MLK
BDT1
G1045
BDT9
BDT8
BDT7
BDT6
BDT5
BDT4
BDT3
BDT2
G1046
DRN
KEY4
KEY3
KEY2
KEY1
G1047
G1060
G1061
G1062
G1099
G1100
+J8
+J7
G1101
G1102
J8
G1105
RGTA
+J6
+J5
+J4
+J3
+J2
+J1
J7
J6
J5
J4
J3
J2
J1
nc
G1103
.c
r.c
SBK
ce
nt
e
om
G1020
MI8
MI7
MI6
MI5
MI4
MI3
MI2
SMI1
G1107
G1108
MLK8
MLK7
MLK6
MLK5
MLK4
MLK3
MLK2
MLK1
G1109
G1110
+LM8
+LM7
+LM6
+LM5
+LM4
+LM3
+LM2
+LM1
G1111
G1112
LM8
LM7
LM6
LM5
LM4
LM3
LM2
LM1
G1113
G1114
*+L8
*+L7
*+L6
*+L5
*+L4
*+L3
*+L2
*+L1
G1115
G1106
42
B62445E/03
#7
*L8
#6
*L7
#5
*L6
#4
*L5
#3
*L4
#2
*L3
#1
*L2
#0
*L1
G1117
G1118
*+ED8
*+ED7
*+ED6
*+ED5
*+ED4
*+ED3
*+ED2
*+ED1
G1119
G1120
*ED8
*ED7
*ED6
*ED5
*ED4
*ED3
*ED2
*ED1
G1121
G1125
G1126
SVF8
SVF7
SVF6
SVF5
SVF4
G1127
G1129
G1130
*IT8
*IT7
*IT6
G1131
G1132
G1133
G1134
G1135
G1255
SVF3
SVF2
SVF1
*IT5
*IT4
*IT3
*IT2
*IT1
+MIT4
+MIT3
+MIT2
+MIT1
MIT4
MIT3
MIT2
MIT1
.c
r.c
nc
ce
nt
e
om
G1116
PMCMT
#6
f
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
#1
f
#0
f
Y127
w
Y000
#7
f
#7
f
#6
f
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
#1
f
#0
f
F255
F1000
#7
f
#6
f
#5
f
#4
f
#3
f
#2
f
#1
f
#0
f
F1255
43
1.6.4
Inputting and
outputting the
operation history data
D Output
B62445E/03
SYSTEM
om
D Input
ce
nt
e
r.c
SYSTEM
MDI/soft key
Signal
Alarm
For extension (date or time)
MDI/soft key of path 2
Signal of path 2
Alarm of path 2
nc
.c
The header and recorded operation data are output, in this order. The
operation history data is divided into four parts by identifier words. Data
other than the identifier words depends on the type.
T(identifier word)
T0
T50
T51
T52
T53
T54
T55
T56
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
Header
MDI/soft key
Signal
Alarm
For extension (date or time)
MDI/soft key of path 2
Signal of path 2
Alarm of path 2
44
B62445E/03
1 Header
T
C: Data word
0 to 1
om
2 MDI/soft key
;
r.c
P0: Usually
P1: At poweron
H **: KCB code (See the following table.)
ce
nt
e
3 Signal
1
0 to 6
0 to 255
.c
nc
45
B62445E/03
4 Alarm
T
0 to 10
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
Time
0 to 1
0 to 1
.c
nc
P0: Usually
P1: At poweron
E0: Date
E1: Time
D*..*: Data Example) October 29, 1992
46
B62445E/03
0 to 1
P0: Usually
P1: At poweron
H **: KCB code (See the following table.)
2, 6
1000 to 1255
om
7 Signal of path 2
*
ce
nt
e
r.c
nc
.c
w
0 to 10
47
B62445E/03
Space
&
r.c
E
ce
nt
e
;
(EOB)
nc
<
>
.c
om
48
B62445E/03
(80H to FFH)
8
Reset
*
MMC
*
F1
CNC
*
F0
F2
*
*
*
om
F3
Shift
Insert
*
5
CAN
Alter
*
ce
nt
e
Delete
*
F4
F5
r.c
*
F6
*
7
8
9
Input
*
Cur
*
Cur
*
Help
*
nc
Cur
*
Cur
*
.c
D
E
F
F7
*
Positn
F8
*
*
Progrm
F9
*
*
Offset
*
System
*
Messeg
*
Grp/Cs
*1*
Page
*
Custom
Page
*
Fapt
FR
*
FL
*
49
B62445E/03
1.6.5
Notes
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
50
B62445E/03
1.7
HELP FUNCTION
1.7.1
General
1.7.2
om
Press HELP key on any screen other than PMC screen, then a help screen
appears.
(However, it is not available when PMC screen is displaying)
Display Method
r.c
O1234 N12345
ce
nt
e
*****
HELP *****
1. ALARM DETAIL
2. OPERATION METHOD
3. PARAMETER TABLE
w
w
w
[3 PARA]
.c
[2 OPE]
nc
[1 ALAM]
O1234 N12345
NUMBER
: 010
MSAGE : IMPROPER G CODE
FUNCTION :
ALARM :
A G CODE NOT LISTED IN GCODE TABLE
IS BEING COMMANDED
ALSO GCODE FOR FUNCTION NOT ADDED
IS BEING COMMANDED
[1
ALAM]
[2 OPE]
[3 PARA] [
] [ OPRT ]
B62445E/03
PROGRAM EDIT
SEARCH
RESET
DATA INPUT WITH MDI
DATA INPUT WITH TAPE
OUTPUT
INPUT WITH FANUC CASSETTE
OUTPUT WITH FANUC CASSETTE
MEMORY CLEAR
[1 ALARM]
[2 OPR]
[3 PARA]
[ OPRT ]
r.c
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
O1234 N12345
om
2 Press [OPRT], (an item number) and soft key [SELECT], then an
operation method of the item is displayed.
or
PAGE
ce
nt
e
PAGE
O1234 N12345
1/4
.c
nc
52
[SELECT]
Current
page/ Total
page
B62445E/03
D Parameter table
SETTING
READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE
AXIS CONTROL/SETTING UNIT
COORDINATE SYSTEM
STROKE LIMIT
FEED RATE
ACCEL/DECELERATION CTRL
SERVO RELATED
DI/DO
O1234 N12345
1/4
(NO.0000~ )
(NO.0100~ )
(NO.1000~ )
(NO.1200~ )
(NO.1300~ )
(NO.1400~ )
(NO.1600~ )
(NO.1800~ )
(NO.3000~ )
][SELECT]
r.c
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
53
Current
page/ Total
page
om
PAGE
or
PAGE
B62445E/03
1.8
DISPLAYING
DIAGNOSTIC PAGE
1.8.1
(1) Press
Displaying Diagnostic
Page
key.
om
SYSTEM
1.8.2
ce
nt
e
r.c
Contents Displayed
002 DWELL
010 PUNCHING
nc
011 READING
.c
54
B62445E/03
r.c
om
D State of TH alarm
0202
#6
CSA
#5
BLA
#4
PHA
#3
RCA
#2
BZA
#1
CKA
#0
SPH
.c
nc
#6(CSA):
#5(BLA):
#4(PHA):
#3(RCA):
ce
nt
e
0203
#7
DTE
#6
CRC
#5
STB
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
B62445E/03
0200
DGN
#6
LV
#5
OVC
#4
HCA
#3
HVA
#2
DCA
#3
#2
#1
FBA
#0
OFA
Overload
alarm
Disconnection alarm
#7
ALD
#6
#5
#4
EXP
0
1
1
1
0
1
DGN
0204
#7
RAM
#6
OFS
#5
MCC
#4
LDA
#1
#0
Motor overheat
Amplifier overheat
Builtin pulse coder (hand)
Disconnection of separated type pulse
coder (hard)
Disconnection of pulse coder (software)
ce
nt
e
0201
DGN
r.c
om
#3
PMS
#2
#1
#0
nc
.c
#3(PMS): Feedback is not correct due to faulty serial pulse coder C or feedback
cable.
0280
This data indicates the cause of servo alarm No. 417, detected by the NC.
If the alarm is detected by the servo, the PRM bit (bit 4 of DGN No. 0203)
is set to 1.
#7
#6
AXS
#5
#4
DIR
#3
PLS
#2
PLC
#1
#0
MOT
#0 (MOT): The motor type specified in parameter No. 2020 falls outside the
predetermined range.
#2 (PLC): The number of velocity feedback pulses per motor revolution, specified in
parameter No. 2023, is zero or less. The value is invalid.
#3 (PLS): The number of position feedback pulses per motor revolution, specified in
parameter No. 2024, is zero or less. The value is invalid.
#4 (DIR): The wrong direction of rotation for the motor is specified in parameter No.
2022 (the value is other than 111 or 111).
#6 (AXS): In parameter No. 1023 (servo axis number), a value that falls outside the
range of 1 to the number of controlled axes is specified. (For example, 4 is
specified instead of 3.) Alternatively, the values specified in the
parameter are not consecutive.
56
B62445E/03
DGN
Detection unit
D Machine position
Distance from reference position of an axis in detection unit
om
0301
DGN
DGN
Distance from the end of the deceleration dog to the first grid point
r.c
ce
nt
e
DGN
"99999999
Difference between the absolute position of the motor and offset data
M (absolute position of the motor) S (offset data)
(pitch interval)
nc
.c
DGN
Off set data is displayed when CNC calculates the machine position.
D Serial spindle
DGN
#7
#6
#5
0400
#4
SAI
#3
SS2
#2
SSR
#1
POS
#0
SIC
This data indicates the offset data received by the CNC while it is
calculating the machine coordinates.
#4(SAI) 0 : Spindle analog control is not used.
1 : Spindle analog control is used.
#3(SS2) 0 : Spindle serial doesnt control 2nd spindle.
1 : Spindle serial control 2nd spindle.
#2(SSR) 0 : Spindle serial control is not performed.
1 : Spindle serial control is performed.
57
B62445E/03
DGN
0402
DGN
0408
#6
#5
SCA
#4
CME
#3
CER
#2
SNE
#1
FRE
#0
CRE
r.c
#7
SSA
om
DGN
ce
nt
e
nc
DGN
#6
#5
0409
#4
#3
SPE
#2
S2E
#1
S1E
#0
SHE
.c
0410
DGN
0411
DGN
0412
58
B62445E/03
0413
DGN
0414
DGN
0415
DGN
0416
DGN
0417
DGN
0418
DGN
0419
DGN
0420
om
DGN
450
ce
nt
e
DGN
r.c
451
DGN
nc
.c
DGN
Instantaneous difference for the move command, calculated in terms of the spindle,
during rigid tapping (signed, accumulated value)
DGN
Instantaneous difference for the travel error, calculated in terms of the spindle,
during rigid tapping (signed)
457
D Twospindle polygon
machining
(T series only)
#7
SC0
470
B62445E/03
#6
LGE
#5
#4
SCF
#3
#2
#1
PST
#0
SPL
om
r.c
#6 (LGE): In spindle polygon synchronization mode, the two spindles have different
loop gains.
ce
nt
e
is stopped in a block including G51.2, one of the spindles cannot attain the
polygon synchronization speed. This may occur when the spindle cannot
be activated because the PSTU bit (bit 7 of parameter No. 7603) is set to 0.
LGE is set to 1 when the speed is changed in polygon synchronization
.c
nc
mode if the serial spindle control unit uses different loop gains for the first
and second spindles during spindle synchronization.
When this function is used, the two spindles must be controlled with an
identical loop gain. The warning is displayed in DGN, but the warning
does not cause an alarm. (The serial spindle control unit switches
parameters according to the statuses of CTH1, CTH2, and other signals.)
60
B62445E/03
471
#6
PQE
#5
#4
NSP
#3
SUO
#2
QCL
#1
PCL
#0
om
r.c
#0: The speed specified for spindle polygon synchronization is too low. (The
unit speed becomes 0 for internal operations.)
#1 (PCL): The first spindle (master axis in polygon synchronization) is clamped.
#2 (QCL): The second spindle (slave axis in polygon synchronization) is clamped.
ce
nt
e
#3 (SUO): The speed specified in spindle polygon synchronization is too high. (The
speed is restricted to the upper limit for internal operations.)
#4 (NSP): A spindle required for control is not connected. (The serial spindle,
second spindle, etc. is not connected.)
#5: A negative Q value is specified while the QDRC bit (bit 1 of parameter
No. 7603) is set to 1.
nc
#6 (PQE): The P value or Q value, specified with G51.2, falls outside the
predetermined range. Alternatively, the P and Q values are not specified
as a pair.
#7 (NPQ): Although the P and Q values are not specified with G51.2, an R value is
specified. Alternatively, none of the P, Q, or R value is specified.
.c
<Note> Bit 0 is set to 1 even when the specified spindle speed is 0 (bit 7 of DGN
470 is set to 1). This, however, does not cause P/S alarm No. 5018 to be
output (because the programmed speed is 0). P/S alarm No. 5018 occurs
when bit 7 of DGN 470 is set to 0, while bit 0 of DGN 471 is set to 1.
Normal spindle speeds will not cause this alarm to be output.
PCL indicates that the speed specified for the master axis exceeds the
maximum speed for the first axis, specified in parameters No. 3741 to
3744, causing, the specified speed to be limited to the maximum speed.
PCL is not set to 1 provided the first spindle is connected correctly.
QCL is set to 1 when the polygon synchronization speed specified for the
that is, if the speed specified for the first axis, divided by the specified P
value, exceeds 59998. In other words, SUO occurs when a speed in excess
of 59998 rpm is specified for the first axis if P is set to 1.
61
B62445E/03
474
475
om
DGN
476
r.c
DGN
ce
nt
e
477
Actual speed of the master axis for spindle polygon synchronization (rpm)
nc
DGN
.c
478
<Note> The values of DGN 477 and DGN 478 are displayed without being
sampled. The displayed values may vary from the actual values. Use
these values for guidance only.
DGN
62
B62445E/03
0500
Send command
0501
Receive command
0502
510
Not ready
Reset state
Operation state
Alarm state
Circuit disconnection
ce
nt
e
0:
1:
2:
3:
4:
r.c
DGN
om
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
511
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
512
#7
PA1
#6
PA0
#5
BNK
#4
#3
THH
#2
THL
#1
#0
PRA
.c
DGN
nc
This data indicates the cause of a system alarm that has occurred in
MMCIV.
#7
DGN
#6
B62445E/03
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
513
om
DGN
520
r.c
DGN
521
ce
nt
e
Total number of retractions made by receiving the overload signal during cutting
after G83 is specified
522
DGN
nc
Difference between the position on the drill axis from which the previous retraction
was started and the position from which the current retraction is started
.c
64
B62445E/03
#6
530
#5
A99
#4
A98
#3
A97
#2
A96
#1
A95
#0
A43
#5 (A99): A pry alarm occurred while the tool was being changed.
om
#4 (A98): After the power was turned on or after an emergency stop was released,
M06 was specified before the first reference position return. While the
tool was being changed, machine lock was enabled for the Zaxis.
r.c
531
ce
nt
e
#5
584
#4
583
#3
582
#2
581
#1
580
#0
502
#6 (585): Spindle servo alarm (excessive error during ATC magazine indexing)
#5 (584): Invalid sequence during positioning and ATC (system error)
#4 (583): Spindle servo alarm (LSI overflow)
nc
.c
DGN
540
Difference between position errors of the master axis and slave axis under simple
synchronous control
M series only
65
B62445E/03
ce
nt
e
0552
r.c
0551
om
nc
.c
66
B62445E/03
The data items displayed on the diagnosis screen are obtained at the
following positions:
Semiclosed loop
error (No. 551)
Motor
+
Kp
Speed
control
Machine
om
Command
Servo amplifier
Conversion
coefficients
Time
constant
ce
nt
e
r.c
Ps
.c
nc
Pf
67
Amount of dual
position compensation (No. 553)
B62445E/03
1.9
NC STATE DISPLAY
X
Y
Z
O1000 N00010
217.940
363.233
0.000
PART COUNT
CYCLE TIME
S
MEM
***
[ ABS ]
MTN
[ REL ]
[ ALL ]
0H
0
09:06:35
[ HNDL ]
[ OPRT ]
r.c
STRT
5
0M38S
T0000
om
RUN TIME
0H15M
ACT.F
3000MM/M
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
68
Mode display
EDIT/MEM/RMT/MDI/INC
HND/JOG/REF/THND/TJOG
EDIT:
Edit mode
MEM: Memory mode
RMT:
Remote operation mode
MDI:
MDI operation mode
INC:
Incremental feed mode
(Without manual pulse
generator)
HND:
Handle feed mode
JOG:
Jog feed mode
REF:
Reference position
return mode
THND: TEACH IN NANDLE
mode
TJOG: TEACH IN JOG mode
B62445E/03
1.10
WAVE FORM
DIAGNOSTIC
FUNCTION
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
.c
nc
Notes
1 To output stored waveform data, the optional reader/punch
interface must have been installed.
2 The waveform diagnosis function is enabled when bit 0
(SGD) of parameter No. 3112 is set to 1. Note, however, that
a graphics board is necessary to display waveforms.
1.10.1
Setting Parameters
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
3112
#0
SGD
1.10.2
1. Press the
Waveform Diagnostic
Parameter Screen
B62445E/03
SYSTEM
om
INPUT
and
r.c
ce
nt
e
O1234 N12345
GRP CONDITION
(ONES TYPE)
0:START
1:START&TRG
2:START&TRG
(MEMORY TYPE)
100: DATA OF
MEMORY
1/3
TRIGGER *******
(CH1)
22
10
*******
S
08:20:52
[ W.MEM ] [
0
]
T0000
[
.c
nc
DATA NO.
11
UNIT
1000
SIGNAL
*******
>
EDIT **** *** ***
[W.PRM] [W.GRPH]
(CH2)
D Waveform diagnosis
parameters (oneshot
type)
B62445E/03
(4) Data number: The table below lists the numbers of the data items for
which a waveform can be displayed (n = 1 to 8).
Data No.
Description
Units
00
0n
1n
2n
3n
5n
RPM
6n
% (relative to
maximum current)
7n
90
Pulses
(input increments)
99
10n
om
% (relative to
maximum current)
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
11n
Pulses
(input increments)
% (relative to
maximum rotation
speed)
% (relative to
maximum output)
.c
(5) Data units: Weight of data when 1 is specified. The data units are
automatically specified for each data item and need not be set unless
the units must be changed for some reason.
[Unit] 0.001
(6) Signal address: PMC address and bit number. Set in the same way as
that for trigger, when the data number is 99.
71
D Waveform diagnosis
parameters (storage
type)
B62445E/03
Units
om
Data No.
0n
1n
2n
% (relative to
maximum current)
5n
RPM
ce
nt
e
r.c
00
6n
% (relative to
maximum current)
7n
(5) Data units: Weight of data when 1 is specified. The data units are
automatically specified for each data item and need not be set unless
the units must be changed for some reason.
nc
.c
[Unit] 0.001
(6) Signal address: Invalid
72
B62445E/03
1.10.3
Graphic of Wave
Diagnosis data
CH2
1.0
0.5
0.5
om
1.0
0.
5
0.
5
1.
0
r.c
1.
0
ce
nt
e
2. Press soft key [(OPRT)], then the following soft keys are displayed.
key.
The following three sets of soft keys are displayed by the
[START] [TIME] [TIME] [HDOBL] [HDOBL]
[START] [CH1] [CH1] [VDOBL] [VHALF]
[START] [CH2] [CH2] [VDOBL] [VHALF]
[START ]
[TIME]
[TIME]
[HDOBL]
.c
nc
1
2
3
4
B62445E/03
O1234 N12345
CH2
om
CH1
To use storage type waveform diagnosis, set 100 for the display start
condition. The maximum data width for storage type waveform diagnosis
is 32760 ms. Data must be sampled before starting drawing. The next
page explains sampling in detail.
ce
nt
e
r.c
nc
Pressing the [START] soft key loads stored data. While the data is being
loaded, SAMPLING blinks at the top of the screen. Once the data has
been loaded, a waveform is displayed. The date on which the data was
stored is displayed at the top left of the screen. If the [START] soft key
is pressed while data is being stored, storage is stopped and the waveform
for the data stored up to that point is displayed. The WAVE DIAGNOS.
(MOMORY) screen indicates whether data is being stored.
CH2
.c
CH193/01/13
O1234 N12345
74
B62445E/03
SYSTEM
] displays the [W.DGNS] soft key. Press this soft key to display the
WAVE DIAGNOS. (PARAMETER) screen.
(2) Press the [W.MEM] soft key to display the WAVE DIAGNOS.
(MEMORY) screen. The operation selection soft keys appear.
The configuration of the operation selection soft keys is as follows:
om
1.10.4
100
TRIGGER:
G0123.4
SAMPLING AXIS
XYZABCUV
XYZABCUV
XYZABCUV
NONE
NONE
XYZABCUV
TIME :
2. 0SEC
: MEMORY
ce
nt
e
r.c
DATA KINDS
POS ERROR
MOTION CMD
CURRENT (%)
SPEED (RPM)
TORQUE CMD
HEAT SIMLT
O1234 N12345
SMPL
DATE
08:20:52
] [
] [
] [START]
nc
.c
] [
] [PUNCH] [
] [
w
w
Press
[SELECT] [
] [
] [
] [START]
] [
(4) Using the cursor, set the necessary data items. To set the sampling
axes, position the cursor to the data item to be set, enter the names of
the axes for which data will be sampled for that data item, then press
[SELECT] or
INPUT
data items.
Example) XYZ + [SELECT] or
INPUT
Once the sampling axes have been selected, the sampling period for each
axis is displayed. Subsequently pressing the [START] soft key starts data
sampling.
75
B62445E/03
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
Notes
1 Data items for which ***** is displayed cannot be set.
2 To change the sampling axes, enter new axis names then
press the [SELECT] soft key. Pressing the [SLELCT] soft
key without entering an axis name results in no sampling
axis being set.
3 If the sampling axes are changed during data sampling,
data sampling is stopped. In this case, press the [START]
soft key to restart data sampling for the new sampling axes.
4 Initially, no sampling axis is set.
nc
The maximum stored data width is 32760 ms. If the storage stop
condition is not satisfied within 32760 ms, data is overwritten, starting
with the oldest data.
Parameter No. 3120 can be used to delay data storage being stopped by
a specified period (ms), after the issue of a servo alarm.
(2) Trigger: Set the PMC address and bit for the signal used to trigger the
stopping of data storage, when 101 or 102 is set for the stop condition.
Example) G0007.2: ST signal
(3) Data type: The following table lists the types of data for which a
waveform can be displayed.
Data type
Description
Units
Pulses
(detection units)
MOTION CMD
Pulses
(input increments)
.c
POS ERROR
% (relative to
maximum current)
SPEED (RPM)
RPM
% (relative to
maximum current)
%
(OVC alarm ratio)
(4) Sampling axis: The axes along which data will be sampled are
displayed.
(5) Sampling period: The sampling period for each axis is displayed.
(6) Date of storage: While data is being sampled, MEMORY blinks in this
field. When data sampling stops, the date at that point appears in this
field.
76
B62445E/03
Outputting waveform
diagnosis data
(storage type)
SYSTEM
screen.
3 Press the [W.MEM],
order.
om
1.10.5
SMPL
DATE
nc
12:15:52
] [
] [
] [PUNCH] [
] [START]
] [
Press
] [
.c
] [
G0123.4
SAMPLING AXIS
XYZABCUV
XYZABCUV
XYZABCUV
NONE
NONE
XYZABCUV
TIME :
2.0SEC
: 93/01/13 12:15:00
ce
nt
e
DATA KINDS
POS ERROR
MOTION CMD
CURRENT (%)
SPEED (RPM)
TORQUE CMD
HEAT SIMLT
TRIGGER:
r.c
CONDIGION:
O1234 N12345
] [
] [ CAN ] [ EXEC ]
Press
SYSTEM
screen.
3 Open the write protect tab on the floppy disk or card.
4 Press the [W.MEM], , [PUNCH], and [EXEC] soft keys, in this
order.
The waveform diagnosis data is output to a file named WAVE
DIAGNOS, to which the number of the last file is assigned.
If a file named WAVE DIAGNOS already exists in the floppy disk or
on the card, P/S alarm 86 is issued. A floppy disk or card can contain
only one file for waveform diagnosis data. If the existing WAVE
DIAGNOS file contains unnecessary waveform diagnosis data of
servo alarm format, delete that file before attempting to output new
data. The procedure for deleting a file is described later.
77
D Output format
B62445E/03
In the servo alarm format, the header, date and time, selected axes, and
waveform diagnosis data are output in this order. Data items are identified
by nine identifier words. Output data other than the identifier words
varies with the data type.
T(identifier word)
om
Header
Positional deviation
Move command
Actual current
Actual speed
Command current
Thermal simulation
Selected axes
Date and time
1 Header
T
ce
nt
e
C: Data word
r.c
T0 :
T60 :
T61 :
T62 :
T63 :
T64 :
T65 :
T68 :
T69 :
2 Data word
T
.c
nc
3 Selected axes
78
B62445E/03
om
r.c
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
Note
No identifier word is output for a data item for which no axis
is selected.
The above file corresponds to a paper tape of about 200 m
in length.
79
1.11
B62445E/03
Load meter of the servo axis and the serial spindle and the speed meter
can be displayed.
OPERATING
MONITOR
1.11.1
Display Method
#6
#5
OPM
#4
#3
#2
#5:(OPM)
0 : Operating monitor is not displayed.
2. Press the
POS
#0
r.c
#1
om
#7
3111
ce
nt
e
4. Press the soft key [MONI], then the operating monitor screen is
displayed.
OPERATING MONITOR
(LOAD METER)
* * *
Y :
* * * * *
0%
Z :
* * * * *
0% S1:
nc
X :
.c
RUN TIME
ACT.F
S1:
0H15M
3000 MM/M
201%
PART COUNT
CYCLE TIME
1500
5
0H 0M38S
80%
O0001 N00001
Notes
1 The bar graph for the load meter shows load up to 200%.
2 The bar graph for the speed meter shows the ratio of the current spindle speed to the
maximum spindle speed (100%). Although the speed meter normally indicates the speed of the
spindle motor, it can also be used to indicate the speed of the spindle by setting bit 6153. (OPS)
of parameter 311 to 1.
3 The servo axes for their load meters are displayed are set to parameter No. 3151 to 3. If
parameters 3151 to 3153 are all zero, the load meter of the basic axes are displayed.
4 For 10 LCD/14 CRT, the bar of the load meter that exceed 100% shows purple color.
80
B62445E/03
3152
Axis number for which the 2nd load meter for servo motor is displayed
3153
Axis number for which the 3rd load meter for servo motor is displayed
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
3151
81
B62445E/03
1.12
LIST OF OPERATIONS
Reset
Data
prote
ction
key
Function
button
POS
POS
Resetting OT alarm
At Power ON
Inputting parameters
Inputting offset values
Yes
OFF
OFF
Mode
MDI or
E.Stop
MDI
.c
Inputting setting
data
Input of PMC parameters, counter
and data table
Inputting PMC parameters (Timer,
keep relay)
Parameter
write=1
[(OPRT)] [RUNPRE][EXEC]
r.c
[(OPRT)] [PTSPRE][EXEC]
<P> and <CAN>
Function
button
OFF
Operation
SYSTEM
(PARAM)
OFFSET
SETTING
Setting no.[NO.SRH]Data<INPUT>
nc
Function
Operation
ce
nt
e
Parameter
write=1
om
Mode
Function
[PMCPRM][COUNTR] or [DATA]Data<INPUT>
MDI or
E.Stop
SYSTEM
(PMC)
[PMCPRM][TIMER] or [KEEPRL]Data<INPUT>
JOG
POS
OFFSET
Mode
Function
button
Operation
EDIT
EDIT
PROG
PROG
<N>File no.[
<N>File no.[
EDIT
PROG
OFF
Function
Heading a file
Deleting a file
Collating a program
Data
prote
ction
key
OFF
Parameter
write=1
82
B62445E/03
Function
Parameter
write=1
Mode
Function
button
Operation
" ][READ][EXEC]
OFF
EDIT or
E.Stop
SYSTEM
(PARAM)
[(OPRT)][
OFF
E.Stop
SYSTEM
(PMC)
om
Inputting parameters
OFF
EDIT
OFFSET
Registering a program
OFF
EDIT
PROG
<N>File no.<INPUT>[
OFF
EDIT
PROG
MEMO
RY
PROG
<START>
Data
prote
ction
key
Function
Parameter
write=1
EDIT
EDIT
EDIT
.c
Output of offset
Mode
SYSTEM
(PARAM)
SYSTEM
(PMC)
OFFSET
EDIT
PROG
EDIT
PROG
Output of macro
variables
EDIT
OFFSET
Operation
[(OPRT)][
" ][PUNCH][EXEC]
" ][PUNCH][EXEC]
<O>Program no.[
" ][PUNCH][EXEC]
r.c
Function
button
nc
Output of parameter
ce
nt
e
" ][READ][EXEC]
83
B62445E/03
Search
Data
prote
ction
key
Mode
Function
button
MEMO
RY
or EDIT
PROG
MEMO
RY
PROG
EDIT
PROG
EDIT
PROG
Searching an offset
number
OFFSET
Edit
Data
prote
ction
key
Deleting a program
OFF
Function
button
PROG
om
Operation
[LIB]
<O>9999<DELETE>
EDIT
PROG
OFF
EDIT
PROG
OFF
EDIT
PROG
<N>Sequence no.<DELETE>
(Deleted up to a block with a specified sequence no.)
<EOB><DELETE>
OFF
OFF
EDIT
EDIT
PROG
PROG
EDIT
PROG
Mode
Function
button
EDIT
PROG
OFF
OFF
Inserting a word
Parameter no.[NO.SRH]
PROG
Deleting a word
Changing a word
Diagnostic number[NO.SRH]
EDIT
Deleting several
blocks
Deleting a block
SYSTEM
(DGNO
S)
SYSTEM
(PARAM)
Mode
.c
Offset no.[NO.SRH]
EDIT
Display of memory
capacity used
Parameter
write=1
nc
Function
Operation
r.c
Parameter
write=1
ce
nt
e
Function
<O>Program no.<DELETE>
Collation
Function
Data
prote
ction
key
Collating memory
ON
Parameter
write=1
84
Operation
[(OPRT)][
" ][READ][EXEC]
B62445E/03
Playback
Function
Parameter
write=1
Mode
Function
button
TEACH
IN
JOG/
HANDLE
Input of NC data
Mode
Function
key
Function
Parameter
write=1
Clearing a program
At
A
Power
ON
.c
At
A
Power
ON
nc
Additional SRAM
area clear
M/T
: <RESET>AND<DELETE>
On 2path are controlled
On 2path are controlled
Path1
: <CAN>AND<1>
Path2
: <CAN>AND<2>
Loader is controlled : <CAN>AND<5>
M/T
: <RESET>
On 2path are controlled
Path1
: <RESET>AND<1>
Path2
: <RESET>AND<2>
Loader is controlled : <RESET>AND<5> (Parameter
only)
M/T
: <DELETE>
On 2path are controlled
Path1
: <DELETE>AND<1>
Path2
: <DELETE>AND<2>
Loader is controlled : <RESET>AND<5>
<PROG>AND<RESET>
ce
nt
e
At
power
ON
Parameter/offset
clear
Operation
r.c
Clear
Data
protection
key
Operation
om
Data
prote
ction
key
At
Power
ON
At
Power
ON
Note
If a PMC ladder program is stored in FROM, loading into
DRAM is not performed.
If a PMC ladder program is not stored in FROM, the ladder
area in DRAM is cleared.
85
B62445E/03
1.13
WARNING SCREEN
DISPLAYED WHEN
AN OPTION IS
CHANGED
D Warning screen
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
*1
nc
Note
This line varies with the parameter settings. Two or more
function names may be displayed.
When an option which uses the SRAM area is added, the system software
may require more SRAM than is currently installed in the system. In this
case, an allocation error screen appears the first time the system is turned
on after the addition of the option, thus restoring the state existing before
the addition.
.c
86
B62445E/03
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
Note
When the currently installed SRAM is not sufficient,
additional SRAM can be mounted. Newly installed SRAM
must be cleared before it can be used.
Operation:When turning on the power, hold down the
following keys:
<O>+<DELETE> for M/T series
<O>+<1> for twopath control (Main)
<O>+<2> for twopath control (Sub)
When installing additional SRAM, however, perform all
clear.
87
1.14
om
WARNING SCREEN
DISPLAYED WHEN
SYSTEM SOFTWARE
IS REPLACED
(SYSTEM LABEL
CHECK ERROR)
B62445E/03
r.c
BOA101
ce
nt
e
NOT READY
In this case, perform memory all clear (by holding down the
DELETE
RESET
and
MDI keys then turning on the power) or reinstall the original system
.c
nc
software.
88
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
HARDWARE
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
EXCHANGER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
.c
89
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.1
STRUCTURE
Control unit (4 slots)
CRT/MDI unit
MAIN PSU
om
OP2 OP1
Series 16
ON
01234N1234
X 123.456
Z 456.789
ce
nt
e
r.c
OFF
SERVOMOTOR
C series
SERVO
AMP
nc
SERVO AMP
AIF01A
.c
I/O LINK
90
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.2
GENERAL OF
HARDWARE
2.2.1
Series 16
Back
ground
drawing
board
Loader
control
board
MCC
function
Loader
control
function
DI/DO
40/ 40
80/ 56
104/ 72
156/120
Option 1
board
Main CPU
board
Graphic control
(CAPII)
CNC CPU
4axis
control
Spindle(x2)
CRT/MDI
PMCRBS
I/O LINK
MPG(x3)
RS232C
(x2)
CAP CPU
(CAP II)
PMC CPU
(PMCRC3)
Communication function
(Remote
buffer, DNC1,
DNC2)
ce
nt
e
I/O LINK
4axis
control
Spindle (x2)
High speed
DI
Analog I/O
.c
nc
Power
supply
2 slots
3 slots
4 slots
6 slots
8 slots
91
On/Off
control
Power
supply unit
AI/BI
Graphic
control
funtion
OPTION
MAIN
CPU
Power
supply unit
om
Back
graund
drawing
function
Option 3
board
I/O card
r.c
RISC
CPU
MCC
Board
Option 2
board
SUB CPU
RISC
board
BASIC SYSTEM
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.3
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
TOTAL CONNECTION
DIAGRAM
92
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.3.1
16TB/MB, 160TB/MB
(MAINA SPEC.)
Power unit
AC200XAC240V
ACIN (CP1)
(CP3)
om
ACOUT (CP2)
ON/OFF (CP4)
ON/OFF
CN2
CRT/MDI
CN1
unit
CK1
+24V (CP5)
For monochro. CRT, LCD
DC24V
+24E (CP6)
r.c
Main CPU
CRT (JA1)
From
Option board 1 for CAP II
MMC board for MMC
MDI (JA2)
R2321(JD5A)
Punch panel
R2322(JD5B)
MPG(JA3)
IOLINK(JD1A)
(Option 3
for PMCRC)
CPD1
CPD1
JD1B
JA1A
nc
AOUT1(JA8A)
ce
nt
e
Tape reader
Operators
panel interface
MPG 3
JD1B
JD1A
CP32
I/O
UnitA
.c
CX4
TB1
CX2B JX1B
CX1A
TB1
CX2A
Absolute
PC battery
JX1A
JY2
SPM
TB2
AMP1(JV1)
TB1
CX2B
CX2A
Emergency stop
PC
Spindle
motor
JX1B
TB1
APCBAT(JA4A)
Braker
CX3
TB2
PSM
JA7B
MCC
AC200V
CX1B
w
w
w
SPDL1(JA7A)
CX1A
AC200V
AC reactor
Braker
JX1A
6V
JA1B
SVM
TB2
(TYPEA I/F)
PC
ENC1(JF1)
1st axis or 1st axis in 1st path
SCALE1(JF21)
Servo
motor
Linear scale
93
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
(Main CPU)
AMP2(JV2)
ENC2(JF2)
SCALE2(JF22)
AMP3(JV3)
ENC3(JF3)
SCALE3(JF23)
AMP4(JV4)
SCALE4(JF24)
Option 1 board
CRT(JA1)
R4221(JD6A)
R2323(JD5C)
Remote buffer
Option 2 board
AOUT2(JA8B)
HDI(JA5)
High speed DI
r.c
AIN(JA6)
APCBAT(JA4B)
AMP5(JV5)
ENC5(JF5)
SCALE5(JF25)
AMP6(JV6)
ENC6(JF6)
SCALE6(JF26)
AMP7(JV7)
ENC7(JF7)
6V
nc
SCALE7(JF27)
ce
nt
e
SPDL2(JA7B)
AMP8(JV8)
ENC8(JF8)
SCALE8(JF28)
.c
Option 3 board
IOLINK(JD1A)
I/O card
DO1(C54)
DO2(C55)
DO3(C56)
Operators panel
DI1(C50)
om
ENC4(JF4)
Magnetics cabinet
DI2(C51)
DI3(C52)
DI4(C53)
DI5(C56)
DI6(C57)
94
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.3.2
16TB/MB, 160TB/MB,
18TB/MB, 180TB/MB
(MAINB SPEC.)
Power unit
AC200XAC240V
ACIN (CP1)
(CP3)
om
ACOUT (CP2)
ON/OFF (CP4)
ON/OFF
CN2
CRT/MDI
CN1
unit
CK1
+24V (CP5)
For monochro. CRT, LCD
DC24V
+24E (CP6)
r.c
Main CPU
CRT (JA1)
From
Option board 1 for CAP II
MMC board for MMC
MDI (JA2)
R2321(JD5A)
Punch panel
R2322(JD5B)
MPG(JA3)
IOLINK(JD1A)
(Option 3
for PMCRC)
CPD1
CPD1
JD1B
JA1A
nc
AOUT1(JA8A)
ce
nt
e
Tape reader
Operators
panel interface
MPG 3
JD1B
JD1A
CP32
I/O
UnitA
.c
CX4
TB1
CX2B JX1B
CX1A
TB1
CX2A
Absolute
PC battery
JX1A
JY2
SPM
TB2
AMP1(JV1)
TB1
CX2B
CX2A
Emergency stop
PC
Spindle
motor
JX1B
TB1
APCBAT(JA4A)
Braker
CX3
TB2
PSM
JA7B
MCC
AC200V
CX1B
w
w
w
SPDL1(JA7A)
CX1A
AC200V
AC reactor
Braker
JX1A
6V
JA1B
SVM
TB2
(TYPEA I/F)
PC
ENC1(JF1)
1st axis or 1st axis in 1st path
SCALE1(JF21)
Servo
motor
Linear scale
95
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
(Main CPU)
SERV02(JS2A)
SCALE2(JF22)
SERV03(JS3A)
SCALE3(JF23)
SERV04(JS4A)
SCALE4(JF24)
SERV05(JS5A)
5th axis servo amp or 5th axis servo amp in 1st path
SVCHK(JA26)
6th axis servo amp or 5th axis servo amp in 1st path
Connector for 5th and 6th servo check
Option 1 board
To CRT (with CAP II)
CRT(JA1)
R4221(JD6A)
R2323(JD5C)
Remote buffer
Option 2 board
AOUT2(JA8B)
r.c
Analog I/O
AIN(JA6)
High speed DI
HDI(JA5)
AMP1(JS1A2)
SCALE1(JF212)
AMP2(JS2A2)
SCALE2(JF222)
AMP3(JS3A2)
SCALE3(JF232)
AMP4(JS4A2)
6V
nc
SCALE4(JF242)
ce
nt
e
SPDL2(JA7B)
APCBAT(JA4A)
AMP5(JS5A2)
AMP6(JS6A2)
SVCHK(JA26)
.c
Option 3 board
IOLINK (JD1A)
I/O card
DO1(C54)
DO2(C55)
DO3(C56)
DI1(C50)
om
SERV06(JS6A)
Operators panel
DI2(C51)
Magnetics cabinet
DI3(C52)
DI4(C53)
DI5(C56)
DI6(C57)
96
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.3.3
18TB/MB
Power unit
AC200XAC240V
ACIN (CP1)
(CP3)
om
ACOUT (CP2)
ON/OFF (CP4)
ON/OFF
CN2
CRT/MDI
CN1
unit
CK1
+24V (CP5)
For monochro. CRT, LCD
DC24V
+24E (CP6)
r.c
Main CPU
CRT (JA1)
From
Option board 1 for CAP II
MMC board for MMC
MDI (JA2)
R2321(JD5A)
Punch panel
R2322(JD5B)
MPG(JA3)
IOLINK(JD1A)
(Option 3
for PMCRC)
CPD1
CPD1
JD1B
JA1A
nc
AOUT1(JA8A)
ce
nt
e
Tape reader
Operators
panel interface
MPG 3
JD1B
JD1A
CP32
I/O
UnitA
.c
CX4
TB1
CX2B JX1B
CX1A
TB1
CX2A
Absolute
PC battery
JX1A
JY2
SPM
TB2
AMP1(JV1)
TB1
CX2B
CX2A
Emergency stop
PC
Spindle
motor
JX1B
TB1
APCBAT(JA4A)
Braker
CX3
TB2
PSM
JA7B
MCC
AC200V
CX1B
w
w
w
SPDL1(JA7A)
CX1A
AC200V
AC reactor
Braker
JX1A
6V
JA1B
SVM
TB2
(TYPEA I/F)
PC
ENC1(JF1)
1st axis or 1st axis in 1st path
SCALE1(JF21)
Servo
motor
Linear scale
97
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
(Main CPU)
SERV02(JS2A)
SCALE2(JF22)
SERV03(JS3A)
SCALE3(JF23)
SERV04(JS4A)
SCALE4(JF24)
SERV05(JS5A)
5th axis servo amp or 5th axis servo amp in 1st path
6th axis servo amp or 5th axis servo amp in 1st path
Connector for 5th axis and 6th servo check
Option 2 board
AOUT2(JA8B)
Analog I/O
AIN(JA6)
High speed DI
HDI(JA5)
SPDL2(JA7B)
AMP1(JS1A2)
SCALE1(JF212)
AMP2(JS2A2)
SCALE2(JF222)
AMP3(JS3A2)
SCALE3(JF232)
AMP4(JS4A2)
SCALE4(JF242)
I/O card
DO1(C54)
nc
DO2(C55)
6V
ce
nt
e
APCBAT(JA4A)
om
SVCHK(JA26)
r.c
SERV06(JS6A)
DO3(C56)
DI1(C50)
Operators panel
DI2(C51)
Magnetics cabinet
DI3(C52)
.c
DI4(C53)
DI5(C56)
DI6(C57)
98
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.4
INTERMACHINE
CONNECTION
2.4.1
CRT/MDI unit
Power supply
unit
om
D Connection of Series 16
CRT/MDI
unit ,
LCD/MDI
unit or PDP/
MDI unit
(ON/OFF)
CP4
r.c
Without CAPII
CRT(JA1)
CN1
ce
nt
e
CK1
MDI(JA2)
Option 1 board
D Terminal layout
With CAPII
CRT(JA1)
nc
CP2 or CP3
200A
200B
200B
200A
2
3
.c
CP5
CN2 (CRT)
CN2
+24V
0V
0V
0V
+24V
+24V
3
+24V
CP5
CRT
1
+24V
0V
1
2
99
0V
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Cable connection
JAI (For LCD)
CN1 (For CRT)
CRT(JA1)
(01) VDR
(08) 0V
VDG (03)
0V (04)
(04) VDG
(11) 0V
om
VDR (01)
0V (02)
(05) VDB
(12) 0V
VDB (05)
0V (06)
(02) HSYNC
(09) 0V
r.c
HSYNC (18)
0V (14)
(03) VSYNC
(10) 0V
VSYNC (12)
0V (16)
ce
nt
e
Shield
Connector : Halfpitch
(PCR)
Connector: MR20pins(CRT)
Connector: Halfpitch
20pins(LCD)
MDI(JA2)
.c
nc
*KEY00
*KEY02
*KEY04
*KEY06
*COM00
*COM02
*COM04
*COM06
*COM08
*COM10
*KEY01
*KEY03
*KEY05
*KEY07
*COM01
*COM03
*COM05
*COM07
*COM09
*COM11
(01)
(02)
(03)
(04)
(05)
(06)
(07)
(08)
(09)
(10)
(11)
(12)
(13)
(14)
(15)
(16)
(17)
(18)
(19)
(20)
CK1
(01)
(02)
(03)
(04)
(05)
(06)
(07)
(08)
(09)
(10)
(11)
(12)
(13)
(14)
(15)
(16)
(17)
(18)
(18)
(20)
*KEY00
*KEY02
*KEY04
*KEY06
*COM00
*COM02
*COM04
*COM06
*COM08
*COM10
*KEY01
*KEY03
*KEY05
*KEY07
*COM01
*COM03
*COM05
*COM07
*COM09
*COM11
Shield
Connector : Halfpitch
20pins(PCR)
Connector: Halfpitch
20pins(PCR)
100
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.4.2
Reader/Puncher
Interface
D Connection
(Channel 1)
om
R2321(JD5A)
Punch panel
(Channel 2)
r.c
R2322(JD5B)
D Cable connection
R2321(JD5A)
R2322(JD5B)
ce
nt
e
Punch panel
(03) RD
RD (01)
0V (02)
DR (03)
0V (04)
0V (06)
CD (07)
0V (08)
(09)
+24V (10)
SD (11)
0V (12)
ER (13)
0V (14)
RS (15)
0V (16)
(17)
(18)
+24V (19)
(20)
(06) DR
(05) CS
(08) CD
(20) ER
(04) RS
(07) SG
(25) +24V
(01) FG
Shield
Connector : Halfpitch
(PCR)
.c
nc
(02) SD
Connector DBM25S
101
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.4.3
Manual Pulse Generator
D Connection
MPG(JA3)
om
D Cable connection
r.c
MPG(JA3)
(05)
(06)
(03)
(04)
HA1
HB1
+5V
0V
1st
HA2 (03)
HB2 (04)
+5V (18)
0V (14)
(05)
(06)
(03)
(04)
HA2
HB2
+5V
0V
2nd
HA3 (05)
HB3 (06)
+5V (20)
0V (16)
(05)
(06)
(03)
(04)
HA3
HB3
+5V
0V
3rd
ce
nt
e
HA1 (01)
HB1 (02)
+5V (09)
0V (12)
nc
Shield
Connector : Halfpitch
G
20pins(Hirose)
.c
A R
2L
V m
2A R
102
0.2 3
2 0.1 0.0394
=76.75[m]
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.4.4
I/O LINK
D Connection
+24E(CP6)
IO LINK (JD1A)
JD1B
Group #0
r.c
JD1A
I/O UnitA
PCB for standard
machine operators
panel
Operators panel
connection unit
Power Mate ,etc.
om
JD1B
Group #1
JD1A
O/E
ce
nt
e
Base #0
Optical fiber
JD1B
O/E
Base #1
(For I/O
unit A)
Terminator
Group #2
JD1A
nc
Expanded up to 16 Groups
.c
IOLINK (JD1A)
JD1B
(01) SIN
(02) *SIN
SIN (01)
*SIN (02)
Twist pair
SOUT (03)
*SOUT (04)
(03) SOUT
(04) *SOUT
0V (11)
0V (12)
(11) 0V
(12) 0V
0V (13)
0V (14)
(13) 0V
(14) 0V
Shield
(+5V) (09)
(+5V) (18)
(+5V) (20)
Connector : Halfpitch
20 pins(PCR)
(09)
(+5V)
(18)
(+5V)
(20)
(+5V)
Connector : Halfpitch
20 pins(PCR)
103
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
Note
Connect +5V when optical I/O link adapter is used. Do not connect when metal cable is used.
When metal cable is used, cable length between units is extended by 10 m.
When optical I/O link adapter is used, cable length between units is extended by 200m.
D Connection between
bases (with I/O unitA)
om
Base #1
AIF01A
AIF01A
JD1B
r.c
JD1A
JD2
JD2
JD3
ce
nt
e
Terminator
To next Group
JD2
.c
nc
S1 (01)
*S1 (02)
S2 (03)
*S2 (04)
S3 (05)
*S3 (06)
S4 (07)
*S4 (08)
S5 (11)
*S5 (12)
S6 (13)
*S6 (14)
ID1 (09)
ID2 (17)
ID3 (18)
0V (15)
0V (16)
JD3
(01)
(02)
(03)
(04)
(05)
(06)
(07)
(08)
(11)
(12)
(13)
(14)
(09)
(17)
(18)
(15)
(16)
S1
*S1
S2
*S2
S3
*S3
S4
*S4
S5
*S5
S6
*S6
ID1
ID2
ID3
0V
0V
Shield
Connector : Halfpitch
20pins (PCR)
JD2
TRM1 (04)
TRM1 (10)
TRM2 (12)
TRM2 (19)
TRM3 (14)
TRM3 (20)
Connector : Halfpitch
20pins (PCR)
104
Connector : Halfpitch
20pins (PCR)
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
When using the C series servo amplifier or series servo amplifier (type
A interface), connect the serial pulse coder cable to the NC.
When using the series servo amplifier (type B interface), connect the
serial pulse coder cable to the servo amplifier module.
2.4.5
Servo Interface
D Connection to C series
servo amplifier
AC reactor
T1
AMPx
(JVx)
200VAC230VAC
S e r v o
amp.
CN1
x:1~8
om
Power line
ENCx
(JFx)
Servo
PC motor
r.c
SCALEx
(JF2x)
APCBAT(JA4A, JA4B)
battery
6V
ce
nt
e
D Connection to cable
AMPx(JVx)
IRn (01)
GDRn (02)
*PWMAn (03)
0V (04)
*PWMBn (05)
0V (06)
*PWMCn (07)
0V (08)
(09)
*MCONn (10)
ISn (11)
GDSn (12)
*PWMDn (13)
0V (14)
*PWMEn (15)
0V (16)
*PWMFn (17)
0V (18)
(19)
*DRDYn (20)
nc
.c
w
w
w
CN1
(01) IRn
(02) GDRn
(03) *PWMAn
(04) COMAn
(05) *PWMBn
(06) COMBn
(07) *PWMCn
(08) COMCn
(09) GNDn *1
(10) *MCONn
(11) ISn
(12) GDSn
(13) *PWMDn
(14) COMDn
(15) *PWMEn
(16) COMEn
(17) *PWMFn
(18) COMFn
(19)
(20) *DRDYn
Shield
Connector : Half
pitch 20pin
Notes
1 Not used for C series amplifier.
2 Suffix n in signal name is an axis number 1 to 8.
105
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Connection to series
servo amplifier
(Interface type A)
AMPx
(JVx)
SVM
JVB
Power line
Linear scale etc.
om
ENCx
(JFx)
Servo
PC motor
SCALEx
(JF2x)
APCBAT(JA4A, JA4B)
battery
6V
r.c
D Connection to cable
AMPx(JVx)
JVxB
ce
nt
e
IRn (01)
GDRn (02)
*PWMAn (03)
0V (04)
*PWMBn (05)
0V (06)
*PWMCn (07)
0V (08)
(09)
*MCONn (10)
ISn (11)
*PWMDn (13)
0V (14)
*PWMEn (15)
0V (16)
*PWMFn (17)
0V (18)
(19)
*DRDYn (20)
nc
.c
w
w
w
x:1~8
(01) IRn
(02) GDRn
(03) *PWMAn
(04) COMAn
(05) *PWMBn
(06) COMBn
(07) *PWMCn
(08) COMCn
(09) GNDn *1
(10) *MCONn
(11) ISn
(12) GDSn
(13) *PWMDn
(14) COMDn
(15) *PWMEn
(16) COMEn
(17) *PWMFn
(18) COMFn
(19)
(20) *DRDYn
Shield
Connector : Half
pitch 20pin
Note
Suffix n in signal name is an axis number 1 to 8.
106
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Connection to series
servo amplifier
(Interface type B)
AMPx
(JSxA)
CN1
Servo
amp.
Power line
Linear scale etc.
om
r.c
D Connection to cable
AMPx(JSxA)
CN1
ce
nt
e
IRn (01)
GDRn (02)
*PWMAn (03)
0V (04)
*PWMCn (05)
0V (06)
*PWMEn (07)
0V (08)
*DRDYn (09)
*MCONn (10)
ISn (11)
GDSn (12)
*ENBLn (13)
0V (14)
PDn (15)
*PDn (16)
*PREQn (18)
0V (19)
*0V (20)
nc
.c
w
w
w
Servo
PC motor
SCALEx
(JF2x)
(01) IRn
(02) GDRn
(03) *PWMAn
(04) 0V
(05) *PWMCn
(06) 0V
(07) *PWMEn
(08) 0V
(09) *DRDYn
(10) *MCONn
(11) ISn
(12) GDSn
(13) *ELBLn
(14) 0V
(15) PDn
(16) *PDn
(17) PREQn
(18) *PREQn
(19) 0V
(20) *0V
Shield
Connector : Half
pitch 20pin
Note
Suffix n in signal name is an axis number.
107
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Connection of serial
pulse coder
ENCx(JFx)
SD (01)
*SD (02)
REQ (05)
(A) SD
(B) *SD
(T) +6V
*REQ (06)
+6V (07)
+5V (09)
+5V (20)
om
+5V (18)
(L) +5V
0V (12)
0V (14)
G
Connector : Halfpitch
20pin
r.c
(M) 0V
(U) OVA
(N) SHLD(Sheil
0V (16)
Connector : CANON
ce
nt
e
Note
Be sure to note voltage drop by cable resistance.
:
:
:
:
0.40 R 2L
M
.c
nc
0.40
R
L
M
[Ex1]A66L00010286(20/0.18,0.0394W/m) : L (Max)=23.79m
[Ex2]A66L00010157(50/0.18,0.016W/m) : L (Max)=58.59m
However, as a cable of 11 dia. cannot be clamped with the halfpitch
connector, prepare a relaying connector or fabricate the cabel by
peeling off the sheeth and covering a heatshrinkable tube.
When using the C series servo amplifier or series servo amplifier
(type A), connect the serial pulse coder to the NC.When using the
series servo amplifier (type B), connect the serial pulse coder to the
servo amplifier.
108
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
0.35
R
L
M
:
:
:
:
0.35 R
2L
r.c
om
[Ex1]A66L00010286(20/0.18,0.0394W/m) : L (Max)=21.75m
[Ex2]A66L00010157(50/0.18,0.016W/m) : L (Max)=53.57m
However, as a cable of 11 dia. cannot be clamped with the halfpitch
connector, prepare a relaying connector or fabricate the cabel by
peeling off the sheeth and covering a heatshrinkable tube.
ce
nt
e
Note
When using the C series servo amplifier or series servo
amplifier (type A), connect the serial pulse coder to the NC.
When using the series servo amplifier (type B), connect
the serial pulse coder to the servo amplifier.
Connection to C series
servo amplifier
Servo amplifier
.c
nc
Connections by Type of
Detectors
Table
CN1
PC
Servo
motor
ENC
Position + speed+rotor position
SCALE
AMP
109
2.4.6
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
Connection to series
servo amplifier
(Interface of type A)
For MAINA
of Series 16/160
SVM
Table
AMP
CN1
PC
Servo
motor
ENC
om
For MAINB
of Series 16/160
and Series 18/180
SVM
ce
nt
e
AMP
JVB
JF
PC
Servo
motor
Table
r.c
SCALE
nc
SCALE
Connection to C series
servo amplifier
Linear scale
Servo amplifier
AMP
CN1
.c
PC
PC
ENC
Servo
motor
SCALE
Position feedback
110
Separate type PC
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Connection to series
servo amplifier
(Interface of type A)
SVM
Linear scale
CN1
AMP
PC
PC
Servo
motor
ENC
om
SCALE
Position feedback
JVB
AMP
Linear scale
ce
nt
e
JF
r.c
SVM
PC
Servo
motor
SCALE
Position feedback
nc
D Associated parameters
#7
#6
#5
1815
#3
#2
Separate type PC
#1
OPTx
.c
#1 (OPTx)
#4
111
PC
Separate type PC
#0
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.4.7
Combining Serial
Spindle and Analog
Spindle
D Only serial spindle is
used
AOUT1
(JA8A)
PC
SPDL1
(JA7A)
(Note)
ce
nt
e
r.c
Serial
spindle
#2
Spindle
motor
om
Serial
spindle
#1
Main CPU
board
Spindle
motor
PC
Analog
spindle
Main CPU
board
Spindle
motor
nc
AOUT1
(JA8A)
SPDL1
(JA7A)
.c
PC
Analog
spindle
Spindle
motor
Main CPU
board
Serial
spindle
#1
AOUT1
(JA8A)
Spindle
motor
PC
SPDL1
(JA7A)
(Note)
Serial
spindle
#2
Spindle
motor
PC
112
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
om
Note
When a serial spindle amplifier is used, an optical I/O link
adapter must be used to connect the main CPU board to the
spindle amplifier. When the a series spindle amplifier is
used, the main CPU board and spindle amplifier must be
connected using a metallic cable.
2.4.8
Connection to serial
Spindle Amplifier
SPDLx
(JA7A, B)
JA7B
SPM
r.c
x:1, 2
ce
nt
e
SPDLx (JA7A, B)
SIN (01)
*SIN (02)
SOUT (03)
*SOUT (04)
(01) SIN
(02) *SIN
(03) SOUT
(04) *SOUT
(11)
(12)
(13)
(14)
(15)
(16)
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0v
Shield
Connector:Halfpitch
20pins
Connector:Halfpitch
20pin
.c
nc
0V (11)
0V (12)
0V (13)
0V (14)
0V (15)
0V (16)
113
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.4.9
Connection to Serial
Spindle Amplifier
SPDLx
(JA7A, B)
x:1, 2
Serial
spindle
amplifier
Optical fiber
JD1
COP1
CN11A
om
SPDLx (JA7A, B)
(02) SIN
(01) *SIN
SIN (01)
*SIN (02)
(04) SOUT
(03) *SOUT
r.c
SOUT (03)
*SOUT (04)
ce
nt
e
+5V (09)
+5V (18)
+5V (20)
0V (11)
0V (12)
0V (13)
0V (14)
0V (15)
0V (16)
(09)
(18)
(20)
(11)
(12)
(13)
(14)
(15)
(16)
+5V
+5V
+5V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
Shield
Connector:Halfpitch
20pins
Connector:Halfpitch
20pin
.c
nc
114
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.4.10
Connection to Analog
Spindle Amplifier
Control signal
Analog
spindle
amplifier
AOUTx (JA8A, B)
AC200V
SPDLx (JA7A, B)
Spindle
motor
Position coder
x:1, 2
om
PC
r.c
Spindle
AOUTx(JA8A, B)
SVC (07)
0V (05)
ce
nt
e
ENB1 (08)
ENB2 (09)
Connector : Halfpitch
20pins
Shield
SPDLx(JA7A, B)
Position coder
(B)
(P)
(A)
(N)
(C)
(R)
SC
*SC
PA
*PA
PB
*PB
(H) +5V
(K) 0V
Shield
Connector : Halfpitch
20pins
Connector : CANON
.c
nc
SC (01)
*SC (02)
PA (05)
*PA (06)
PB (07)
*PB (08)
+5V (09)
+5V (18)
+5V (20)
0V (12)
0V (14)
0V (16)
Connector : MR20pin
2.4.11
R2321(JD5C)
(Channel 3)
Host computer
Option 1 board
R4221(JD6A)
115
Host computer
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Example of cable
connection
Host computer
R2323(JD5C)
(02) SD
RD (01)
0V (02)
DR (03)
0V (04)
CS (05)
0V (06)
CD (07)
0V (08)
(09)
+24V (10)
SD (11)
0V (12)
ER (13)
0V (14)
RS (15)
0V (16)
(17)
(18)
+24V (19)
(20)
(20) ER
(04) RS
om
(08) CD
(03) RD
(06) DR
ce
nt
e
r.c
(05) CS
(07) SG
Shield
Connector: Halfpitch
20pins (PCR)
(25) +24V
(01) FG
.c
nc
Notes
1 Connect RS when CS is not used.
2 Connect as follows when protocol A or extended protocol A
is used:
a) Connect to ER when DR is not used.
b) Always connect CD to ER
116
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Example of RS422
cable
Host computer
R4221(JD6A)
RD
*RD
TT
*TT
RS
*RS
TR
*TR
SG
(06)
(24)
(08)
(26)
(09)
(27)
(12)
(30)
RD
*RD
RT
*RT
CS
*CS
TR
*TR
r.c
om
(04)
(22)
(17)
(35)
(07)
(25)
(11)
(29)
(19)
(01) FG
ce
nt
e
RD (01)
*RD (02)
RT (03)
*RT (04)
CS (05)
*CS (06)
DM (07)
Note) *DM (09)
0V (08)
(+24V) (10)
SD (11)
*SD (12)
TT (13)
*TT (14)
RS (15)
*RS (16)
TR (17)
*TR (18)
(+24V) (19)
(20)
Shield
Connector : Halfpitch 20
G
pins (PCR)
nc
Note
Be sure to use the twisted pair cable. Note that pin
arrangement of *DM signal on NC side is not regular to
escape from damage due to wrong connection.
2.4.12
.c
Highspeed DI Signal
Interface
HDI (JA5)
Touch sensor
D Connection diagram
HDI (JA5)
Touch sensor
117
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Connection details
HDI (JA5)
r.c
om
HDI0 (01)
0V (02)
HDI1 (11)
0V (12)
HDI2 (03)
0V (04)
HDI3 (13)
0V (14)
HDI4 (05)
0V (06)
0V (16)
HDI6 (07)
0V (08)
HDI7 (17)
0V (18)
Shield
Connector: Halfpitch
20pin (PCR)
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
Parameter 6200 and 6202 decide which signals are used for the high speed
skip signal.
118
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.4.13
Analog signal interface
CNC OPTION 2
JA6
(PCR-EV20MDT)
AIN0
11
0V
12
0V
AIN2
13
AIN3
0V
14
0V
AOUT
15
0V
16
18
19
10
0V
17
20
r.c
AIN1
om
ce
nt
e
Cable connection
AIN0
0V
AIN1
0V
AIN2
0V
AIN3
0V
nc
Analog output
AOUT
11
12
3
4
13
14
5
0V
Shield
.c
D Receiver circuit
CNC
5V
18k
36k
AIN0X3
Input voltage range 10V to +10V
36k
0V
1000k
0V
AOUT
Output voltage 10V to +10V
0V
119
0V
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.4.14
Environmental
Requirement
om
The peripheral units, such as the control unit and CRT/MDI, have been
designed on the assumption that they are housed in closed cabinets. In this
manual cabinet refers to the following:
(1) Cabinet manufactured by the machine tool builder for housing the
control unit or peripheral units;
(2) Cabinet for housing the flexible turnkey system provided by FANUC:
(3) Operation pendant, manufactured by the machine tool builder, for
housing the CRT/MDI unit or operators panel ;
(4) Equivalent to the above.
The environmental conditions when installing these cabinets shall
conform to the following table.
In operation
0 to 45
In storage or transportation 20 to 60
Change in
temperature
1.1C/minute max.
Relative
humidity
Normal :
75% or less
Temporary (with 1 month) : 95% or less
Vibration
In operation :
Environment
r.c
Room temperature
ce
nt
e
0.5 G or less
2.4.15
nc
Power Capacity
The power capacity of the CNC control unit, which in this section means
the specification required for the power supply, is obtained by adding the
power capacity of the control section and the power capacity of the servo
section.
.c
2.4.16
0.4KVA
1KVA
The CNC has been steadily reduced in size using surfacemount and
custom LS1 technologies for electronic components. The CNC also is
designed to be protected from external noise. However, it is difficult to
measure the level and frequency of noise quantitatively, and noise has
many uncertain factors. It is important to prevent both noise from being
generated and generated noise from being introduced into the CNC. This
precaution improves the stability of the CNC machine tool system.
The CNC component units are often installed close to the parts generating
noise in the power magnetics cabinet. Possible noise sources into the
CNC are capacitive coupling, electromagnetic induction, and ground
loops.
When designing the power magnetics cabinet, guard against noise in the
machine as described in the following:
120
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
The cables used for the CNC machine tool are classified as listed in the
following table :
Bind the cables in each group as described in the action column.
Group
Signal line
DC solenoid (24VDC)
Action
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
Notes
1 The groups must be 10 cm or more apart from one another
when binding the cables in each group.
2 The electromagnetic shield refers to shielding between
groups with grounded steel plates.
121
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Ground
The following ground systems are provided for the CNC machined tool:
Servo
amplifier
CNC
control
unit
ce
nt
e
Power
magnetics
unit
r.c
ground.
om
Operator s
panel
Machine
tool
nc
.c
Distribution board
Connect the signal gournd with the frame ground (FG) at only one
place in the CNC control unit.
The grounding resistance of the system gorund shall be 100 ohms or
less (class 3 grounding).
The system ground cable must have enough crosssectional area to
safely carry the accidental current flow into the system gound when
an accident such as a short circuit occurs.
(Generally, it must have the crosssectional area of the AC power
cable or more.)
Use the cable containing the AC power wire and the system gound
wire so that power is supplied with the ground wire connected.
122
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
om
Control unit
M3 or M4 terminal
for signal ground
(SG)
r.c
SG
ce
nt
e
M3
nc
Ground cable:
wire with a sectional area
of 2mm2 or more
Ground plate of
the cabinet
System ground
Connect the 0 V line of the electronic circuit in the control unit with the
ground plate of the cabinet via the signal ground (SG) terminal.
The SG terminal is located on the printed circuit board at the rear of the
control unit.
.c
F r a me
ground =
(FG)
Ground cable
123
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Noise suppressor
The AC/DC solenoid and relay are used in the power magnetics cabinet.
A high pulse voltage is caused by coil inductance when these devices are
turned on or off.
This pulse voltage induced through the cable causes the electronic circuits
to be disturbed.
To reduce the pulse voltage, use a spark killer for an AC device or a diode
for a DC device.
om
ce
nt
e
r.c
Use a spark killer consisting of a resistor and capacitor in series. This type
of spark killer is called a CR spark killer.
(A varistor is useful in clamping the peak voltage of the pulse voltage, but
cannot suppress the sudden rise of the pulse voltage. FANUC therefore
recommends a CR spark killer.)
The reference capacitance and resistance of the spark killer shall conform
to the following based on the current (1(A)) and DC resistance of the
stationary coil :
1) Resistance (R):Equivalent to DC resistance of the coil
I 2 I 2 (F)
2) Capacitance (C):
10
20
Spark killer
Motor
Spark killer
.c
nc
AC relay
The CNC cables that required shielding should be clamped by the method
shown below. This cable clamp treatment is for both cable support and
proper grounding of the shield. To insure stable CNC system operation,
follow this cable clamp method.
Partially peel out the sheath and expose the shield. Push and clamp by
the plate metal fittings for clamp at the part. Metal fittings for clamp are
attached to the control unit. The ground plate must be made by the
machine tool builder, and set as follows:
124
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
Machine side
installation
board
Ground plate
om
Control unit
r.c
Metal fittings
for clamp
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
Shield cover
125
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.5
LED DISPLAY AND
MODULE
CONFIGURATION OF
PCB
2.5.1
Power supply unit
Code
om
Name
Power supply unit AI
A16B12120900
A16B12120901
A16B12120870
A16B12120871
D LED display
This LED is lit when the input AC power voltage is supplied to CP1.
ce
nt
e
PIL(Green)
This LED is lit when overcurrent,overvoltage, or low voltage occurs in direct current output voltage.
ALM(Red)
D Disposition of
Connector, etc.
D In case of Power supply
AI and BI
A20B10050420
r.c
nc
CP1
(AC IN)
F1
CP3
(AC OUT)
.c
CP2
(AC OUT)
Battery case
PIL
ALM
LED
CP4
(CONTROL)
CP5
(24V)
CP6
(24E)
F3
F4
126
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
I/O
PSU
Fuse
24 V Input
24 V Output
DC IN
DC OUT
ce
nt
e
Battery case
.c
nc
Battery
127
CP1A
r.c
Connector
number
Abbreriation
om
Function
CP1B
CP8
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Fuse
Fuses
Ordering code
AI
A02B0200K100
A02B 0200 K100
BI
A02B0200K101
A02B 0200 K101
A02B0177K101
Symbol
Rating
F1
F3
F4
F1
F3
F4
7.5A
3.2A
5A
7.5A
5A
5A
7.5A
Individual code
A60L00010245#GP75
A60L00010075#3.2
A60L00010046#5.0
A60L00010245#GP75
A60L00010075#5.0
A60L00010046#5.0
A60L00010046#7.5R
om
Power
supply
Use
F3
F4
D Battery
200VAC input
r.c
F1
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
128
129
ON
AL
FB
A2
FA
OFF
A3
B2
COM
CP4
A1
Alarm output B3
External alarm
input
B1
Power OFF
Power ON
BAT
BAT
Trans
form
er
ALM
BATTERY
Auxil
iary
power
supply
F2/7.5A, 10A
200 VAC
input
0V
+24V
RY1
+15V
Regu
lator
A15
PWM
A10
PC
OUT
PUT
time
A15
15
+15
+24
Voltage
monitor
control
+24V
Signal
control
MAC
+5V OCL
OVP
15V
ReguOVP
lator
+5V
Regulator
MAO
+15V
ReguOVP
lator
F3/3.2A
+24V
OVP
Regulator
F4/5A
om
+5V
control
circuit
PWM
DV
r.c
VOLT
AGE
Reference
voltage
Oscil
lator
Rec
tifier
ce
nt
e
F5/0.3A
Noise
filter
ALM ON/
OFF
Control
PIL
+24V
Regu
lator
nc
RY2, 3
.c
F1/7.5A, 10A
1
2
CP1 R
200 VAC
input
CP2, 3
EN
PF (RY1)
+5V
15V
+15V
+24V
+24E
B62445E/03
2. HARDWARE
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.5.2
Main CPU Board
D Series16
Main CPU Board
MAINA4axis specification
Code
A16B32000010
A16B32000170
om
Name
MAINB6axis specification
Name
Code
D LED display
A16B32000110
r.c
Power OFF
Initial status after power on (CPU is not run yet)
STATUS JjJJ
STATUS jjJJ
STATUS JJjJ
STATUS jJjJ
STATUS JjjJ
STATUS JJJj
STATUS jJJj
STATUS Jjjj
nc
ce
nt
e
STATUS jjjj
STATUS JJJJ
j:OFF
J:ON
:Dons care
STATUS jJjj
ALARM jJJ
STATUS jJjj
ALARM jJj
STATUS JJJJ
ALARM
J
.c
STATUS jJjj
ALARM JJj
3 LED display when the system, fitted with option 2 board (with
subCPU), is not started
j:OFF J:ON
STATUS JJjj
ALARM jjj
130
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
(1)
Connector
for add on
board
(6)(7)
(8)
(9)
CRT
MDI
R2321
R2322
MPG
IOLINK
SPDL1
AOUT1
APCBAT
JA1
JA2
JD5A
JD5B
JA3
JD1A
JA7A
JA8A
JA4A
AMP1
AMP2
AMP3
AMP4
ENC1
ENC2
ENC3
ENC4
SCALE1
SCALE2
SCALE3
SCALE4
JV1
JV2
JV3
JV4
JF1
JF2
JF3
JF4
JF21
JF22
JF23
JF24
ce
nt
e
ROM for
boot
Connector Connector
number Use
name
om
LED
r.c
D D Location of modules
A16B32000010
No.
FROM
module
.c
Function
Display of system
configuration screen
FLASH ROM MODULE: 4MB
ADDITIONAL SRAM: 512KB
A20B29020092
A20B29020093
A20B29020094
DRAM
module
RAM: 6MB
RAM: 4MB
RAM: 2MB
(3)
PMC
module
A20B29010961
(4)
CRTC
module
A20B29020270 CRT
text display
A20B29020271
control
A20B29020272
A20B29020273
A20B29020275
A20B29020276
A20B29020277
A20B29020278
A20B29010980 Spindle
control
A20B29010981
A20B29010982
(2)
Specifications
A20B29020080 CNC
system,
servo
A20B29020081
system,
A20B29020082 graphic
system,
system
A20B29020090 Additional
SRAM
S
A20B29020091
nc
(1)
Name
(5)
Spindle
module
131
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
No.
Name
Specifications
Function
Display of system
configuration screen
(6)
Servo
module
A20B29020060 Servo
control
A20B29020061 3 or 4 axis
(7)
Servo
module
A20B29020060 Servo
control
A20B29020061 1 or 2 axis
(8)
Name
Specifications
Function
A20B82000010 Graphic
Graphic
function
board
display
A20B82000011 control
D Location of modules
A16B32000170
(1)
nc
Connector
for add on
board
(9)
(7)(8)
ROM for
boot
.c
(10)
132
Connector
name
Connector
number
Use
CRT
MDI
R2321
R2322
MPG
IOLINK
SPDL1
AOUT1
APCBAT
JA1
JA2
JD5A
JD5B
JA3
JD1A
JA7A
JA8A
JA4A
AMP1
AMP2
AMP3
AMP4
ENC1
ENC2
ENC3
ENC4
SCALE1
SCALE2
SCALE3
SCALE4
JV1
JV2
JV3
JV4
JF1
JF2
JF3
JF4
JF21
JF22
JF23
JF24
ce
nt
e
LED
Display of system
configuration screen
r.c
No.
om
Add on board
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
No.
Specifications
Function
Display of system
configuration screen
A20B29020350 Expanded
SRAM
A20B29020351
ADDITIONAL SRAM:256KB
ADDITIONAL SRAM:2.25MB
PMC
module
PMC MODULE:PMP2+SLC
A20B29010961
PMC MODULE:PMP2
CRTC
module
CRTC MODULE:14CRT
CRTC MODULE:14CRT
CRTC MODULE:VGA
A20B29020276
CRTC MODULE:9CRT
A20B29020277
CRTC MODULE:9CRT
A20B29020278
CRTC MODULE:VGA
A20B29010980 Spindle
control
A20B29010981
A20B29010982
DRAM:2MB
Spindle
module
nc
(6)
ADDITIONAL SRAM:768KB
om
FROM
module
DRAM:4MB
ce
nt
e
(5)
SRAM
module
A20B29020275
(4)
DRAM:6MB
A20B29020273
(3)
A20B29010940 CNC
system
A20B29010941
RAM
A20B29010942
A20B29020352
(2)
DRAM
module
r.c
(1)
Name
CRTC MODULE:9CRT
CRTC MODULE:VGA
Servo
module
(8)
Servo
module
.c
(7)
Add on board
No.
(8)
Name
Specifications
Function
A20B82000010 Graphic
Graphic
function
board
display
A20B82000011 control
133
Display of system
configuration screen
GRAPHIC ENGINE FUNCTION
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
LED
Connector
for add on
board
(8)(9)
(10)
(11)
JA1
JA2
JD5A
JD5B
JA3
JD1A
JA7A
JA8A
JA4A
SERVO1
SERVO2
SERVO3
SERVO4
SERVO5
SERVO6
SCALE1
SCALE2
SCALE3
SCALE4
SVCHK
JS1A
JS2A
JS3A
JS4A
JS5A
JS6A
JF21
JF22
JF23
JF24
JA26
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
ROM for
boot
CRT
MDI
R2321
R2322
MPG
IOLINK
SPDL1
AOUT1
APCBAT
134
r.c
Connector Connector
name
number
Use
om
D Location of modules
A16B32000110
(Total version of PC
board is 04A or older)
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
No.
Function
Display of system
configuration screen
(4)
A20B29010940 CNC
system
A20B29010941
RAM
A20B29010942
DRAM
module
ADDITIONAL SRAM:2.25MB
FROM
module
ADDITIONAL SRAM:256KB
DRAM:6MB
ADDITIONAL SRAM:768KB
om
(3)
A20B29020350 Expanded
SRAM
A20B29020351
A20B29020352
(2)
SRAM
module
Specifications
DRAM:4MB
r.c
(1)
Name
DRAM:2MB
PMC
module
PMC MODULE:PMP2+SLC
A20B29010961
PMC MODULE:PMP2
CRTC
module
CRTC MODULE:14CRT
A20B29020273
CRTC MODULE:14CRT
A20B29020275
CRTC MODULE:VGA
A20B29020276
CRTC MODULE:9CRT
A20B29020277
CRTC MODULE:9CRT
A20B29020278
CRTC MODULE:VGA
A20B29010980 Spindle
control
A20B29010981
A20B29010982
Servo
module
(8)
Servo
module
(9)
Servo
module
ce
nt
e
(5)
Spindle
module
nc
(6)
.c
(7)
135
CRTC MODULE:9CRT
CRTC MODULE:VGA
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
Add on board
No.
(8)
D Series18
Main CPU Board
Name
Specifications
Graphic
function
board
Function
Display of system
configuration screen
MAINB4axis specification
Name
om
Code
A16B22020860
MAINB6axis specification
Name
r.c
Code
D LED display
A16B32000160
D Location of modules
A16B22020860
ce
nt
e
LED
Connector Connector
name
number
Use
(1)
nc
CRT
MDI
R2321
R2322
(7)(8)
(9)
(10)
.c
Connector
for add on
board
ROM for
boot
136
JA1
JA2
JD5A
JD5B
MPG
IOLINK
SPDL-1
A-OUT1
AMP1
AMP2
AMP3
AMP4
SCALE1
SCALE2
SCALE3
SCALE4
JA3
JD1A
JA7A
JA8A
JS1A
JS2A
JS3A
JS4A
JF21
JF22
JF23
JF24
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
No.
Specifications
Function
Display of system
configuration screen
A20B29020350 Expanded
SRAM
A20B29020351
ADDITIONAL SRAM:256KB
ADDITIONAL SRAM:2.25MB
PMC
module
PMC MODULE:PMP2+SLC
A20B29010961
PMC MODULE:PMP2
CRTC
module
CRTC MODULE:14CRT
CRTC MODULE:14CRT
CRTC MODULE:VGA
A20B29020276
CRTC MODULE:9CRT
A20B29020277
CRTC MODULE:9CRT
A20B29020278
CRTC MODULE:VGA
A20B29010980 Spindle
control
A20B29010981
A20B29010982
DRAM:2MB
Spindle
module
nc
(6)
ADDITIONAL SRAM:768KB
om
FROM
module
DRAM:4MB
ce
nt
e
(5)
SRAM
module
A20B29020275
(4)
DRAM:6MB
A20B29020273
(3)
A20B29010940 CNC
system
A20B29010941
RAM
A20B29010942
A20B29020352
(2)
DRAM
module
r.c
(1)
Name
CRTC MODULE:9CRT
CRTC MODULE:VGA
Servo
module
(8)
Servo
module
.c
(7)
Add on board
No.
(8)
Name
Graphic
function
board
Specifications
Function
137
Display of system
configuration screen
GRAPHIC ENGINE FUNCTION
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
(1)
(2) (3)
Connector
for add on
board
(8) (9)
(10)
(11)
CRT
MDI
R2321
R2322
MPG
IOLINK
SPDL1
AOUT1
APCBAT
JA1
JA2
JD5A
JD5B
JA3
JD1A
JA7A
JA8A
JA4A
SERVO1
SERVO2
SERVO3
SERVO4
SERVO5
SERVO6
SCALE1
SCALE2
SCALE3
SCALE4
SVCHK
JS1
JS2
JS3
JS4
JS5
JS6
JF21
JF22
JF23
JF24
JA26
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
ROM for
boot
Connector Connector
name
number
Use
om
LED
r.c
D Location of modules
A16B32000160
138
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
No.
Specifications
Function
Display of system
configuration screen
A20B29020350 Expanded
SRAM
A20B29020351
ADDITIONAL SRAM:256KB
ADDITIONAL SRAM:2.25MB
PMC
module
PMC MODULE:PMP2+SLC
A20B29010961
PMC MODULE:PMP2
CRTC
module
CRTC MODULE:14CRT
CRTC MODULE:14CRT
CRTC MODULE:VGA
A20B29020276
CRTC MODULE:9CRT
A20B29020277
CRTC MODULE:9CRT
A20B29020278
CRTC MODULE:VGA
A20B29010980 Spindle
control
A20B29010981
A20B29010982
DRAM:2MB
Spindle
module
nc
(6)
ADDITIONAL SRAM:768KB
om
FROM
module
DRAM:4MB
ce
nt
e
(5)
SRAM
module
A20B29020275
(4)
DRAM:6MB
A20B29020273
(3)
A20B29010940 CNC
system
A20B29010941
RAM
A20B29010942
A20B29020352
(2)
DRAM
module
r.c
(1)
Name
CRTC MODULE:9CRT
CRTC MODULE:VGA
Servo
module
(8)
Servo
module
(9)
Servo
module
.c
(7)
Add on board
No.
(10)
Name
Graphic
function
board
Specifications
Function
139
Display of system
configuration screen
GRAPHIC ENGINE FUNCTION
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.5.3
Option 1 board
Name
Specifications
A16B22000913
Remote buffer
A16B22000914
DNC1
A16B22000919
Graphic (CAPII)
A16B22000918
A16B22000916
Graphic + DNC1
D LED display
Status of graphic function
r.c
jjjj
jjj
ce
nt
e
STATUS
ALARM
om
Option 1 board
Function
STATUS jJ
ALARM jjj
STATUS Jj
ALARM jjj
STATUS jj
ALARM jjj
STATUS jJ
ALARM Jjj
STATUS Jj
ALARM Jjj
STATUS jl
ALARM Jjj
STATUS ll
ALARM Jjj
STATUS lj
ALARM Jjj
STATUS lL
ALARM Jjj
STATUS Jl
ALARM Jjj
.c
nc
STATUS JJJJ
ALARM Jjj
Communication function
j:OFF,
J:ON,
STATUS JJJJ
ALARM Jjj
STATUS
jJ
ALARM jjj
STATUS
ll
ALARM jjj
140
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Location of modules
Connector Connector
name
number
Use
LED
CPU
CRT
JA1
R2323 JD5C
R4221 JD6A
(5)
Communication
function ROM
Module
(1) (2)
FBUS
back plane
connector
D Type of modules
Name
(4)
Specifications
Function
ce
nt
e
No.
(3)
r.c
JNA
om
Graphic ROM
Display of system
configuration screen
Graphic
CPU module
Not display
(2)
Graphic
engine
module
A20B29000311 Graphic
control for
TT
GRAPHIC ENGINE
MODULE 2
(3)
Graphic
engine
module
A20B29000311 Graphic
control
GRAPHIC ENGINE
MODULE 1
CRTC MODULE:
14CRT
A20B29020273
CRTC MODULE:
14CRT
A20B29020275
CRTC MODULE:VGA
A20B29010361 Communication
control
COMMUNICATION MODULE
nc
(1)
.c
(4)
Communication
control
module
(5)
CRTC
module
141
CRTC MODULE:VGA
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.5.4
Option 2 board
Series 16
Option 2 board for MAINA
Name
Specifications
Function
A16B22020400
Option 2 board
A16B22020401
Additional axis
Option 2 board
A16B22020890
Option 2 board
A16B22020891
Additional axis
r.c
Series 16
Option 2 board for MAINB
om
Option 2 board
Name
Specifications
Function
A16B22020850
Option 2 board
A16B22020851
Additional axis
ce
nt
e
Option 2 board
Series 18
Option 2 board for MAINB
Name
Specifications
A16B22020853
.c
nc
Option 2 board
142
Function
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D LED display
LED display
NC statue
When power is off
STATUS JJJJ
STATUS jJJJ
Initializing RAM
STATUS JjJJ
STATUS jjJJ
STATUS JJjJ
STATUS jJjJ
STATUS jJJj
STATUS Jjjj
r.c
STATUS jjjj
om
ce
nt
e
No.
j:OFF,
J:ON
NC statue
STATUS jJjj
ALARM jjJ
STATUS jJjj
ALARM Jjj
STATUS jJjj
ALARM jjj
j:OFF,
LED display
J:ON
NC statue
STATUS JJJJ
ALARM Jjj
STATUS JJjj
ALARM Jjj
STATUS JJjj
ALARM jjj
A RAM module of at least 2M is not mounted, or another alarm occurred. Check and replace the DRAM
module.
.c
nc
j:OFF,
LED display
J:ON
NC statue
STATUS JJJJ
ALARM jjj
On normal operation
STATUS JJJJ
ALARM jjJ
143
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Location of modules
A16B22020400 and
A16B22020401
Connector Connector
name
number
Use
LED
FBUS
back plane
connector
Name
AMP5
AMP6
AMP7
AMP8
ENC5
ENC6
ENC7
ENC8
SCALE5
SCALE6
SCALE7
SCALE8
JV5
JV6
JV7
JV8
JF5
JF6
JF7
JF8
JF25
JF26
JF27
JF28
Specifications
Function
ce
nt
e
No.
r.c
(6)(7)
JNA
JA5
JA6
JA7B
JA8B
JA4B
om
(1) (2)
HDI
A1N
SPDL2
AOUT2
APCBAT
(1)
(2)
(3)
FROM
module
SRAM
module
A20B29000541 CNC
system
A20B29010991 RAM
A20B29010940 CNC
system
A20B29010941
RAM
A20B29010942
DRAM:6MB
A20B29010984 Spindle
control
A20B29010985
A20B29010986
A20B29000280 Analog
I/O+HDI
A20B29000281 HDI
DRAM
module
Spindle
module
nc
(4)
HAM
module
DRAM:4MB
DRAM:2MB
(6)
Servo
module
(7)
Servo
module
.c
(5)
Display of system
configuration screen
144
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Location of modules
A16B22020890, 0891
Connector Connector
name
number
Use
LED
(6)
Name
AMP5
AMP6
AMP7
AMP8
ENC5
ENC6
ENC7
ENC8
SCALE5
SCALE6
SCALE7
SCALE8
JV5
JV6
JV7
JV8
JF5
JF6
JF7
JF8
JF25
JF26
JF27
JF28
Specifications
Function
ce
nt
e
No.
(7)
r.c
(1) (2)
JA5
JA6
JA7B
JA8B
JA4B
om
HDI
A1N
SPDL2
AOUT2
APCBAT
(1)
(2)
FROM
module
SRAM
module
A20B29020350 CNC
expanded
A20B29020351
RAM
A20B29020352
DRAM
module
A20B29010940 CNC
system
A20B29010941
RAM
A20B29010942
DRAM:6MB
A20B29010984 Spindle
control
A20B29010985
A20B29010986
A20B29000280 Analog
I/O+HDI
A20B29000281 HDI
nc
(3)
Spindle
module
DRAM:4MB
DRAM:2MB
.c
(4)
Display of system
configuration screen
HAM
module
(6)
Servo
module
(7)
Servo
module
(5)
145
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
LED
(1) (2)
Name
JA5
JA6
JA7B
JA8B
JA4B
JS1A-2
JS2A-2
JS3A-2
JS4A-2
JS5A-2
JS6A-2
JF21-2
JF22-2
JF23-2
JF24-2
JA8C
Specifications
Function
ce
nt
e
No.
HDI
A-IN
SPDL-2
A- OUT2
APCBAT
AMP1
AMP2
AMP3
AMP4
AMP5
AMP6
SCALE1
SCALE2
SCALE3
SCALE4
SV- CHK
(1)
(2)
SRAM
module
A20B29020350 CNC
system
A20B29020351
RAM
A20B29020352
DRAM
module
A20B29010940 CNC
system
A20B29010941
RAM
A20B29010942
DRAM:6MB
A20B29010984 Spindle
control
A20B29010985
A20B29010986
A20B29000280 Analog
I/O+HDI
A20B29000281 HDI
Spindle
module
DRAM:4MB
DRAM:2MB
.c
(4)
Display of system
configuration screen
FROM
module
nc
(3)
r.c
Connector Connector
name
number
Use
om
D Location of modules
A16B22020850, 0851
HAM
module
(8)
Servo
module
(7)
Servo
module
(8)
Servo
module
(5)
146
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Location of modules
A61B22020853
LED
Connector Connector
name
number
Use
(1) (2)
Name
AMP1
AMP2
AMP3
AMP4
JS1A-2
JS2A-2
JS3A-2
JS4A-2
SCALE1
SCALE2
SCALE3
SCALE4
SV-CHK
JF21-2
JF22-2
JF23-2
JF24-2
JA8C
Axis 1 scale
Axis 1 scale
Axis 1 scale
Axis 1 scale
Servo check
Specifications
Function
ce
nt
e
No.
r.c
(6) (7)
JA5
JA6
JA7B
JA8B
JA4B
om
HDI
A-IN
SPDL-2
A-OUT2
APCBAT
(1)
(2)
FROM
module
SRAM
module
A20B29020350 CNC
system
A20B29020351
RAM
A20B29020352
DRAM
module
A20B29010940 CNC
system
A20B29010941
RAM
A20B29010942
DRAM:6MB
A20B29010984 Spindle
control
A20B29010985
A20B29010986
A20B29000280 Analog
I/O+HDI
A20B29000281 HDI
nc
(3)
Spindle
module
DRAM:4MB
DRAM:2MB
.c
(4)
Display of system
configuration screen
HAM
module
(6)
Servo
module
(7)
Servo
module
(5)
147
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.5.5
Option 3 board
Name
Specifications
A16B32000054
PMCRC
A16B32000055
PMCRC+CAP
A16B32000057
CAP
D LED display
Status display of
PMCRC function
ce
nt
e
jjjj
jjj
r.c
STATUS
ALARM
om
Option 3 board
Function
LED display
NC statue
STATUS JJzz
STATUS jJzz
STATUS Jjzz
STATUS jjzz
nc
.c
No.
LED display
NC statue
STATUS llzz
ALARM jjj
NMI from another board (LEDs are flashing simultaneously). Check other boards LED display
STATUS jlzz
ALARM Jjj
STATUS ljzz
ALARM jjj
A bus error occurred (incorrect memory access). Replace the option 3 board.
STATUS Jlzz
ALARM jjj
STATUS Jzz
ALARM Jjj
The parity error etc. occurred in the PMC control module. Replace the PMC control module.
STATUS Llzz
ALARM jjj
148
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
LED display
NC statue
Startup status immediately after power is turned on
STATUS zzjJ
ALARM jjj
STATUS zzJj
ALARM jjj
STATUS zzjj
ALARM jjj
LED display
STATUS zzLL
ALARM jjj
STATUS zzjL
ALARM jjj
STATUS zzLj
ALARM jjj
STATUS zzLl
ALARM jjj
ce
nt
e
NC statue
r.c
STATUS JJJJ
ALARM jjj
om
LED display
j:OFF, J:ON
Description
jjJ
nc
ALARM
jJj
ALARM
jJJ
ALARM
Jjj
ALARM
JjJ
ALARM
JJj
ALARM
JJJ
.c
ALARM
149
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Location of modules
LED
Connector Connector
name
number
Use
IOLINK
(4)
(5)
JNA
Specifications
Function
ce
nt
e
Name
r.c
FBUS
Back
plane
connector
No.
Display of system
configuration screen
ROM
module for
CAP
A20B29000290 CAPII
system
A20B29000291
(2)
ROM
module for
CAP
No. display
(3)
ROM
module for
CAP
A20B29010413 DRAM+
SRAM for
CAPII
(4)
DRAM
module for
PMC
ADDITIONAL DRAM(MGR)
DRAM(APPLICATION) :2MB
A20B29020192
ADDITIONAL DRAM(MGR)
DRAM(APPLICATION) :1MB
A20B29020193
ADDITIONAL DRAM(MGR)
DRAM(APPLICATION)
:512KB
A20B29020194
ADDITIONAL DRAM(MGR)
A20B29020196
DRAM(APPLICATION) :2MB
A20B29020197
DRAM(APPLICATION) :1MB
A20B29020198
DRAM(APPLICATION)
:512KB
A20B29010960
PMC MODULE:PMP2
A20B29010961
PMC MODULE:PMP2
.c
nc
(1)
om
JD1A2
(5)
PMC
module
module
150
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.5.6
Loader Control boad
Name
Code
Function
A16B22020880
LED display
om
A16B22020560
Description
STATUS jjjj
STATUS JJJJ
The power has just been turned on, or the CPU is not
operating
STATUS jJJJ
RAM is initialized
STATUS JjJJ
STATUS jjJJ
STATUS JJjJ
STATUS jJjJ
STATUS jJJj
STATUS Jjjj
r.c
ce
nt
e
LED display
J:ON
Description
STATUS jJjj
ALARM Jjj
STATUS jJjj
ALARM jjJ
STATUS jJjj
ALARM jjj
nc
.c
151
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Location of modules
D Incase of
A16B22020560
(2)
Connector
number
Use
CNBK
CNPW
Brake output
Emergency stop
IO1
TP
(1)
Connector
name
BRAKE
ESP
LED
CNWF
CNTP
JNA
AMP1
AMP2
AMP3
AMP4
FBUS
Back
plane
connector
JV1
JV2
JV3
JV4
CRM1
CRF1
ce
nt
e
r.c
IO2
JF
om
IOLINK JD1A
AOUT JA8
APCBAT JA4
No.
Name
Specifications
Function
Display of system
configuration screen
(1)
FROM
module
(2)
DRAM
module
DRAM:4MB
PMC
module
(3)
DRAM:2MB
Servo
module
A20B29020060 Servo
control 3rd
A20B29020061 or 4th axis
(5)
Servo
module
A20B29020060 Servo
control 1st
A20B29020061 or 2nd axis
.c
nc
A20B29000143
(4)
152
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Location of modules
A16B22020880
CNBK
CNPW
Brake output
Emergency stop
CNWF
CNTP
JD1A
JA8
AMP1
AMP2
AMP3
AMP4
Name
CRM1
Specifications
Function
ce
nt
e
No.
JS1A
JS2A
JS3A
JS4A
r.c
IO- 2
om
Use
IOLINK
AOUT
(2)
Connector
number
IO1
TP
(1)
Connector
name
BRAKE
ESP
LED
Display of system
configuration screen
FROM
module
(2)
DRAM
module
DRAM:4MB
(3)
PMC
module
A20B29000143
(4)
Servo
module
A20B29020060 Servo
control 3rd
A20B29020061 or 4th axis
A20B29020060 Servo
control 1st
A20B29020061 or 2nd axis
nc
(1)
Servo
module
.c
(5)
153
DRAM:2MB
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.5.7
I/O Card
(Sink Type Output)
Name
Code
I/O card
(sink type output)
Function
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
Note
This printed circuit board has no LED display.
2.5.8
Name
Code
nc
I/O Card
(Source Type Output)
.c
I/O card
(Source type output)
Function
Note
This printed circuit board has no LED display.
154
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.5.9
I/O Cards with Power
Supply (Power C)
(Sink Type Output)
Name
Code
I/O card
(sink type output)
Function
A16B22020690 DI : 104
DO : 72
A16B22020691 DI : 80
DO : 56
A16B22020692 DI : 40
DO : 40
Power supply
PIL (Green)
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
D LED display
155
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Positions of connector
etc.
I/O
PSU
Function
Position 1
Connector
number
Abbreriation
HDI
JA5B
DIGITAL OUTPUT 1
DO1
C54
11
DIGITAL OUTPUT 2
DO1
C55
12
24V Output
DC OUT CP1B
24V Input
DC IN
Battery
CP1A
r.c
om
CP8
12
DIGITAL INPUT 1
DI1
C50
DIGITAL INPUT 2
DI2
C51
DIGITAL INPUT 3
DI3
C52
10
DIGITAL INPUT 4
DI4
C53
13
Battery case
.c
nc
PIL
LED
1
3
Fuse
ce
nt
e
11
10
156
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.5.10
I/O Cards with Power
Supply (Power C)
(Source Type Output)
Name
Code
I/O card
(sink type output)
Function
A16B22020690 DI : 104
DO : 72
A16B22020691 DI : 80
DO : 56
A16B22020692 DI : 40
DO : 40
Power supply
PIL (Green)
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
D LED display
157
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Positions of connector
etc.
I/O
PSU
Function
Position 1
Connector
number
Abbreriation
HDI
JA5B
DIGITAL OUTPUT 1
DO1
C74
11
DIGITAL OUTPUT 2
DO1
C75
12
24V Output
DC OUT CP1B
24V Input
DC IN
Battery
CP1A
r.c
om
CP8
12
DIGITAL INPUT 1
DI1
C70
DIGITAL INPUT 2
DI2
C71
DIGITAL INPUT 3
DI3
C72
10
DIGITAL INPUT 4
DI4
C73
13
Battery case
.c
nc
PIL
LED
1
3
Fuse
ce
nt
e
11
10
158
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.5.11
Background Graphic
Board
Name
Code
Background graphic
board
Function
D LED display
LED display transition when the power is turned on
The STATUS LEDs are green and the ALARM LEDs are red.
j:OFF, J:ON
No.
om
LED display
NC statue
STATUS jjjj
STATUS JJJJ
STATUS jJJJ
STATUS JjJJ
STATUS jjJJ
r.c
Initializing RAM
ce
nt
e
STATUS JJjJ
STATUS Jjjj
LED display
STATUS jJjj
ALARM Jjj
No.
LED display
J:ON
NC statue
nc
j:OFF,
j:OFF,
NC statue
STATUS JJJJ
ALARM Jjj
STATUS JJjj
ALARM Jjj
.c
159
J:ON
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
D Location of modules
(3)
Name
Specifications
Function
ce
nt
e
No.
r.c
om
(1) (2)
(1)
A20B29020350 system
RAM
A20B29020351
.c
nc
DRAM
module
160
A20B29010940 system
RAM
A20B29010941
SRAM
module
DRAM:6MB
A20B29010942
(3)
A20B29020081 Background
graphic
A20B29020082 system
A20B29020352
(2)
FROM
module
Display of system
configuration screen
DRAM:2MB
DRAM:4MB
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.6
LIST OF THE PCBS
AND UNITS
2.6.1
Control Unit Rack
Name
2 Slots
A02B0200C001
4 Slots
6 Slots
8 Slots
Series16
Control unit
rack (With
MMCIV)
4 Slots
Series18
Control unit
rack (Without
MMCIV)
MMC IV)
2 Slots
6 Slots
A02B0200C005
A02B0200C002
A02B0200C003
A02B0200C004
A02B0200C010
A02B0200C011
A02B0200C012
A02B0129C001
ce
nt
e
8 Slots
A02B0129C021
3 Slots
A02B0129C002
6 Slots
A02B0129C003
4 Slots
A02B0129C010
6 Slots
A02B0129C011
.c
nc
A02B0129C005
4 Slots
Series18
Control unit
rack (With
k
MMCIV)
161
For power
supply C
om
A02B0200C021
3 Slots
Remarks
r.c
Series16
Control unit
rack (Without
MMCIV)
MMC IV)
Drawing No.
For power
supply C
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.6.2
Power Unit
Name
Power unit
Drawing No.
AI
Remarks
A16B12120900
A16B12120901
BI
A16B12120870
A16B12120871
A20B10050420
2.6.3
Name
Drawing No.
A16B32000170
A16B32000110
A16B32000860
A16B32000160
A16B22000918
A16B22000916
Remote buffer
A16B22000913
DNC1
A16B22000914
nc
Graphic+DNC1
Graphic
A16B22020400
A16B22020890
.c
A16B22020401
A16B22020850
A16B22020851
w
w
A16B22000919
A16B22020853
A16B22020891
A16B32000055
PMCRC
A16B32000054
CAPII
Loader
control board
Remarks
A16B32000010
ce
nt
e
Main CPU
board
r.c
DC24V input
om
A16B32000057
MAINA specification
A16B22020560
MAINB specification
A16B22020880
162
A16B22020852
Servo
waveform
cannot be
displayed.
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
A (DI:40 DO:40)
A16B22000958
B (DI:80 DO:56)
A16B22000957
C (DI:104 DO:72)
A16B22000956
D (DI:104 DO:80)
A16B22000955
E (DI:40 DO:40)
A16B22000953
F (DI:80 DO:56)
A16B22000952
G (DI:104 DO:72)
A16B22000951
H (DI:104 DO:80)
Drawing No.
A16B22000950
Expansioon board
Highspeed skip signal input
only
B (DI:80 DO:56)
C (DI:104 DO:72)
A (DI:40 DO:40)
With high
speed skip
signal input
A16B22000954
A16B22020692
A16B22020691
Used as
power C
A16B22020690
A16B22000988
A16B22020728
ce
nt
e
I/O card
(source output
type)
A20B90010480
r.c
A (DI:40 DO:40)
Remarks
om
Name
B (DI:80 DO:56)
A16B22000987
A16B22020727
C (DI:104 DO:72)
A16B22000986
A16B22020726
D (DI:104 DO:80)
A16B22020725
E (DI:40 DO:40)
A16B22000983
A16B22020723
nc
F (DI:80 DO:56)
G (DI:104 DO:72)
With high
speed skip
signal input
A16B22000982
A16B22020722
A16B22000981
A16B22020721
A16B22020720
Expansion board
A20B80010150
A (DI:40 DO:40)
A16B22020852
B (DI:80 DO:56)
A16B22020851
Used as
power C
C (DI:104 DO:72)
A16B22020850
.c
H (DI:104 DO:80)
163
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
Add on board
Drawing No.
Name
Graphic function board
A20B82000010
A20B82000011
Remarks
For main
CPU board
Modules
Name
PMC control
module
om
2.6.4
Drawing No.
For PMCRE
Remarks
A20B29000140
A20B29000143
r.c
A20B29000142
A20B29010960
A20B29010961
Highspeed
DI, analog I/O
module
A20B29000280
Highspeed skip DI
A20B29000281
ROM module
1 MB
A20B29000290
768 KB
A20B29000291
ce
nt
e
A20B29000311
A20B29000350
A20B29000541
nc
A20B29000580
A20B29000991
A20B29010390
A20B29010413
DRAM
module
6MB
A20B29010940
4MB
A20B29010941
2MB
A20B29010942
.c
A20B29010980
A20B29010981
Analog
A20B29010982
Serial+analog
A20B29010984
Serial
A20B29010985
Analog
A20B29010986
For main
CPU board
164
For option 2
board
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
Name
Drawing No.
A20B29020060
A20B29020061
A20B29020080
FROM 4MB
A20B29020081
FROM 2MB
FROM/SRAM
module
A20B29020082
A20B29020090
FROM 8MB
A20B29020091
FROM 6MB
A20B29020092
A20B29020093
A20B29020094
A20B29020191
A20B29020194
A20B29020196
For option 3
2MB
r.c
1MB
A20B29020197
512KB
A20B29020198
A20B29020250
CRT control
module
For 14CRT
A20B29020270
For 9CRT
A20B29020271
For LCD
A20B29020272
A20B29020273
A20B29020275
512KB+1MB
512KB+512KB
A20B29020192
A20B29020193
nc
ce
nt
e
512KB
For 9CRT
A20B29020276
For LCD
A20B29020277
A20B29020278
A20B29020341
A20B29020343
SRAM module
256KB
A20B29020350
256KB+512KB
A20B29020351
256KB+2MB
A20B29020352
A20B29020410
A20B29020411
.c
For 14CRT
FROM/SRAM
module
FROM SRAM
module
For learning
control function
om
FROM/SRAM
module
Remarks
165
When MMC
is not pro
provided
When MMC
is provided
When MMC
is not pro
provided
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.6.5
For system without MMCIV
CRT/MDI Unit
Name
TB
A02B0120C041#TA
A02B0120C041#TAR
A02B0120C041#TAS
MB
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
r.c
Conforming to
safety standards
MB
TB
A02B0120C051#TA
A02B0120C041#MAS
TB
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0120C042#TA
A02B0120C042#MA
ce
nt
e
9CRT/MDI
(standard monochrome)
(standard,
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0120C041#MA
A02B0120C041#MAR
9CRT/MDI
(small size color)
size,
Remarks
om
9CRT/MDI
(small size monochrome)
size,
Specification
A02B0120C051#TAR
A02B0120C051#TAS
MB
Conforming to
safety standards
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0120C051#MA
nc
A02B0120C051#MAR
A02B0120C051#MAS
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
9PDP/MDI
(standard key)
TB
A02B0120C052#TA
MB
A02B0120C052#MA
TB
.c
9CRT/MDI
(standard,
(standard color)
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0120C081#TA
MB
Conforming to
safety standards
+24 V input
A02B0200C101#TBS
A02B0200C101#TBR
Conforming to
safety standards
+24 V input
Symbolic keys
A02B0120C081#MA
Conforming to
safety standards
+24 V input
A02B0200C101#MBS
A02B0200C101#MBR
Conforming to
safety standards
+24 V input
Symbolic keys
A02B0120C111
Color
166
Monochrome
A02B0120C112
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
Name
9 separatetype PDP unit
Specification
Monochrome
A02B1020C113
TB
Remarks
A02B0120C121#TA
A02B0200C100
Conforming to
safety standards
+24 V input
A02B0120C121#TAS
MB
Conforming to
safety standards
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
om
A02B0120C121#TAR
A02B0120C121#MA
A02B0120C121#MAS
TB
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0120C122#TA
A02B0120C122#TAR
ce
nt
e
Conforming to
safety standards
r.c
A02B0120C121#MAR
A02B0120C122#TAS
MB
Conforming to
safety standards
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0120C122#MA
A02B0120C122#MAR
A02B0120C122#MAS
nc
14 CRT/MDI
(color,
(color landscape type)
.c
14 CRT/MDI
(color,
(color portrait type)
TB
w
w
w
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0120C071#TA
A02B0120C071#TF
MB
TB
For CAPII
A02B0120C071#MA
A02B0120C072#TA
A02B0120C072#TF
MB
167
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0120C072#MA
For CAPII
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
Name
9.5 LCD/MDI
(color landscape type)
(color,
Specification
TB
Remarks
A02B0200C061#TB
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C061#TBS
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0200C061#TFB
For CAPII
A02B0200C061#TFBR
For CAPII
Conforming to
safety standards
om
A02B0200C061#TBR
A02B0200C061#TFBS
A02B0200C061#MB
r.c
MB
For CAPII
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C061#MBS
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
ce
nt
e
A02B0200C061#MBR
9.5 LCD/MDI
(color,
(color portrait type)
TB
A02B0200C062#TB
For CAPII
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C062#TFBS
.c
w
For CAPII
A02B0200C062#TFBR
For CAPII
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0200C062#MB
A02B0200C062#MBR
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C062#MBS
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
Color
A02B0200C050
Monochrom
e
A02B0200C081
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0200C062#TFB
MB
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C062#TBS
nc
A02B0200C062#TBR
168
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
Specification
TB
Remarks
A02B0200C071#TB
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C071#TBS
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
om
A02B0200C071#TBR
A02B0200C071#TFBR
For CAPII
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C071#TFBS
MB
For CAPII
For CAPII
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
r.c
A02B0200C071#TFB
A02B0200C071#MB
ce
nt
e
A02B0200C071#MBR
A02B0200C071#MBS
14 CRT/MDI
(color,
(color portrait type)
TB
Conforming to
safety standards
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0200C072#TB
.c
w
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0200C072#TFB
For CAPII
A02B0200C072#TFBR
For CAPII
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C072#TFBS
MB
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C072#TBS
nc
A02B0200C072#TBR
For CAPII
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0200C072#MB
w
169
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C072#MBS
A02B0200C072#MBR
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
Name
9.5 LCD/MDI
(color landcape type)
(color,
Specification
TB
Remarks
A02B0200C065#TB
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C065#TBS
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0200C065#TFB
For CAPII
A02B0200C065#TFBR
For CAPII
Conforming to
safety standards
om
A02B0200C065#TBR
A02B0200C065#TFBS
A02B0200C065#MB
r.c
MB
For CAPII
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C065#MBS
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
ce
nt
e
A02B0200C065#MBR
9.5 LCD/MDI
(color,
(color portrait type)
TB
A02B0200C066#TB
For CAPII
A02B0200C066#TFBR
nc
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0200C066#TFB
For CAPII
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C066#TFBS
MB
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C066#TBS
.c
A02B0200C066#TBR
For CAPII
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
A02B0200C066#MB
w
w
170
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0200C066#MBS
A02B0200C066#MBR
Conforming to
safety standards
Symbolic keys
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
Name
Specification
Color
A02B0200C051
TB
Remarks
A02B0120C121#TA
A02B0120C121#TAR
MB
Conforming to
safety standards
A02B0120C121#MA
A02B0120C121#MAR
TB
A02B0120C122#TA
A02B0120C122#TAR
MB
om
A02B0120C122#MA
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
A02B0120C122#MAR
171
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.7
HOW TO REPLACE
THE MODULES
2.7.1
Removing
om
2.7.2
Insertion
ce
nt
e
r.c
(1) Insert the new module board diagonally with BSIDE outward (Fig.b)
(2) While pushing on the upper edge of the module board, raise it until it
is locked (Fig.(c)).
nc
(a)
.c
No.1 pin
(b)
(c)
172
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.8
HOW TO REPLACE
THE BATTERIES
2.8.1
1.
2. The battery used for memory back up is located on the front of the main
board.
3. Remove the battery cover on the main board by holding the upper and
lower part of the battery cover and pulling it towards you. Then take
off the battery.
4. Remove the connector on the main board towards you.
If you replace the battery while the CNC power is off, you should
replace it within 30 minutes. If it will take more than 30 minutes, you
should replace the battery with power on. Or the CNC memory
contents will be lost.
5. Connect the connector of new battery.
6. Mount a battery and put the battery cover back on.
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
BATTERY
Power
supply
unit
.c
nc
Battery
unit
Connector on
PCB side
Battery
Power supply
unit front panel
Battery Replacement
Connector on
cable
173
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.8.2
1.
om
D Figure of replacing
batteries
r.c
Thread
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
5.
6.
7.
8.
Lid
174
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.9
HOW TO REPLACE
FAN MOTOR
A90L00010378
A90L00010385#A
om
1. Remove the control section printed circuit board underneath the fan to
be replaced.
2. There is a backplane inside the slot. The fan motor cable is connected
to the backplane. Grasp the left and right side of the cable connector
attached to the backplane and remove it.
r.c
3. Open the upper lid of the control section rack. Insert a philips head
screwdriver into the hole at the center front of the lid. The latch
holding the cover in place can be released by prying with the
screwdriver in the direction shown in (3) of following figure.
ce
nt
e
4. Open the lid sufficiently and remove the fan motor. Since the fan itself
is not screwed into the rack, it can be easily removed.
5. Install the new fan motor. Guide the fan motor cable through the hole
and into the rack.
6. Close the lid until the latch locks.
7. Attach the fan motor cable to the connector on the back plane. At this
time,affix the middle portion of the cable to the hooks at the back of
the rack.
nc
Fan motor
.c
(4)
Cable
Connector
Back plane
175
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.10
om
When a fuse blows in the power supply unit of the CNC, find and correct
the cause of the failure and replace the fuse.
Each fuse has a small window in which a white mark appears when the
fuse has blown.
Fig. 1 shows the fuse mounting diagram, and table 1 shows the fuse lists.
r.c
Fuse F1
ce
nt
e
Battery case
nc
PIL
ALM
Fuse F3
Fuse F4
.c
AI
Specifications
Parts specifications
F1
A60L00010245#GP75
3.2A
A60L00010075#3.2
F4
5AS
A60L00010046#5.0
F1
7.5A
A60L00010245#GP75
F3
5A
A60L00010075#5.0
F4
A02B0200K101
7.5A
F3
BI
A02B0200K100
Power
supply
Table 1. Fuses
5AS
A60L00010046#5.0
Uses
F1
F3
F4
176
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.11
MAINTENANCE OF
HEAT PIPE TYPE
HEAT EXCHANGER
om
r.c
1 When cleaning and replacing the filter, be sure to cut off the fans
electric power source.
2 Detach the filter cover and take out the filter inside.
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
3 Protect the filter from silting due to dust by blowing air on both sides.
177
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
om
ce
nt
e
r.c
nc
Detach the two installation screws (A) of the external fan unit, and detach the unit
from the main unit by sliding it down. Detach the power source cable to the fan and
the earth cable. Also detach installation screws (B).
1 Wipe the dirt, condensation, etc., which has accumulated on the fan
motor and fan installation case with a dry cloth, etc. When the
condensation, etc. has accumulated and the dirt is difficult to remove,
soak a cloth in neutral detergent, lightry sqeeze it and wipe away the
dirt.
However, take care not to allow the detergent to enter the electrical
sections such as the internal rotor of the fan motor.
.c
178
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
om
1 Detach the heat exchanger format the unit and either blow off with air,
wipe off with a dry cloth, or brush the accumulated dirt, condensation,
etc.
When the dirt is especially severe
r.c
1 Detach the internal fan unit, the terminal unit, and the cable from the
main unit.
Main unit
nc
ce
nt
e
.c
2 Using a neutral detergent, remove the dirt from the main unit fan
section by brushing. At this time, take care not to bend the fin of the
element.
3 After cleaning, dry well.
D Installation
179
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.12
HOW TO REPLACE
THE COLOR LIQUID
CRYSTAL DISPLAY
The color liquid crystal display is provided with a setting switch tuner
for precisely adjust video signal.
This setting is required for each NC unit and the cables used to display
max. quality.
D Tuning locations
TM1
r.c
SW1
om
D Others
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
180
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
2.13
This section describes the location and replacement of the LCD fuse.
r.c
om
Fuse FS1
(1) If the fuse blows, first find and eliminate the cause. Then, replace the
fuse.
D Ordering information
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
*Inhouse code
181
: A60L00010290#LM50
2. HARDWARE
B62445E/03
POS
CAN
key).
om
r.c
2.14
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
182
POS
key).
B62445E/03
om
After you change a SRAM module, you must set various data again.
This chapter describes the procedures to input and output the parameters,
the part programs and the tool offset values.
3.1 SETTING PARAMETERS FOR
INPUT/OUTPUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
r.c
ce
nt
e
(16T) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
3.5 DUMP / RESTORE OF CAPII DATE (16T) . . . . 207
.c
nc
183
B62445E/03
3.1
SETTING
PARAMETERS
FOR INPUT/OUTPUT
D Setting procedure of
parameters
1.
2. Press
OFFSET
SETTING
om
and
INPUT
r.c
4. Press
O1234N12345
INI ISO TVC
0
0
0
FCV
ce
nt
e
PARAMETER (SETTING)
0000
SEQ
0
0
0
0001
0
0
0
0012 RMV
X 0
0
0
Y 0
0
0
Z 0
0
0
B 0
0
0
0020 I/O CHANNEL
0
0
0
0
0
MIR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0 T0000
nc
.c
RESET
B62445E/03
or
,then
the cursor becomes bit length and you can set parameters bit by bit
(Bit parameter only).
(Ex.1)
1234
EOB
4567
0
0
0
1234
EOB
EOB
1234
4567
(Ex.2)
EOB
9999
0
EOB
9999
INPUT
r.c
INPUT
9999
ce
nt
e
0
0
0
3 To set the same data use
(Ex.) 1234 EOB
=
9999
1234
0
key.
om
EOB
INPUT
1234
0
1234
1234
0
0
0
4 For bit parameters,
=
EOB
=
INPUT
(Ex.) 1 1 EOB
0 0 0 00 0 0 0
00011000
00000000 00011000
00000000
000 11000
00000000
00000000
8. After the required parameters are set, set PARAMETER WRITE to
0.
.c
nc
185
B62445E/03
3.2
INPUTTING/
OUTPUTTING
DATA
om
3.2.1
Confirming the
Parameters Required for
Data Output
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
ISO
#0
#1
#0
SB2
ce
nt
e
0000
r.c
nc
#7
NFD
#6
#5
#4
#3
ASI
#2
.c
0101
186
B62445E/03
0102
Not used
Baud Rate
50
100
110
150
5:
6:
7:
8:
200
9: 2400
300 l10: 4800
600
11: 9600
1200 12: 19200 [BPS]
ce
nt
e
1:
2:
3:
4:
r.c
0103
om
3.2.2
Outputting CNC
Parameters
2.
PROG
Press PROG key and soft key PRGRM to select a program text.
nc
4. Press
SYSTEM
[EXEC].
.c
6. Press soft key [PUNCH] and [EXEC],and the parameters are started
to be output.
187
B62445E/03
3.2.3
1. Select MDI mode.
Outputting PMC
Parameters
2. Press
OFFSET
SETTING
om
4. Press
INPUT
r.c
then key
ce
nt
e
INPUT
nc
11.In DEVICE item, press soft key [FDCAS] to select the floppy cassette.
12.In KIND DATA item, press soft key [PARAM].
13.In FUNCTION item, press soft key [WRITE].
14.In FILE No item, specify a file name. In this example input as follows:
INPUT
.c
15.Press soft key [EXEC]. Then PMC parameters are started to be output.
16.After the PMC parameters have been output, set PARAMETER
WRITE to 0.
17.Press
RESET
3.2.4
SYSTEM
4. Press soft key [PUNCH] and [EXEC], then pitch error compensation
amount is started to be output.
188
B62445E/03
3.2.5
Outputting Custom
Macro Variable Values
When custom macro function is equipped, values of variable no. 500 and
later are output.
1. Press
OFFSET
SETTING
key.
om
4. Press soft key [PUNCH] and [EXEC], then custom macro variable
values are output.
Outputting Tool
Compensation Amount
r.c
3.2.6
OFFSET
SETTING
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
4. Press soft key [PUNCH] an [EXEC] key, and the tool compensation
amount is started to be output.
189
B62445E/03
3.2.7
1. Confirm the following parameters. If 1 is set, set to the MDI mode and
set it to 0.
#7
#6
#5
#4
NE9
3202
#3
#2
#1
#0
NE8
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
3.2.8
nc
.c
Inputting CNC
Parameters
0020
2 : Channel 2
3 : Channel 3
(JD5C of Option 1)
190
B62445E/03
5
0101
#7
NFD
#6
#5
#4
#3
ASI
#2
#1
#0
SB2
r.c
0102
om
FANUCFloppy cassette F1
ce
nt
e
0103
Baud rate
50
100
110
150
nc
1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
7:
8:
200
9: 2400
300 l10: 4800
600
11: 9600
1200 12: 19200 [BPS]
.c
1815
4. Press soft key [READ] and [EXEC]. Then input of parameters are
started.
5. Because alarm 300 will generate for the system with absolute pulse
coder, set parameter 1815#5 to 0.
#7
#6
#5
APCx
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
191
3.2.9
B62445E/03
Inputting PMC
Parameters
OFFSET
SETTING
screen.
4. Press
SYSTEM
om
key and
7. Press
INPUT
r.c
key.
ce
nt
e
8. Press soft key [I/O] and set the parameters required for I/O.
Item selection cursor displays the next item after an item is set.
9. In CHANNEL item , press 1
INPUT
to select channel 1.
10.In DEVICE item, press [FDCAS] key to select the floppy cassette.
11.In FUNCTION item, press soft key [READ] to input data
12.In FILE NO item, press 2
INPUT
nc
13.Press soft key [EXECT] and the PMC parameters are started to be
input.
14.After data has been read, turn off power and turn it on.
3.2.10
.c
PROG
, [F SRH], and 3
[EXEC] to select
SYSTEM
and
key.
7. Press soft key [READ] and [EXEC], then the pitch error
compensation amount is started to be input.
8. After data has been input, press
OFFSET
SETTING
B62445E/03
3.2.11
Inputting Custom Macro
Variable Values
If the system is equipped with the custom macro fucntion, input the
variable values.
For PPR, item 4 is not required.
1. Confirm that EDIT mode is selected.
2. Turn off the program protect key (KEY2=1).
PROG
om
3. Press
r.c
ce
nt
e
OFFSET
SETTING
key,
nc
9. Press 500 and soft key [NO SRH] to display variable number 500 and
confirm the custom macro variables are set correctly.
Of the data displayed, 0 and vacant differ in meaning.
Vacant is an undefined variable. To set vacant, press soft key
[INPUT].
10.Select EDIT mode again.
.c
11.Press
PROG
12.Press address O and a program number (0001 for example) ,then press
to delete the program.
DELETE
Inputting Tool
Compensation Amount
3.2.12
PROG
contents screen.
4. Press soft key [(OPRT)],
, [F SRH], and
[EXEC] to select
OFFSET
SETTING
B62445E/03
key.
7. Press [READ] key and [EXEC] key and data input is started.
3.2.13
#6
NPE
3201
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
RAL
#0
om
#6 (NPE) When programs are registered in part program storage area, M02,M30
and M99 are:
0 : regarded as the end of program.
r.c
#7
3202
#4 (NE9)
ce
nt
e
#5
#4
NE9
#3
#2
#1
#0
NE8
nc
#0 (NE8)
.c
PROG
file.
4. Press soft key [(OPRT)],
key.
6. Press soft key [READ] and [EXEC], then data input is started.
194
B62445E/03
3.3
INPUT/OUTPUT
SUPER CAP DATA
3.3.1
om
The following operation allows all the data used for Super CAP M to be
input and output in a lump.
1. Confirm the parameters shown below:
P0020: I/O CHANNEL (select I/O device) : 0
P0102: I/O device number
: 3
P0103: Baud rate
for 4800 bauds
: 10
for 9600 bauds
: 11
2. Select EDIT mode.
3. Press function key
PROG
r.c
Input/Output of
Conversational Data in a
Lump(Super CAP M)
ce
nt
e
4. Press soft key [8] (C.A.P DATA) on the basic menu screen.[Series16]
Conversational Data Screen
C.A.P DATA
.
DATA
I/O
PRE
TOOL
.c
TOOL
DRCTRY
nc
TOOL
FILE
DIVIDE
TOLDIR
DEF.
FILE
TOOL
USED
DEF.
FILE
TOOL
USED
195
PRE
TOOL
TOOL
FILE
B62445E/03
READ
PUNCH
READ
EXEC
=0
=3
@
@
@
@
@
PUNCH
EXEC
PUNCH
ALL
DATA
DEF.
FILE
ce
nt
e
DIR
r.c
om
OR
PRE
TOOL
TOOL
FILE
F.S.
FILE
< FLOPPY
DIR
PUNCH READ
EXEC
ALL
DATA
>
DEF.
FILE
PRE
TOOL
TOOL
FILE
F.S.
FILE
DEF.
FILE
PRE
TOOL
TOOL
FILE
F.S.
FILE
nc
PUNCH
EXEC
ALL
DATA
The above operation reads and punches default data, pretool list, tool file
and F.S. file in a lump.
.c
196
B62445E/03
3.3.2
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
nc
3.3.3
.c
Note
You should input/output NC parameters separately. You
can input/output other data in a lump.
197
B62445E/03
r.c
om
[CAP:HEAD-L]
SINGLE
ce
nt
e
SINGLE
1. NC PARAMETER (HD1)
7. NC PARAMETER (HD2)
2. NC OFFSET (HD1)
5. NC OFFSET (HD2)
3. NC PROGRAM (HD1)
nc
4. PMC PARAMETER
<
PUNCH
I/O
SET UP
Note
For 16TB, data select menu on tool post 2 is not displayed.
.c
READ
198
B62445E/03
PUNCH
SINGLE
SINGLE
1. NC PARAMETER (HD1)
2. NC OFFSET(HD1)
7. NC PARAMETER (HD2)
5. NC OFFSET(HD2)
3. NC PROGRAM(HD1) 6. NC PROGRAM(HD2)
om
4. PMC PARAMETER
<
NC
NC
NC
PMC
PARAM OFFSET PROG PARAM
r.c
CAP
TOOL
<
ce
nt
e
NC
NC
NC
PMC
PARAM OFFSET PROG PARAM
CAP
TOOL
CAPPROG
I/O
PREPG SELECT
SET UP
END
nc
.c
Note
NC parameters can be output only separately. If NC
parameters are selected to be output with other data, other
data is canceled.
199
B62445E/03
PUNCH
SINGLE
SINGLE
1. NC PARAMETER (HD1)
REGISTEREPROGRAMS
7. NC PARAMETER (HD2)
5. NC OFFSET (HD2)
3. NC PROGRAM (HD1)
6. NC PROGRAM (HD2)
9. CAP PROGRAM
4. PMC PARAMETER
om
2. NC OFFSET (HD1)
***HEAD 1***
00012
00110
00120
00150
00160
r.c
<
ce
nt
e
ALL
ALL
SELECT CANCEL SELECT
SELECT CANCEL
END
[ALL SELECT] Press this key to output all the programs.When you
press this key, the following menu is displayed.
EXEC REALLY? YES: [EXEC], NO: [CANCEL]]
<
EXEC
CANCEL
.c
nc
To execute punching all the programs, press [EXEC] and when it is not
needed, press [CANCEL].
200
B62445E/03
r.c
om
[ALL CANCEL]
[CAP:HEAD-L]
PUNCH
SINGLE
ce
nt
e
SINGLE
1. NC PARAMETER (HD1)
7. NC
PARAMETER (HD2)
2. NC OFFSET (HD1)
5. NCOFFSET (HD2)
3. NC PROGRAM (HD1)
4. PMC PARAMETER
nc
.c
<
I/O
SET UP
EXEC
CANCEL
Notes
1 The data format output by the above data input/output in a lump funciton is different from the
data format input/output in an individual operation. Therefore, output data by this function
cannot be used for inputting.
2 Data format is different between 16TB and 16TTB.
3 The data that can be input by the input/output in a lump function is limited to data output by the
same function.
4 The range of PMC parameters to be output can be specified by the following NC parameter.
201
B62445E/03
NC parameter
9090
PMCIOS
PMCIOS
:The start address number of D area of the PMC parameters to be output.
9091
PMCIOE
om
PMCIOE
:The end address number of D area of PMC parameters to be output.
No.9090(PMCIOS)=0, No.9091(PMCIOE)=0
: All the PMC parameters including keep relays, counters, timers and data
are output.
No.9090(PMCIOS)=No.9091(PMCIOE) : 0
r.c
: D area data of PMC parameters from the specified starting address number
to the ending address number are output.
ce
nt
e
3.3.4
1. Set optional parameters required and the parameter for setting the
number of axes (parameter no. 1010) beforehand.
2. Connect an I/O device and set the corresponding parameters required
as the same as output operation.
3. Select EDIT mode. Select Head 1 screen for path 2.
4. Release protection according to each data to input.
1) NC parameter : Set setting data PARAMETER WRITE to 1.
2) Offset amount : Turn off protection of offset data (KEY1=1).
3) NC program : Turn off program protect (KEY3=1).
4) PMC parameter : Set setting data PARAMETER WRITE to 1.
5) Tool File : Turns off offset data protection (KEY1=1)
6) CAP program : Turns off program protect (KEY3=1)
.c
nc
202
B62445E/03
[CAP:HEAD-L]
READ
SINGLE
1. NC
SINGLE
PARAMETER(HD1)
2. NC OFFSET (HD1)
7. NC
PARAMETER(HD2)
5. NC OFFSET (HD2)
om
< NC
OTHERS
NC HD2
PARAM
I/O
PRE
PARAM PG
EXE
C
ce
nt
e
PARAM
r.c
Notes
1 For path 1, data select menu on HEAD 2 is not displayed.
2 When the I/O device is other than FANUC Cassette
adapter, soft keys [NCPARAM],[OTHERS],and [NC HD2
PARAM] are not displayed.
nc
7. Rewind the data to its head when an I/O device other than FANUC
Cassette adapter is used.
When the FANUC Cassette adapter is used, since the data is called
automatically, it is not needed to execute this operation.
.c
<
[EXEC]
I/O
SET
UP
203
EXE
C
CANCEL
B62445E/03
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
204
B62445E/03
3.4
INITIAL SCREEN
om
Symbolic
FAPT TURN
INPUTTING/OUTPUTT
ING CAPII
DATA(16T)
PRESS [DATA
SET] KEY
**FAMILY PROGRAM**
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
PRESS [FAMILY
PROGRAM]
4 or 5
INPUT
:
:
:
INPUT
.c
(REFER TO TABLE 3)
205
B62445E/03
Item
Operation on I/O
device
Family program
Output
2, n
INPUT
Sub cycle
5, n
INPUT
Family program
Input
1, n
INPUT
Sub cycle
4, n
INPUT
Remarks
n=PFANUC PPR
n=BFANUC Cassette
n=CSub Memory
*When n is omitted, p
, parameter
no. 15 becomes valid.
I/O
Operation on I/O
device
Material data
5, n
4, n
INPUT
Remarks
n=PFANUC PPR
n=BFANUC Cassette
n=CSub Memory
*When n is omitted, parameter
no. 15 becomes valid.
r.c
Input
Item
om
INPUT
ce
nt
e
I/O
Item
Operation on I/O
device
Remarks
System parameter
1INPUTSAVE ENDY
7, n
INPUT
5INPUTSAVE ENDY
Tool data
11, n
INPUT
9INPUTSAVE ENDY
Setting
14, n
INPUT
Graphic data
16, n
INPUT
System parameter
2, n
INPUT
MTF
6, n
INPUT
Tool data
10, n
INPUT
Setting
13, n
INPUT
Graphic data
15, n
INPUT
System parameter
4, n
INPUT
MTF
8, n
INPUT
Tool data
12, n
INPUT
nc
INPUT
MTF
Input/
Read
3, n
Collati
on
.c
Output/
Registeration
206
n=PFANUC PPR
n=BFANUC Cassette
B62445E/03
3.5
DUMP/RESTORE OF
CAPII DATA (16 T)
The sub memory is stored in RAM module on the Option 3 board (board
for CAPII). The procedure below describes a method to input and output
the data in sub memory, which is used when Option 3 board or RAM
module is replaced.
3.5.1
System parameter (FAPTSYS. PARAM.)
MTF (FAPTMTF)
Setting data (FAPTSETTING)
Tool data
Turning tool
(FAPTTOOL)
om
1.
2.
3.
4.
C axis tool
r.c
(FAPTMATERIAL)
(FAPTSUB. CYCLE)
3.5.2
Operation
D Outputting data (Dump)
ce
nt
e
nc
[AUXILIARY] D
INPUT
.c
[AUXILIARY] D
INPUT
1. Hold
SP
INPUT
207
INPUT
B62445E/03
3.6
CLEARING CAPII
DATA (16 T)
3.6.1
Deleting File Name and
Files
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
No
.c
nc
Delete a file ?
Yes
DEL
EOB
Press [END]
INPUT
YES(Delete)
NO(Not delete)
Delete really ?
INPUT
208
INPUT
B62445E/03
3.6.2
1. Press
Clearing CAP-II
Memory
SP
INPUT
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
209
B62445E/03
r.c
om
This chapter describes the signals between the machine operators panel,
magnetics cabinet and the PMC, connection of the signals between PMC
and CNC, and confirmation method of on/off state of these signals.
It also describes system configuration of PMC, parameters of PMC,
ladder and how to display time chart of the signals on the CRT.
It also describes a method of inputting/outputting PMC parameters to an
external device.
4.1 GENERAL OF INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
4.2 SPECIFICATION OF PMC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
TABLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
210
NC
.c
G007.2
ST
X
X 0000 ~0127
PMCDGN *
STL
F0.5
211
System reserve
area
Internal relay
Variable timer
Counter
Data table
Message display
Keep relay
MTB decides
addresses
and signals
F 0000 ~ 0141
PMC address
Y 0000 ~ 0127
PMCDGN
FANUC decides
addresses
and signals
correspondence
PMCDGN *
Y0.1
STL
X5.7
+24E
DI/DO
0V
RV
0V
0V
Contacts
Open
Close
om
Tr
Off
On
Output
24V
0V
Load
Load
Off
On
Power
supply
ST2
ST1
Input
. . 0V
. . 24V
PMCDGN
[0] . . . . . .
[1] . . . . . .
PMCDGN
[0]
[1]
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
X0.1 X0.0
ST2
ST1 DOOR
PMCRB/RC
G 0000 ~ 0191
PMCDGN
w
B62445E/03
4.1
GENERAL OF
INTERFACE
B62445E/03
4.2
SPECIFICATION OF
PMC
4.2.1
Specification
Model
PMCRA1
PMCRB3
PMCRB4
PMCRC3
PMCRC4
Ladder
Ladder
Ladder
Step sequence
Ladder C
Ladder C
Step sequence
2
8 ms
2
8 ms
2
8 ms
3
8 ms
3
8 ms
5.0
(s/step)
1.0
(s/step)
1.0
(s/step)
0.10
(s/step)
0.1
(s/step)
Program capacity
S Ladder (step)
Approx. 3,000
Approx. 5,000
Approx. 5,000
Approx. 5,000
Approx. 8,000
Approx. 12,000
Approx. 8,000
Approx. 12,000
Approx. 16,000
Approx. 24,000
Approx. 16,000
Approx. 24,000
Approx. 16,000
Approx. 24,000
Approx. 16,000
Approx. 24,000
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
1 to 128KB
0.1 to 64KB
1 to 128KB
0.1 to 64KB
1 to 128KB
0.1 to 64KB
1 to 128KB
0.1 to 64KB
1 to 128KB
0.1 to 64KB
S Language only
Instruction
(Basic)
(Function)
12 kinds
48 kinds
14 kinds
67 kinds
14 kinds
67 kinds
max. 896KB
14 kinds
69 kinds
max. 896KB
14 kinds
69 kinds
Internal relay
Message request
(R)
(A)
1100 byte
25 byte
1618 byte
25 byte
3200 byte
125 byte
1618 byte
25 byte
3200 byte
125 byte
Nonvolatile
S Var. Timer
(T)
80 byte
80 byte
300 byte
80 byte
300 byte
S Counter
S Keep relay
(C)
(K)
80 byte
20 byte
80 byte
20 byte
200 byte
50 byte
80 byte
20 byte
200 byte
50 byte
S Data table
Subprogram
(D)
(P)
1860 byte
3000 byte
512 programs
8000 byte
2000 programs
3000 byte
512 programs
8000 byte
2000 programs
(L)
9999 labels
Timer No. 100
devices specified
9999 labels
Timer No. 100
devices specified
9999 labels
Timer No. 100
devices specified
9999 labels
Timer No. 100
devices specified
(I)
1024 points
max.
1024 points
max.
1024 points
max.
1024 points
max.
1024 points
max.
(O)
1024 points
max.
1024 points
max.
1024 points
max.
1024 points
max.
1024 points
max.
(I)
(O)
Flash memory
Flash memory
Flash memory
Flash memory
Flash memory
.c
Label
Fixed timer
nc
S Symbol/comment (Note 1)
S Message
Input/output
S I/O Link
S I/O card
(Note 2)
212
B62445E/03
Notes
1 Normal size of a symbol, a comment, and a message are 32KB, and 2.1KB, respectively. Max.
size of a symbol and a comment are each 64KB.
2 These points are max.points, when two sheets of I/O cards have been mounted.
Address
Model
Signal d
Si
l description
i i
FS18B
FS16B/18B
PMCRA1
PMCRB3
PMCRB4
PMCRC3
PMCRC4
X0XX127
X1000XX1019
X0XX127
X1000XX1019
r.c
Character
Ch
om
4.2.2
Internal relay
Counter
Keep relay
F0XF255
F1000XF1255
F0XF511
F1000XF1511
F2000XF2511
G0XG255
G1000X
G1225
G0XG255
G1000X
G1225
G0XG511
G1000X
G1511
G2000X
G2511
G0XG255
G1000X
G1225
G0XG511
G1000X
G1511
G2000X
G2511
R0XR999
R9000X
R9099
R0XR1499
R9000XR9117
R0XR2999
R0XR1499
R0XR2999
R9000XR9199 R9000XR9117 R9000XR9199
A0XA24
A0XA24
A0XA124
A0XA24
A0XA124
C0XC79
C0XC79
C0XC199
C0XC79
C0XC199
K0XK19
K0XK19
K0XK39
K900XK909
K0XK19
K0XK39
K900XK909
Data table
D0XD1859
D0XD2999
D0XD7999
D0XD2999
D0XD7999
Variable timer
T0XT79
T0XT79
T0XT299
T0XT79
T0XT299
L1XL9999
L1XL9999
L1XL9999
L1XL9999
P1XP512
P1XP2000
P1XP512
P1XP2000
.c
Label number
ce
nt
e
F0XF511
F1000XF1511
F2000XF2511
nc
F0XF255
F1000XF1255
X0YX127
X1000YX1019
F0XF255
F1000XF1255
X0XX127
X0XX127
X1000XX1013 X1000XX1019
Subprogram number
213
B62445E/03
4.2.3
Builtin Debug
Function
Function
Contents
Diagnostic function
S Timer
S Counter
S Keep relay
S Data table
r.c
ce
nt
e
4.2.4
om
(1) R9000 (Operation output register for the ADD, SUB, MULB, DIVB,
and COMPB functional instructions)
#7
#6
#4
#3
#2
#0
#1
nc
R9000
#5
Operation result
register
Zero
Sign is minus
Overflow
.c
(2) R9000 (Error output for the EXIN, WINDR, WINDW, MMCWR,
MMCWW, MMC3R, and MMC3W functional instructions)
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
R9000
(3) R9002 to R9005 (Operation output registers for the DIVB functional
instruction)
The data remaining after the DIVB functional instruction is executed
in output.
214
B62445E/03
(4) R9010 to R9027 (Interface area for the FNC9x functional instruction)
(PMCRC3/RC4 only)
The area is provided as an interface between the FNC9x functional
instruction to be executed and a desired function.
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
R9010
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
R9011
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
om
R9012
Addresses of the dcontrol data for SUB90
R9013
R9014
r.c
R9015
R9026
ce
nt
e
R9027
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
R9002
R9003
nc
R9004
.c
R9005
215
Register for
remainder
(used by DIVB
instruction)
B62445E/03
(5) R9100 to R9117 (Interface area for the FNC9x functional instruction)
(PMCRC3/RC4 only)
The area is provided as an interface between the FNC9x functional
instruction to be executed and a desired function.
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
R9100
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
R9101
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
om
R9102
r.c
R9105
R9116
ce
nt
e
R9117
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
.c
nc
R9091
always OFF
always ON
Cyclic signal of 200
ms (104 ms ON, 96
ms OFF)
216
B62445E/03
4.2.5
Execution Period of
PMC
Sequence program
1st level
(Highspeed sequence)
From NC
(1)
END1
om
2nd level
(Normal sequence)
(2)1
Synchronized
buffer
r.c
(2)2
(2)n
From MT
ce
nt
e
END2
END3
8msec
Period
(1)
1st level
(1)
(2)1
(2)2
.c
3rd level
(1)
nc
2nd level
3rd level
(Display sequence)
(PMCRC/RC3/
RC4 only)
217
(1)
(2)n
(2)1
B62445E/03
4.3
PMC SCREEN
4.3.1
1. Press
Display Method
SYSTEM
2. Press soft key [PMC], then PMC screen is displayed and the following
soft keys are displayed:
MONIT RUN
om
ce
nt
e
r.c
PMCLAD
PMCDGN
PMCPRM
RUN/STOP
EDIT
I/O
SYSPRM
MONIT
PMCLAD
PMCDGN
When
builtin
programmer is running.
PMCPRM
EDIT
I/O
SYSPRM
MONIT
System parameter screen
Input/output of sequence program
Editing sequence program
RUN/STOP of sequence
.c
nc
STOP
PMCRB3/RB4
(With memory card
for editing)
PMCRC3/RC4
RUN/
STOP
EDIT
I/O
SYSPRM
X:Cannot
218
B62445E/03
4.3.2
PMCLAD SCREEN
Ladder display
LADDER
LOG1
LOG1
X008.4
*ESP
om
ALWAYS1
LOG1
EMERGENCY
STOP
PORD
r.c
END1
POR
POWER ON
RESET
BOTTOM
SRCH
WSRCH
ce
nt
e
TOP
NSRCH
ADRESS
SYMBOL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
.c
D Search method
nc
D Contents displayed
Switched each
time pressed
219
B62445E/03
[Remarks]
The search function searches a signal in the forward direction and
displays the ladder with the searched signal at its head. Because there
may exist plural contacts, repeat the search operation to find plural
locations, repeat the search operation to find plural locations with the
specified signal.
If a specified signal is not found up to the end of the program (ladder),
execution returns to the head of a program and search continues.
Ladder diagram and signal status dump can displayed together.
The dump is displayed over 2 lines at the last line of ladder diagram by
pressing the [DUMP] soft key.
om
PAGE
PAGE
r.c
address.
nc
D Parameter display on
ladder diagram
ce
nt
e
.c
f : Can be
used
: Can not be
used
B62445E/03
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
Notes
;=EOB adr (trigger address) ;p1 (trigger point) ;p2 (trigger
checking number (1~65535))
nc
* Because parameters are stored in the nonvolatile memory, they are not
lost even if the power is turned off.
When bit 2 of keep relay K18 is set to 1 after parameters for sampling
are specified, the trigger function automatically starts when the power
is turned on.
For this operation, depress [TRIGER] soft key to bring the following
menu.
.c
SEARCH
ADRESS
TRGON
TRGOFF
TRIGER
WINDOW
RET
START
NEXT
DUMP
DPARA
TRGSRC
INIT
B62445E/03
This function is used for displaying the divided screen. It can display
max. six division.
For this operation, depress [WINDOW] soft key to bring the following
menu.
ADRESS
TRIGER
WINDOW
DIVIDE
CANCEL
DELETE
SELECT
WIDTH
r.c
RET
om
SEARCH
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
(1) [DIVIDE]
D ONLINE EDIT
(PMCRB3/RB4/RC3/RC4
)
When bit 1 in the keep relay K17 is 1, this function is available and
[ONLEDT] soft key is displayed.
When the ladder program is executing, a part of the ladder program can
be changed.
S Change the type of contact (A contact, B contact)
S Change address of contact and coil.
S Change address parameter of functional instruction.
This function dont change the size.
(Cannot be Addition, deletion and chanegable data size)
When bit 3 in the keep relay K18 is 1, this program is automatically
transferred to backup RAM after online edit.
When bit 3 in the keep relay K18 is 0, transfer to backup RAM with COPY
function of I/O screen. If power is off without this operation, edited data
is lost.
222
B62445E/03
4.3.3
PMCDGN SCREEN
D TITLE screen
MONIT RUN
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
TITLE
STATUS
TRACE
ALARM
nc
1st page
ANALYS
M.SRCH
2nd page
3rd page
MEMORY USED
LADDER
SYMBOL
MESSAGE
SCAN TIME
:
:
:
:
.c
223
KB
KB
KB
KB
MSEC
D STATUS screen
B62445E/03
G0000
G0001
G0002
G0003
G0004
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
ED7 ED6 ED5 ED4 ED3 ED2 ED1
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
ED15 ED14 ED13 ED12 ED11 ED10 ED9
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
ESTB EA6 EA5 EA4 EA3 EA2 EA1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
FIN
0
0
ED0
0
ED8
0
EA0
0
Signal
name
Signal state
0:Off
1:On
Signal state
om
ADDRESS
MONIT RUN
0 reverses for
0 0: On
signals with *.
r.c
SEARCH
1: Off
ce
nt
e
[Search Method]
Page key :Forward and Backward by screen
Cursor key :Forward and Backward by diagnostic number
To search a specified address or signal name, input an address number
or signal name and press [SEARCH].
D Alarm screen
MONIT RUN
STATUS
.c
nc
For details
of alarms,
refer to
Appendix
2 List of
Alarms.
ALM
TITLE
224
ALARM
TRACE
Alarm display
Blinked
B62445E/03
D TRACE screen
MONIT RUN
T.DISP
ce
nt
e
EXEC
r.c
om
TRACE MODE
:
(0:1BYTE/1:2BYTE/2:WORD)
1STTRACE ADDRESS CONDITION
ADDRESS TYPE
: (0:PMC/1:PHY)
ADDRESS
:
MASK DATA
:
2NDTRACE ADDRESS CONDITION
ADDRESS TYPE
: (0:PMC/1:PHY)
ADDRESS
:
MASK DATA
:
.c
nc
225
B62445E/03
MONIT RUN
Trace
address
and mask
data(in parentheses)
6
.
*
I
I
.
.
.
.
.
5
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
4
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
3
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
2
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
1
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
0
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
7
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
6
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
5
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
4
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
3
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
2
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
1
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
0
.
*
*
*
.
.
.
.
.
TRCPRM
om
Latest status
I mark : 1
* mark : 0
r.c
NO.
0000
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0006
0007
0008
STOP
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
#7
k017
#5
#4
#3
#2
226
#1
#0
B62445E/03
4.3.4
Memory display
(M.SRCH)
1) Pressing the [M.SRCH] soft key changes the screen to that shown in
Fig. 3.5. The displayed soft keys also change.
2) Enter a physical address in hexadecimal from which the contents of the
memory are to be displayed. Then pressing the [SEARCH] key
displays 256 byte of stored data starting from the specified address.
Example) Enter 100000, then pressing the [SEARCH] keydisplays
the contents of the memory starting from 100000H.
om
PAGE
or
PAGE
key.
r.c
ce
nt
e
To store data in memory, set bit 4 of keep relay K17 to 1, move the cursor
to a position at which the address of the data to be changed in RAM is
displayed, and enter data in units of data type in hexadecimal.
Example) Entering 0F41, then pressing the
INPUT
key stores
MONIT RUN
0000
4142
2020
5152
0000
4344
2020
5354
0000
4546
2020
5556
0000
4748
2020
5758
0000
494A
2020
595A
0000
4B4C
2020
2020
0000
4D4E
2020
2020
0000
4F50
2020
2020
QRSTUVWXYZ
100040
100050
100060
100070
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
................
................
................
................
100080
100090
1000A0
1000B0
4641
0000
0000
0000
4E55
0000
0000
0000
4320
0000
0000
0000
434F
0000
0000
0000
2E2C
0000
0000
0000
5444
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
FANUC CO.LTD....
................
................
................
1000C0
1000D0
1000E0
1000F0
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
................
................
................
................
SEARCH
INPUT
.c
nc
100000
100010
100020
100030
227
................
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOP
D ANALYS screen
(PMCRB3/RB4/RC3/RC4
)
(Ladder editing card is
required for PMCRB3/
RB4)
B62445E/03
TRIGGER ADDRESS
MONIT RUN
10 (110 SEC)
: G0007.2
(a)
(b)
(c)
TRIGGER MODE
:
0
(0: AFTER 1: ABOUT 2: BEFORE 3: ONLY)
(d)
DELETE
INIT
ADDRESS
ce
nt
e
SCOPE
r.c
om
CONDITION
:
0
(0: START 1: TRIGGERON 2: TRIGGEROFF)
.c
nc
228
B62445E/03
MONIT RUN
SIGNAL ADDRESS
SCOPE
9:
10
11
12
DELETE
Y0000.0
: R0000.1
:
:
INIT
Up to 16
signals
ADDRESS
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
a.
b.
c.
d.
X0000.0
X0000.1
X0002.0
X0005.0
13 :
14 :
15 :
16 :
om
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
r.c
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
229
B62445E/03
3 SCOPE screen
PMC SIGNAL ANALYSIS(PARAM)
MONIT RUN
SAMPLING TIME : 10 CONDITION : 1
TRIGGER ADDRESS : G0007.2 TRIGGER MODE : 0
+---------+---------+---------+------
X0000.0
X0000.1
X0002.0
X0005.0
0
om
+---------+---------+---------+------
256(MSEC)
SGNPRM
T.SRCH
ADDRESS
r.c
START
ce
nt
e
g. Cursor key
.c
nc
230
B62445E/03
4.3.5
PMCRAM Screen
1 Set to MDI mode or emergency stop state.
2 Set PARAMETER WRITE (on setting screen) to 1 or set the program
protect signal (KEY4) to 1.
PWE
f
counter
Keep relay
Data table
Either one
Either one
r.c
Timer
KEY4
om
D Inputting PMC
parameters from the MDI
ce
nt
e
INPUT
.c
nc
D TIMER screen
COUNTR
MONIT RUN
NO.ADDRESS DATA
11 T200
12 T220
13 T240
14 T260
15 T280
16 T300
17 T320
18 T340
19 T360
20 T380
KEEPRL
Timer
delay
time
(msec)
DATA
Timer set time : Timer no. 18 is max. 1572.8 sec and its accuracy is
48ms.
Timer no. 9 is max. 262.1 sec and its accuracy is 8ms.
231
D COUNTER screen
B62445E/03
This screen sets and displays max. value of counter and current value of
the counter instruction (SUB 4).
Page no. (screen is scrolled by page key)
Max. value of counter (Minimum
value is specified by counter ins.)
Current value of counter
TIMER
KEEPRL
DATA
ce
nt
e
COUNTR
PRESET
and CURRENT
can be set
up to
9999, respectively.
r.c
om
MONIT RUN
.c
nc
TIMER
DATA
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
COUNTR
KEEPRL
MONIT RUN
NO.ADDRESS
11 K10
12 K11
13 K12
14 K13
15 K14
16 K15
17 K16
18 K17
19 K18
20 K19
DATA
232
DATA
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
B62445E/03
#6
k016
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
om
k017
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
233
B62445E/03
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
k018
#7IGNDINT 0 : When the screen is switched to the PCMMDI screen, the CRT is initialized.
1 : When the screen is switched to the PCMMDI screen, the CRT is not
initialized.
*It is effective for PMCRC3/RC4
om
#5CHKPRTY 0 : The parity check is performed for the system ROM and program
ROM/RAM.
1 : The parity check is not performed for the system ROM and program
ROM/RAM.
r.c
ce
nt
e
#3TRNSRAM 0 : A ladder program is not automatically sent to the backup RAM after
online editing is completed.
#2TRGSTAT 0 : The trigger stop function does not automatically start when the power is
turned on.
1 : The trigger stop function automatically starts when the power is turned on.
#1DBGSTAT 0: In the C language debug function, the automatic break processing
does not start when the power is turned on.
nc
.c
#0IGNKEY 0 : Function keys are enabled when a user program displays the user
screen.
1 : Function keys are disabled when a user program displays the user
screen.
*This flag is effective for the PMCRC3/RC4.
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
k019
When this bit is set to 1 of the user screen, the screen cannot be switch to
the NC screen using function keys. A program which always sets this bit
to 0 or which changes the screen to the NC screen is required.
#1
#0
These bits are status of not used for PMC management software are used
by system. Do not change the values.
Usually all the bits are 0.
234
B62445E/03
MONIT RUN
No. of
data table
groups
G.DATA
G.CONT
r.c
om
INIT
NO.SRH
No. of
data table
Data length
Table
parameter
Data table
head address
Group no. of
data table
ce
nt
e
NO. OF GROUPS
c.
Group No.
nc
#5
#4
#3
#2
.c
k019
#1
#0
0 : Binary format
1 : BCD format
w
w
w
#7
TYPE
0 : 1byte length 1 : 2byte length
2 : 4byte length
235
B62445E/03
C.DATA
GSRCH
r.c
NO.ADDRESS DATA
000D0000 0
001D0001 0
002D0002 0
003D0003 0
004D0004 0
005D0005 0
006D0006 0
007D0007 0
008D0008 0
009D0009 0
MONIT RUN
om
SEARCH
ce
nt
e
Group No.
c.
Address
.c
nc
selected.
236
B62445E/03
4.4
LIST OF SIGNALS BY
EACH MODE
D Automatic operation
MODE
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL
FEED RATE,
ETC
[PMC CNC]
KEY3(Program protect key)
om
EDIT
r.c
[PMC CNC)
ST
(Cycle start)
*SP
(Feed hold)
SBK
(Single block)
DRN
(Dry run)
BDT19 (Block delete)
MI
(Mirror image)
STLK (Start lock:16T/18T)
CDZ
(Chamfering:16T/18T)
SMZ
(Inposition check:16T/18T)
PN18 (External program no. search)
MINP (External program input)
DNCI
(DNC input mode)
HS1AD
(Handle interrupt axis
select)
AFL
(Auxiliary function neglect)
FIN, MFIN2, MFIN3
(Auxiliary function complete)
MFIN, SFIN, TFIN, TFIN
(High speed M/S/T function complete)
GR1, 2 (Gear input 16T/ 18T)
*SSTP (Spindle stop)
SAR
(Spindle speed arrival)
SOR
(Spindle orientation)
ce
nt
e
A
U
T
O
M
A
T
I
C
MEM
MDI
RMT
.c
nc
O
P
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
[CNC PMC]
STL
(Cycle start LED)
SPL
(Feed hold LED)
MF, M00M31
MF2, M200M215
(Miscellaneous
function)
MF3, M300M315
SF, S00S31
(Spindle speed function)
TF, T00T31
(Tool function)
BF, B00B31
(2nd miscellaneous
func.)
DEN
(Distribution end)
OP
(automatic operating)
GR1OGR3O(Gear selection:16M/18M)
237
[PMC CNC]
*FV07
(Feed rate
override)
*AFV07
(2nd feed rate
override)
OVC
(Override cancel)
ROV1,ROV2,
HROV,
*HROV06
(Rapid traverse override)
SOV07
(Spindle
speed override)
B62445E/03
D Manual operation
MODE
[PMC CNC]
MP1, MP2
(Multiplier)
JOG
+, (Jog feed)
[PMC CNC]
RT
(Rapid traverse)
[PMC CNC]
*JV015
(Manual feedrate overid )
ride)
[PMC CNC]
ZRN(Reference position return mode)
[MT CNC]
*DEC (Reference position deceleration)
[CNC PMC]
ZP
ZP2, ZP3, ZP4
(Reference position return completion)
ce
nt
e
Z
R
N
nc
w
.c
Others
om
[PMC CNC]
HSnAD (Axis selection) n:13(No. of
MPGs)
O
P
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
D Others
FEED RATE,
ETC
Handle/
incremental
r.c
M
A
N
U
A
L
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL
+, (Man
ual feed move
command)
ROV1, ROV2
HROV
*HROV06
(Rapid traverse override)
[PMC CNC]
MD14 (Mode selection)
*ESP
(Emergency stop)
KEY14 (Memory protection key)
MLK,MLK
(All axes/ each axis machine lock)
*IT,*IT (All axes/ each axis machine lock)
*"MIT (interlock per axis and direction:M series)
STLK (Start lock:T series)
*ABSM (Manual absolute)
SVF (Servo off)
*FLWP (Follow up)
ERS
(External reset)
RRW
(Reset & Rewind)
EXLM (Stored stroke limit external switching)
"LM, RLSOT (Software limit external setting M series)
*"L (Overtravel limit)
*"ED (External deceleration of each axis)
[CMC PMC]
MA
(NC ready)
SA
(Servo ready)
AL
(NC alarm)
RST
(Resetting)
BAL
(Battery alarm)
INP
(Inposition)
MV
(Axis moving)
TAP
(Tapping)
238
B62445E/03
4.5
SIGNAL AND
SYMBOL
CORRESPONDENCE
TABLE
SYMBOL
A
PMC address
Signal names
G006.2
AFL
G005.6
*AFV07
G013.07
AL
F001.0
Alarm Signal
ALMA, B
F045.0,
F049.0
AR015
F040.07.
F041.07
ARSTA, B
G071.0.
G075.0
r.c
om
*ABSM
ce
nt
e
F001.2
BDT19
F044.0,
F045.07
BF
F007.7
BCLP
F061.1
BUCLP
F061.0
*BECLP
G038.7
*BEUCL
G038.6
B00B31
F030033
BFIN
G005.7
BGEACT
F053.4
CDZ
G053.7
Chamfering Signal
CHPA, B
F046.0
F050.0
CFINA, B
F046.1
F050.1
CON
G027.7
CSS
F002.2
CTHA, B
G070.2, 3,
G074.2, 3
.c
nc
BAL
239
B62445E/03
SYMBOL
D
PMC address
Signal names
Reference Position Return Deceleration Signal
F001.3
DM00
F009.7
DM01
F009.6
DM02
F009.5
DM30
F009.4
DNCI
F043.5
DRN
G046.7
DTCH18
G124.07
*ESP
X008.4, G008.4
ERS
G008.6
ENB
F001.4
r.c
om
X009.07
DEN
ce
nt
e
*DEC18
F038.2, 3
EF
F008.0
EFIN
G005.1
*"ED18
G118.07
G120.07
ESTB
G002.7
EA06
G002.06
ED015
G000.07
G001.07
EREND
F060.0
ESEND
F060.1
ENBKY
F053.7
EXSTP
G058.2
EXWT
G058.3
EXRD
G058.1
EXLM
G007.6
FIN
G004.3
*FLWP
G007.5
Followup Signal
F1D
G016.7
FSCSL
F044.1
*FV07
G012.07
.c
nc
ENB2, 3
240
B62445E/03
SYMBOL
G
PMC address
Signal names
F034.02
GR
G028.1, 2
G029.02
GOQSM
H
GR 0
G039.7
HA, HB
HSIAD
G041.07
G042.03
HROV
G096.7
*HROV06
G096.06
*IT
G008.0
*IT18
G130.07
INHKY
F053.0
INCH
F002.0
INP18
F104.07
Inposition Signal
*JV015
G010011
"JIJ8
G100.07
G102.07
KEY14
G046.36
*"L18
G114.07
G116.07
"LM18
G110.07
G112.07
MA
F001.7
NC Ready Signal
MABSM
F004.2
MAFL
F004.4
MBDT19
F004.0
F005.07
MCFNA, B
G071.3
G075.3
MD14
G043.02
MDRN
F002.7
MD1040
F073.02
MDTCH18
F110.07
MEDT
F003.6
r.c
All Axis Interlock Signal
ce
nt
e
om
HSnAD
nc
.c
241
B62445E/03
SYMBOL
M
PMC address
Signal names
G058.0
"MIT12
(Tseries)
X004.25
"MIT14
(Mseries)
G132.03
G134.03
MI18
G106.07
MF
F007.0
MF2
F008.4
MF3
F008.5
MFIN
G005.0
M00M31
F01013
M200215
F014015
M300315
F016017
r.c
om
MINP
ce
nt
e
G044.1
MLK18
G108.07
MH
F003.1
MINC
F003.0
MJ
F003.2
MMDI
F003.3
MMEM
F003.5
MMLK
F004.1
MMI18
F108.07
MP1, MP2
G019.4, 5
MRDYA, B
G070.7
G074.7
MRMT
F003.4
MREF
F004.6
MSBK
F004.3
MTCHIN
F003.7
MV18
F102.07
MVD18
F106.07
OFN05
G039.05
OP
F000.7
.c
nc
MLK
242
B62445E/03
SYMBOL
O
PMC address
Signal names
G070.6
G074.6
OUT07
F072.07
OVC
P
ORCMA, B
G006.4
PA, PB
PN18
G009.03
PRC
G040.6
PRGDPL
F053.1
PRTSF
F062.7
PSW110
F070.0
F071.2
RCHA, B
G071.7
G075.7
RCHPA, B
F046.2
F050.2
RCFNA, B
F046.3
F050.3
RGTAP
G061.0
RGSPM
F065.1
RGSPP
F065.0
RLSOT
G007.7
ROV1, 2
G014.0, 1
R01I12I
G032.0
R01O120
G036.0G037.3
RPD0
F002.1
RPBSY
F053.2
RPALM
F053.3
RRW
G008.6
RSLA, B
G071.6
G075.6
RST
F001.1
Reset Signal
RT
G019.7
RWD
F000.0
Rewinding Signal
r.c
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
G028.7
om
PC2SLC
243
B62445E/03
SYMBOL
S
PMC address
Signal names
F000.6
SBK
G046.1
ST
G007.2
STL
F000.5
*SP
G008.5
SPL
F000.4
SF
F007.2
S00S31
F022025
SFIN
G005.2
SFRA, B
G070.5
G074.5
SRVA, B
G070.4
G074.4
r.c
om
SA
ce
nt
e
SVC
G029.4
*SSTP
G029.6
*SSTP2, 3
G027.4, 5
SOR
G029.5
SOV07
G030
SOCNA, B
G071.4
G075.4
SVF18
G126.07
STLK
G007.1
SKIP
X004.7
Skip Signal
SIND
G033.7
SSIN
G033.6
SGN
G033.5
SRN
G006.0
SMZ
G053.6
SPAL
F035.0
SPSTP
G028.6
SCLP
F038.0
SUCLP
F038.1
.c
nc
SAR
244
B62445E/03
SYMBOL
S
PMC address
Signal names
G028.5
*SUCPF
G028.4
SPPHS
G038.3
SPSYC
G038.2
SPSLA, B
G071.2
G075.2
STRD
G058.5
STWD
G058.6
SWS13
G027.02
SYNC14
G138.03
SUNC4J
G140.3
r.c
om
*SCPF
ce
nt
e
F001.5
TF
F007.3
T00T31
F026029
TFIN
G005.3
THRD
F002.3
TL1256
G047.07
G048.0
TLRST
G048.7
TLSKP
G048.5
TLCH
F064.0
TLNW
F064.1
TLMLA, B
G070.0
G074.0
TLMHA, B
G070.1
G074.1
TMRON
G053.0
UI0UI15
G054055
UO0131
F054059
UINT
G053.3
.c
nc
TAP
245
B62445E/03
SYMBOL
W WOSQM
PMC address
Signal names
Work Coordinate System Shift Amount Write
Mode Signal
WOSET
G040.7
XAE
X004.0
YAE
X004.1
ZRN
G043.7
ZP18
F094.07
ZP2128
F096.07
ZP3138
F098.07
ZP4148
F100.07
ZRF18
F102.07
ZAE
X004.2
r.c
om
G039.6
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
246
5. DIGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
DIGITAL SERVO
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
247
5. DEGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
5.1
This section describes how to set initial servo parameters, which is used
for field adjustment of machine tool.
INITIAL SETTING
SERVO PARAMETERS
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
3111
#0
SVS
om
SYSTEM
key
[SV.PARA].
r.c
5. Input data required for initial setting using the cursor and page key.
SERVO SETTING
Y AXIS
00000000
47
00000000
2
1
125
111
8192
12500
8000
nc
ce
nt
e
X AXIS
(1)INITIAL SET BIT 00000000
(2)MOTOR ID NO.
47
(3)amr
00000000
(4)cmr
2
(5)FEED GEAR N
1
(6)
(N/M) M
125
(7)DIRECTION SET
111
(8)VELOCITY PULSE NO. 8192
(9)POSITION PULSE NO. 12500
(10)REF.COUNTER
8000
PRM
PRM
PRM
PRM
PRM
PRM
PRM
PRM
PRM
PRM
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
PRMCAL
#2
#1
DGPRM
#0
PLC01
.c
2000
248
2000
2020
2001
1820
2084
2085
2022
2023
2024
1821
5. DIGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
2020
54
56
57
58
59
60
Drawing
number
0531
0506
0561
0562
0564
0571
0572
50
30/
2000
0L
(Item of xxxx)
Model
name
om
Format
number
5L
6L
7L
10L
44
Drawing
number
0532
0433
0371
0372
Model
name
40S
30S
20SP
Format
number
50
51
0315
10S
46
48
49
0313
0314
0316
10SP
0S
5S
6S
52
53
80
82
0505
0502
0590
0382
0384
20S/
1500
20S
30S
5T
10T
ce
nt
e
(Item of xxxx)
45
Drawing
number
47
r.c
Format
number
(Item of xxxx)
Model
name
nc
.c
Format
number
40
41
0331
0332
0333
50S
Drawing
number
39
60S
70S
(Item of xxxx)
Model
name
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
Drawing
number
0371
0373
0313
0514
0317
0318
0319
Model
name
20SP
10SP/
0S
5S/
3000
10S/
3000
20S/
3000
30S/
3000
Format
number
73
78
79
81
83
84
Drawing
number
0320
0583
0381
0383
0385
0374
6S/
3000
40S/
2000
0T/
3000
5T/
3000
10T/
3000
00SP
(Item of xxxx)
(Item of xxxx)
Model
name
249
5. DEGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
68
69
70
71
72
Drawing
number
0561
0562
0564
0571
0572
0L/
3000
5L/
3000
6L/
3000
7L/
3000
10L/
2250
(Item of xxxx)
Model
name
Format
number
15
16
17
Drawing
number
0123
0127
0128
Model
name
3/
3000
6/
2000
6/
3000
Format
number
22
23
Drawing
number
0152
30/
2000
om
6 For a series(A06BxxxxBVVV)
18
19
20
21
0142
0143
0147
0148
12/
2000
12/
3000
22/
2000
22/
3000
24
25
26
0153
0161
0162
0163
30/
3000
M3
M6
M9
ce
nt
e
r.c
(Item of xxxx)
(Item of xxxx)
Model
name
2001
#7
AMR7
#6
AMR6
#5
AMR5
#4
AMR4
#3
AMR4
#2
AMR3
#1
AMR2
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
nc
#7
.c
250
#0
AMR1
Motor model
50S
40S, 30S
other than above
5. DIGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
(4) CMR
DGN
1820
1
+100
CMR
Set value=2CMR
Set value=
FRM
2084
FRM
2085
om
n
m
r.c
ce
nt
e
For serial pulse coder B, set 250,000 pulses or less to parameter 2084.
Examples
Examples of calculation
1/1000 mm
1 rotation
of motor
8mm n=1/m=125
10mm n=1/m=100
12mm n=3/m=250
1/10000 mm
n=2/m=25
n=1/m=10
n=3/m=25
nc
n
m
.c
Examples of calculation
2022
1 rotation
8mm
of motor 10mm
12mm
n=1/m=5
n=1/m=4
n=3/m=10
PRM
1/1000 mm
251
5. DEGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
Full close
Semi
close
2000
Separate
detector
Velocity
feedback
pulses
2023
Position
feedback
pulses
2024
8192
819
12500
NS/10
1250
r.c
NS
xxxx xxx 1
om
xxxx xxx 0
Resolution 1/10000mm
Resolution 1/1000mm
ce
nt
e
Para
meter
no.
2000
Separate
detector
1815
Velocity
feedback
pulses
2023
Position
feedback
pulses
2024
nc
Full close
Semi
close
xxxx xxx1
0000
0010
0000
0000
4000
NS/10
4000
.c
PRM
1821
252
5. DIGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
5.2
SERVO TUNING
SCREEN
5.2.1
Parameter Setting
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
1. Press
Displaying Servo
Tuning Screen
SYSTEM
key
r.c
#0 (SVS)
5.2.2
#0
SVS
om
3111
ce
nt
e
nc
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
SERVO TUNING
(PAMAMETER)
FUN.BIT
LOOP GAIN
TURNING SET.
SET PERIOD
INT.GAIN
PROP.GAIN
FILER
VELOC.GAIN
SV SET
SV TUN
(9)
(10)
(11)
(12)
(13)
(14)
(15)
(16)
(17)
OPE
.c
w
w
w
00000000
3000
0
50
113
1015
0
125
01234 N12345
(MONITOR)
ALARM 1
00000000
ALARM 2
00000000
ALARM 3
10000000
ALARM 4
00000000
ALARM 5
00000000
LOOP GAIN
2999
POS ERROR
556
CURRENT%
10
SPEED RPM
100
253
5. DEGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
Alarm1
#7
OVL
#6
LV
#5
OVC
#4
HCA
#3
HVA
#2
DCA
#1
FBA
#0
OFA
DGN (200) :
#7 (OVL) :
#6 (LV) :
Overload alarm
Insufficient voltage alarm
#4 (HCA) :
#3 (HVA) :
#2 (DCA) :
Discharge alarm
#1 (FBA) :
Disconnection alarm
#0 (OFA) :
Overflow alarm
Alarm2
#7
ALD
#6
#5
om
Overcurrent alarm
r.c
#5 (OVC) :
#4
EXP
#3
#1
#0
ce
nt
e
DGN (201)
#2
Overload
alarm
Amplifier overheat
Motor overheat
Discon- 1
nection
alarm
1
nc
#7
#6
CSA
Alarm3
#5
BLA
#4
PHA
#3
RCA
#2
BZA
#1
CKA
#0
SPH
.c
DGN (202) :
#5 (BLA) :
#4 (PHA) :
#3 (RCA) :
#2 (BZA) :
#1 (CKA) :
#0 (SPH) :
#6 (CSA) :
254
5. DIGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
Alarm4
#7
DTE
#6
CRC
#5
STB
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
DGN (203) :
Communication error of serial pulse coder.
There is no response.
#6 (CRC) :
#5 (STB) :
#6
OFS
#5
MCC
DGN (204) :
#3
PMS
#2
#1
#0
ce
nt
e
#6 (OFS) :
#4
LDM
r.c
#7
Alarm3
om
#7 (DTE) :
#5 (MCC) :
#4 (LDM) :
#3 (PMS) :
.c
nc
255
5. DEGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
5.3
ADJUSTING
REFERENCE
POSITION
(DOG METHOD)
5.3.1
om
General
Speed
r.c
Rapid traverse
(PRM1420)
FL rate
(PRM1425 )
ce
nt
e
Time
PCZ
nc
Grid
.c
10000P
CMR
10mm/rev
Error counter
Proportion
gain
(Serial)
FFG
PC
10000P/rev (Flexible feed gear)
Counter capacity
10000p
Refere
count.
GRID
Speed
loop
Command
D Parameter
#7
PRM
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
1002
#1
DLZ
#0
1821
[P]
5. DIGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
PRM
1850
[P]
When the resolution is 0.0001mm, set the value in the unit ten times
the detection unit.
#7
PRM
#6
1815
#5
APC
#4
APZ
#3
#2
#1
OPT
#0
om
ce
nt
e
r.c
1 : Established
(Turns to 1 after establishment)
To manually change the value of the APZ bit from 0 to 1 without first
returning to the reference position
when using serial pulse coder , follow this procedure: Back up the
data with the battery and give the motor one or more turns.
Turn the power off then on again, then change the APZ bit setting
from 0 to 1.
#1(OPT) 0 : Position detection is performed by the pulse coder built in the motor.
1 : Separate type pulse coder or linear scale is used.
PRM
nc
[P]
Example
.c
(1 m)
300mm
257
reference counter
30000
20000
15000
10000
etc
5. DEGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
5.4
When there are no dog nor limit switch for reference position return, this
function enables the tool to return the reference position that is set by
MTB.
When the absolute position detector is used, the reference position once
set remains also during power off. When the absolute detector is replaced
or absolute position is lost, perform this setting.
DOGLESS
REFERENCE
POSITION SETTING
om
5.4.1
General
Speed
r.c
Time
ce
nt
e
JOG
ZRN
+J
GRID
..........................
nc
ZP
1 Move the tool near the reference position using a manual operation.
2 Select the reference position return mode or switch.
3 Press a button for an axisanddirectionselectsignal + or , and the
machine moves to the next grid, then stops.
(This position is set as the reference position).
After the reference position has been set, select the reference position
return mode(SRN signal is 1) and turn on an axisanddirection
select signal, then the tool returns to the reference position.
Operation
.c
5.4.2
258
5. DIGITAL SERVO
B62445E/03
5.4.3
Associated Parameters
#7
PRM
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
DLZ
1002
#0
#7
PRM
#6
1006
#5
ZMI
#4
#3
#2
om
#0
r.c
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
259
B62445E/03
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
PARAMETERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
nc
A06B6065Hxxx
(xxx is any)
.c
260
B62445E/03
6.1
GENERAL OF
SPINDLE CONTROL
(SERIAL*
INTERFACE)
S instruction
M instruction
NC
om
PMC
M03,M04,M05,M19
FIN
r.c
*SSTP(Spindle stop)
Motor speed
ce
nt
e
SF,GR10,GR20,GR30
(For milling machine)
(PRM 3735X3752)
0
1
Orientation speed
(PRM 3705#1, 3732,
3706#5)
nc
Output polarity
(PRM 3706#7,6)
SGN(0=+,1=)
SSIN
*ESP,MRDY,
SFR,SRV,ORCM
etc.
SST, SDT, SAR, LDT1,
LDT2
ORAR, ALM etc.
w
Operators
panel
Load meter
SIND
Interface
function
w
w
Serial spindle
amplifier
R01IXR12I
.c
R010XR120
Optical cable
Interface
function
Spindle
motor
PC
LM
Spindle
Speed meter
SM
261
B62445E/03
6.1.1
Method A of Gear
Change for Machining
Center
Output
Motor speed
Max
4095
Gear 2
Gear 3
PRM 3736
om
Gear 1
PRM 3735
S code
6.1.2
Output
Motor speed
Max
4095
ce
nt
e
Method B of Gear
change for Machining
Center(PRM 3705#2=1)
r.c
Gear 1
Gear 2
Gear 3
nc
6.1.3
For Lathe
Output
.c
w
PRM 3735
S code
Motor speed
Max
4095
Gear 1
Gear 2
Gear 3
Gear 4
S code
0
0 PRM 3741 PRM 3742 PRM 3743 PRM 3744
PRM 3736
262
B62445E/03
6.2
TABLE OF TEST
POINTS
6.2.1
Printed Circuit Board
(A16B22010440)
Name
Signal
Remarks
Pulsegenerator phase A
PB
Pulsegenerator phase B
RA
DC +2.5VX0.2V
DC +2.5VX0.2V
PBAS
Duty 50%
PAA
r.c
RB
PAAS
ce
nt
e
om
PA
PBA
Duty 50%
*ITP1
ITP pulse
The high level of this signal indicates that serial data is being transmitted from the CNC
MSA
LSA
*LS
Positioncoder phase A
Duty 50%
TR
nc
PAE2
Posiitoncoder phase B
Duty 50%
PSE2
Positioncoder phase Z
1 pulse/rotation
*PELS
CLK1
Clock signal
VDC
SDC
Control power DC link voltage Voltage that is 1/100 of the DC voltage of the
signal
input power
+24V
+24V DC voltage
+20V to +26V
+15V
+15V DC voltage
+15V 4%
+5V
+5V DC voltage
+5V%
15V
15V DC voltage
15V4%
.c
PBE2
0V
263
B62445E/03
Name
IU
Remarks
Amplifier
Model 1SX3S
Model small 6S,6SX12S
Model 15S
Model 15SX22S
Model 26S
Model Small 30S
Model 30S
Model 40S
Model 30HV,40HV
Model 60HV
Current
21.9A/V
33.3A/V
41.7A/V
66.7A/V
83.3A/V
111.1A/V
83.3A/V
104.2A/V
50.5A/V
94.7A/V
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
IV
Signal
264
B62445E/03
6.2.2
Signal Waveform
At Test Points
PB
PA
PB
Remarks
Waveform
Check terminal
PA
Pulse generator
output
0.36
X0.5
+2.5V
om
0V
RA
RB
2.5V"0.2V
0V
Nominal
voltage
r.c
+4X+4.5V
PAA
0V
0V
Signal formed
by PA/PB
ce
nt
e
PBA
Peak
IU
IV
0V
0V
nc
125ns
+4V
.c
CLK1
265
0V
Clock
8MHz
B62445E/03
6.3
CONFIRMING POWER
SUPPLY
(SERIAL INTERFACE)
6.3.1
Power Supply
om
Volt
+24V
Across +24V to 0V
Rated value
+20X+26V
r.c
DC voltage
on spindle
control circuit
PCB
Across +15V to 0V
+15V"4%
+5V
Across +5V to 0V
+5V"2%
15V
Across 15V to 0V
15V"4%
ce
nt
e
+15V
6.3.2
Test Points
nc
D A20B10030550
+B
0B
0V
C
N
6
ST
.c
CN10
+24V
+5V
+15V
C
N
5
0V
0V
15V
0V
CN11A
266
CN11B
C
N
4
CN2
TB
B62445E/03
D A20B10030920
CN10
+B
0B
0V
om
C
N
6
r.c
+24V
C
N
5
+5V
+15V
ce
nt
e
0V
.c
nc
CN13
267
CN11A
CN11B
0V
0V
15V
0V
CN2
C
N
4
TB
B62445E/03
D A16B22010010
A16B22010440
0V +24V +15V 15V +5V
Display part
Setting
switch
ROM
om
ST2
CN10
r.c
ST1
ce
nt
e
C
N
12
S2
S3
C
N
14
CNA/TOP
CN13
.c
nc
TB
268
CN11A
CN11B
CN2/BOTTOM
B62445E/03
6.4
SPINDLE SETTING
AND TUNING
SCREEN
6.4.1
1.
Display Method
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
SPS
#0
om
#7
3111
key.
r.c
2. Press
4. Press soft key [SPPRM] and the spindle tuning screen is displayed.
ce
nt
e
5. The following screens are available and they can be selected by soft
key.
1 [SP.SET] : Spindle setting screen
6.4.2
nc
.c
SPINDLE SETTING
(1)GEAR SELECT
(2)SPINDLE
D Gear select
D Spindle
: 1
: S11
(PARAMETER)
(3)GEAR RATIO
(4)MAX SPINDLE SPEED
(5)MAX MOTOR SPEED
(6)MAX C AXIS SPEED
50
3000
6000
100
1
2
3
4
CTH1 CTH2
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
B62445E/03
D Parameter
S11:1st Main S12:1st Sub S21:2nd Main S22:2nd Sub
Gear ratio(HIGH)
4056
4056
4216
4057
4058
4216
4057
4058
4217
4059
3741
3742
3743
3743
4020
3744
4196
ce
nt
e
Max. C axis speed
3742
3744
6.4.3
3741
r.c
4217
4059
om
Gear ratio(LOW)
4021
None
4020
4021
SPINDLE TUNING
.c
nc
OPERATION
: SPEED CONTROL
GEAR SELECT : 1
SPINDLE
: S11
(PARAMETER)
PROP.GAIN
20
INT.GAIN
50
LOOP GAIN
3000
MOTOR VOLT
30
TIME CONST
100
REF. SHIFT 2046
(MONITOR)
MOTOR SPEED
100
SPINDLE SPEED 150
POS ERR S1 100
POS ERR S2 103
SYN.ERR
3
D Operation mode
1
2
3
4
5
6
270
4196
None
B62445E/03
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f (%)
Rigid
tapping
f
f
f
f
f
f
Cs
axis
control
f
f
f
f
f
f (%)
r.c
Proportional gain
Integral gain
Position loop gain
Motor voltage
Regenerative power
ZRN gain %
Shift reference point
Shift spindle stop pos.
ORAR gain (%)
Acc./Dec. time constant
Orient Synation
chro.
control
Spind
le
positioning
control
f
f
f
f
f
f
om
D Display of parameter
ce
nt
e
nc
Normal
operation
.c
Motor speed
Spindle speed
Position deviation S1
Position deviation S2
Position deviation Z
Synchronous deviation
Feed rate
f
f
Orient Synation
chro.
control
f
f
f
Spindle data
16383
f
f
f
f
Rigid
tapping
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
f
Spind
le
positioning
control
f
271
Cs
axis
control
B62445E/03
6.4.4
Spindle Monitor Screen
SPINDLE MONITOR
ALARM
:
OPERATION
:
SPINDLE SPEED :
MOTOR SPEED :
SCREEN
AL27(POSITION CODER DIS.)
Cs AXIS OONTROL
100 DEG/MIN
150 RPM
0
50 100 150
JJJJJ
CONTROL INPUT : ORCM MRDY *ESP
CONTROL OUTPUT : SST SDT ORAR
200
om
1: Motor overheated
2: Speed deviation excessive
3: Fuse blow of DC link
4: Fuse blow of AC inputline
5: Fuse blow of DC voltage
7: Excessive speed
9: Heat sink overheat
10: Low voltage of AC input
11: Excess voltage in DC link
12: Excess current in DC link
13: CPU internal data memory error
18: ROM SUM check error
19: U phase current offset excessive
20: V phase current offset excessive
24: Serial data transmission abnormal
25: Serial data transmission stop
26: Cs axis speed detecting signal failure
27: Position coder signal disconnection
28: Cs pos.detect signal disconnection
29: Short time overload
30: Input circuit excess current
31: Speed detecting signal disconnection
32: SLC LSI internal RAM abnormal
33: DC link charging insufficient
34: Parameter abnormal setting
35: Gear ratio data excessive
36: Error counter overflow
37: Speed detecting unit error setting
38: Magnetic sensor signal abnormal
39: Alarm of one revolution signal for Cs axis control is detected
40: Alarm of one revolution signal for Cs axis control is not detected
41: Erroneous detection of the position coder one revolution signal
42: Undetection of the position coder one revolution signal
46: Erroneous detection of the position coder one revolution signal on
threading
47: Abnormal position coder signal
48: Erroneous detection of position coder one revolution signal
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
D Spindle alarm
272
B62445E/03
D Operation
D Load meter
Normal operation
Orientation
Synchronous operation
Rigid tapping
Cs contour cotrol
Spindle positioning control
1) Load meter[%] + Load meter data
3276
om
Max.output value
of load meter (*)
r.c
Max.10 signals those are ON are displayed from the following signals:
: Torque limit command (low)
TLMH
CTH1
: Gear signal 1
CTH2
: Gear signal 2
SPSL
MCFN
SOCN
RSL
RCH
INDX
:
:
:
:
:
:
ROTA
NRRO
INTG
:
:
DEFM
ce
nt
e
TLML
SRV
SFR
: Spindle orientation
MEDY
: Machine ready
ARST
*ESP
: Emergency stop
nc
ORCM
Max. 10 signals those are ON are displayed from the following signals:
ALM
SST
SDT
SAR
LDT1
LDT2
:
:
:
:
:
:
Alarm signal
Speed zero signal
Speed detecting signal
Speed arrival signal
Load detecting signal 1
Load detecting signal 2
.c
273
TML5
ORAR
CHP
CFIN
RCHP
RCFN
:
:
:
:
:
:
Torque limitation
Orientation end signal
Power line switched signal
Spindle switch complete
Output switch signal
Output switch complete
signal
B62445E/03
6.4.5
om
Correspondence
Between Operation
Mode and Parameters
on Spindle Tuning
Screen
S21:
2nd Main
S22:
2nd Sub
Proportional gain(HIGH)
4040
4206
4040
4206
4041
Integral gain(HIGH)
4048
Integral gain(LOW)
4049
Motor voltage
4083
4236
4083
4236
Regenerative power
4080
4231
4080
4231
S11:
1st Main
S12:
1st Sub
S21:
2nd Main
S22:
2nd Sub
Proportional gain(HIGH)
4042
4208
4042
4208
4043
4209
4043
4209
Integral gain(HIGH)
4050
4207
ce
nt
e
4212
4041
4048
4049
4207
4212
nc
S12:
1st Sub
r.c
S11:
1st Main
4051
4060
4213
4061
.c
Integral gain(LOW)
4218
4050
4051
4060
4213
4218
4061
4063
Motor voltage
4084
4237
4084
4237
4064
4220
4064
4220
4077
4228
4077
4228
Orientation by PC method
4031
4204
4031
4204
4062
274
4219
4062
4219
4063
B62445E/03
D Synchronization control
mode
S21:
2nd Main
S22:
2nd Sub
Proportional gain(HIGH)
4044
4210
4044
4210
4045
4211
4045
4211
Integral gain(HIGH)
4052
Integral gain(LOW)
4053
4065
4066
4067
4068
Motor voltage
4085
4032
4032
Shift amount
4034
4034
4214
4221
4052
4053
4065
4214
4221
om
4066
4222
4067
4222
4068
4085
r.c
4238
4238
ce
nt
e
S12:
1st Sub
S12:
1st Sub
S21:
2nd Main
S22:
2nd Sub
Proportional gain(HIGH)
4044
4210
4044
4210
4045
4211
4045
4211
Integral gain(HIGH)
4052
Integral gain(LOW)
4053
4065
4066
4067
4068
.c
nc
S11:
1st Main
4214
4221
4222
4052
4053
4065
4214
4221
4066
4067
4222
4068
4238
4085
4238
4091
4239
4091
4239
4073
4223
4073
4223
4085
ZRN gain %
Motor voltage
275
D Spindle contouring
control mode
(Cs axis control)
B62445E/03
S12:
1st Sub
S21:
2nd Main
4046
4047
4047
Integral gain(HIGH)
4054
4054
Integral gain(LOW)
4055
4055
4069
4069
4070
4070
4071
4072
Motor voltage
4086
ZRN gain %
4092
4092
4135
4135
4071
4072
r.c
4086
ce
nt
e
D Spindle positioning
control mode
4046
om
Proportional gain(HIGH)
S22:
2nd Sub
S12:
1st Sub
S21:
2nd Main
S22:
2nd Sub
Proportional gain(HIGH)
4044
4210
4044
4210
4045
4211
4045
4211
Integral gain(HIGH)
4052
Integral gain(LOW)
4053
4065
4066
4067
4068
.c
nc
S11:
1st Main
4214
4221
4052
4053
4214
4065
4066
4221
4067
4222
4222
4068
4238
4085
4238
4091
4239
4091
4239
4073
4223
4073
4223
4085
ZRN gain %
Motor voltage
276
B62445E/03
6.5
Standard parameters those are specific to each motor model can be set at
a time by this operation.
Note that, however, depending on the conditions under which a motor is
used, the machine tool builder may determine unique values to the
parameters.
Therefore, always set the parameters (No.4000 and later) according to the
parameter list attached to the machine.
AUTOMATIC
SETTING OF
STANDARD
PARAMETER
4019
#7
LDSP
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
4133
ce
nt
e
Motor model
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
nc
.c
w
#0
Code
3S
6S
8S
12S
15S
18S
30S
8P
12P
15P
(1500/6000rpm)
(1500/6000rpm)
(1500/6000rpm)
(1500/6000rpm)
(1500/6000rpm)
(1500/4500rpm)
(1150/4500rpm)
(750/6000rpm)
(750/6000rpm)
(750/6000rpm)
Code
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
23
Motor model
18P
22P
40P
30P
50P
1S
1.5S
2S
3S
0.5S
(750/6000rpm)
(750/6000rpm)
(575/4500rpm)
(575/4500rpm)
(575/4500rpm)
(3000/8000rpm)
(1500/8000rpm)
(1500/8000rpm)
(1500/6000rpm)
(3000/8000rpm)
#1
r.c
om
277
B62445E/03
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
278
B62445E/03
7.1
GENERAL OF
SPINDLE CONTROL
(ANALOG
INTERFACE)
7.1.1
S command
M command
om
Block Diagram
PMC
NC
M03 X M05, M06, M19
CW/CCW command
orientation
Spindle speed
conversion
Gear 1
*SSTP
Gear 2
r.c
FIN
Motor speed
Spindle stop
ce
nt
e
GR1, GR2
Gear information
(16T/18T)
nc
D/ A converter
.c
w
*ESP, MRDY
SFR, SRV
ORCM, TLM
SAR, LDT
SST, ORAR
SDT, ALM
SVC
DV
RV
Spindle amp.
PC
Operatiors
panel
Spindle
motor
Load meter
LM
Speed meter
Spindle
279
SM
B62445E/03
7.1.2
Calculation of S Analog
Voltage and Associated
Parameters
[M series]
1 Gear change method A(PRM3705#2=0)
Motor speed
Gear 1
PRM 3735
0V
PRM 3741
PRM 3742
PRM 3743
ce
nt
e
Gear 3
r.c
(4095) 10V
PRM 3736
Gear 2
Max
om
SVC
S code
(RPM)
Motor speed
Gear 1
(4095) 10V
PRM 3736
Max
PRM 3752
nc
PRM 3751
Gear 2
Gear 3
PRM 3742
PRM 3743
PRM 3735
0V
PRM 3741
S code
(RPM)
.c
[T series]
SVC
Gear 1
Max
Gear 2
Gear 3
Gear 4
(4095) 10V
Motor speed
0V
0
PRM 3741
280
PRM 3742
PRM 3743
PRM 3744
S code
(RPM)
B62445E/03
#7
TCW
3706
#6
CWM
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
CWM
[M series]
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
SGB
#1
#0
r.c
3705
om
TCW
#0
ce
nt
e
3743
[rpm]
nc
3736
[rpm]
3742
[rpm]
3735
.c
Set value=
[T series]
3741
[rpm]
DGN
3742
[rpm]
DGN
3743
[rpm]
DGN
3744
[rpm]
w
DGN
281
4095
7.1.3
om
Tuning S Analog
Voltage (D/A Converter)
B62445E/03
r.c
DGN
3731
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
3741
DGN
282
B62445E/03
(4) If the output voltage is not correct, perform the following calculation,
change the value of parameter no. 3730 and tune the gain of D/A
converter.
Setting value=
10V
measured voltage
(5) Execute an S command again and confirm that the output voltage is
correct.
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
283
B62445E/03
7.2
TABLE OF TEST
POINTS
7.2.1
Model 1S to 3S
(Amp. Specification :
A06B-6059-H00x)
Remarks
PA
90 advance by PB at CW rotation
Vpp =0.360.5V
PB
90 delay by PA at CW rotation
Vpp =0.360.5V
RA
+2. 5VDC
RB
+2. 5VDC
"0. 2V
om
Signal
DA2
"0. 2V
r.c
Name
Duty 50%
Duty 50%
TSA
ce
nt
e
PAP
PBP
TS2
TS3
0X"10V,(CCW:+, CW: )
FWP
RVP
CW rotation pulse
Error voltage
4.2 to +4.8V
VCMD
nc
ER
CLK1
Clock signal
SLIP
Slip pulse
VDC
IU
22.2 A/V
IV
IW
.c
DTDC
+24V
+24V DC voltage
+15V
+15V DC voltage
+15V"4%
+5V
+5V DC voltage
+5V"4%
15V
15V DC voltage
15V"4%
SM
LM
Loadmeter signal
0V
284
B62445E/03
7.2.2
Models 6S to 26S
(Amp. specification:
A06B6059H2xx)
Signal contents
Remarks
PA
90, advance by
Vpp=0.360.5V
PB
RA
+2. 5V DC "0. 2V
DA2
PB
at
CW
rotation
om
Name
+2. 5V DC "0. 2V
Duty 50%
PBP
Duty 50%
TSA
TS2
TS3
r.c
RB
PAP
ce
nt
e
TSAF
TSAR
CW rotation speed
detection signal
At CW (backward rotation)
6000 rpm , 0. 82V "82mv
ER
Error voltage
4.2X+4.8V
CLK1
Clock signal
SLIP
Slip pulse
VDC
SDC
ADIN
nc
VCMD
Model
IV
IW
.c
IU
6SX12S 15SX22S
+24V
+24V DC voltage
+15V
+15V DC voltage
+15V"4%
+5V
+5V DC voltage
+5V"4%
15V
15V DC voltage
15V"4%
0V
*RGHLD
285
66.6 A/V
26S
83.3 A/V
7.2.3
Test Points Signal
Waveform
B62445E/03
Check
terminal
Waveform
Remarks
+10V
DA2
0V
+10V
VCMD
0V
0V
om
TSA
10V
0V
TS3
+4. 8V
ER
ce
nt
e
0V
4.2V
PB
0.36
X0.5
+2.5V
nc
0V
0V
w
w
Nominal voltage
+4Y+4. 5V
0V
0V
PBP
2.5V"0.2V
.c
PAP
IU
F/V converter
output
(Pluse for reverse rotation)
Pulse generator
output
PA
RA
RB
Speed feedback
voltage
(Pulse for reverse rotation)
r.c
5.0V
PA
PB
At CCW
(Minus for reverse rotation)
Signal formed
by PA/PB
Peak
0V
IV
0V
IW
0V
Peak value is
proportional to
current value
200ns 200ns
+4V
CLK1
0V
286
Clock
2. 5MHz
B62445E/03
7.3
SETTING
PARAMETERS
(DIGITAL AC
SPINDLE)
PCB
Display
Display
Setting
switch
r.c
om
Setting
switch
DATA
SET
UP
and
DOWN
ce
nt
e
at the same time for more than 1 second and when the display shows
FFFFF, release the buttons.
UP
or
nc
.c
DOWN
UP
button.
DATA
SET
button at last.
When the display shows 88888, the setting value is stored in memory.
* If you turn off power before pressing
DATA
SET
287
B62445E/03
7.4
SETTING STANDARD
PARAMETERS
ce
nt
e
1.
2.
3.
4.
r.c
om
The standard parameters are stored in ROM. If the parameter list attached to the machine is lost or when an
accident occurs and no parameter can be set, perform
the setting of standard parameters.
Also when a ROM is replaced with different maximum
speed applied to different motor model, perform the
following procedure.
However, since the standard parameters are set to
each motor, some parameters must be modified by the
parameter list according to the machines unique characteristics.
DATA
SET
UP
and
DOWN
at the
same time for more than 1 second and when the display shows FFFFF,
release the buttons.
nc
DOWN
button to display
.c
FC22 on the display and release the MODE button. (Display changes
to that of step 4)
Other number shows other meaning, therefore select the number
correctly.
8. Press
DATA
SET
9. When the display shows GOOD, the standard parameters have been
set correctly.
10.Turn power off and set jumper S1 and SH to the DRIVE side.
11.Modify the standard parameters those are specific to the machine or
the PCB as required. Refer to 7.6 Tuning after replacing PCB.
288
B62445E/03
7.5
LIST OF PARAMETER
No.
Setting
value
Contents
F01
0: not used
1: used
F02
0: not used
1: used
F03
0: 100%
none
F05
Standard
Highspeed
0
1
2
3
Max. 5000
Max. 6000
Max. 10000
Max.12000
Max. 15000
Max. 20000
ce
nt
e
F06
1: 120%
r.c
F04
om
F00
Pattern 2
0
4
5
6
Pattern 1
.c
nc
Output
Content
Nb
Pattern 2
Output
Speed
Speed
Nb
F08
F09
F10
Adjustment of speed error offset at the time of the forward rotation command
F11
Adjustment of speed error offset at the time of the reverse rotation command
F12
F13
F07
40msec)
289
B62445E/03
No.
Setting
value
Contents
F14
F15
F16
F17
F19
F20
F21
F22
F23
F24
F25
F26
F27
F28
F29
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
Torque limit value when the torque limit signal (TLMH) is turned on
om
F18
F31
F32
F33
F34
F35
F36
F37
F38
F39
F40
.c
F30
290
B62445E/03
Setting
value
Content
F42
F43
Slip constant
F44
Voltage compensation
F45
F46
F47
F48
F49
F50
F51
F52
F53
om
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
F41
291
B62445E/03
7.6
1. Set jumpers on the PCB to the previous satate.
2. Check whether ROM is mounted or not and confirm version of ROM.
If ROM is not mounted or ROM series is different, remove the ROM
from the old PCB and mount it on new PCB.
3. Install the PCB to the unit and set the system to the emergency stop
state. Then turn on power and measure voltage on the PCB.
Test points
Rating
"4%
+24V
About 23V
+15V
+15V
"4%
+5V
+5V
"2%
15V
15V
"2%
om
TUNING AFTER
REPLACING PCB
(S SERIES AC
SPINDLE)
DATA
SET
UP
and
DOWN
ce
nt
e
6. Press MODE ,
r.c
written.
7. Set parameters according to the parameter list attached to the machine.
1) When you press and hold MODE button and press
or
nc
DOWN
UP
UP
or
DOWN
.c
RV2
RV3
RV4
Adjusting +5V
Adjust +5V"0.1V
RV5
Standard setting 50 %
RV6
292
B62445E/03
10.Measure test point TS3 with a digital tester and adjust parameter
F29
F10
om
F11
r.c
F12
ce
nt
e
Tune
14.Tune
F12
nc
15.Tune
F14
.c
16.Press
DATA
SET
DATA
SET
button, the
Note
This operation cannot be accepted when a rotation
command is specified.
Always perform this operation with the spindle stopped.
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
TROUBLESHOOTING
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
295
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.1
CORRECTIVE
ACTION FOR
FAILURES
When?
With what
operation?
What failure?
r.c
Recovery
8.1.1
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
Investigating the
Conditions under
which Failure Occurred
om
Appropriate action
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.2
POWER CANNOT BE
TURNED ON
Points
om
Confirm the green LED PIL and red LED ALM on the front of power unit.
1) Proceed to item 1 when green LED PIL is turned off.
2) Proceed to item 2 when green LED is lit and red LED AML is turned
off.
3) Check item 3 when red LED ALM is lit.
ce
nt
e
r.c
nc
AL
ON button
Contacts of power on is
closed.
.c
ON
COM
w
w
OFF
OFF button
CP5
F3
CP2
9ICRT/MDI
Unit
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
om
Note
When a work is conducted with power supply unit removed,
perform the work within 30 minutes (Data in memory may be
lost)
ce
nt
e
r.c
.c
nc
Notes
When removing the cable note the following :
1 If 6V battery is connected as shown below, absolute position
of the machine may be lost when cable (2)is removed.
Therefore, the machine position must be established by
reference position return ,after releasing the alarm.
2 If 6V battery is not connected, the above operation is not
needed.
299
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
Main CPU
Manual pulse generator
MPG (JA3)
(1
)
MPG
Pulse coder
PC
(2)*
(3)
SCALEn (JF2n)
n : Axis
number
Linear scale
BAT
6V (1.5V x 4)
r.c
APCBAT (JA4A)
om
ENCn (JFn)
nc
ce
nt
e
(d) If AlM does not light by power on of NC, any of load connected
to (1) to (3) may be faulty. Check whether grounding or
shortcircuiting exists or not. If it is present, replace the
appropriate part or cable.
(4) Shortcircuiting within the controller (PCB may be faulty)
Power is supplied to PCBs through the back panel.
Check it by the steps below :
1) Remove a PCB in a slot and turn on power, then confirm lightening
of LED ALM. Repeat this operation to each PCB.
2) When ALM does not light at power on with a PCB removed, the
PCB may be faulty.
.c
Note
Perform an operation with a PCB removed within 30
minutes, otherwise data in memory may be lost.
300
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.3
NO MANUAL OPERATION NOR AUTOMATIC OPERATION CAN
BE EXECUTED
Points
om
r.c
Causes and
Countermeasures
1. Position display
(relative, absolute,
machine coordinate)
does not change
#7
X1008
G0008
ce
nt
e
#5
#4
*ESP
#3
#2
#1
#0
*ESP
nc
#7
#6
#5
.c
X1008
G0008
#3
#2
#1
#0
*ESP
w
w
G0008
#4
*ESP
#7
ERS
#6
RRW
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
RESET
RESET
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
om
(Example of display)
JOG : Manual operation (JOG) mode
HND : Manual handle (MPG) mode
MDI : Manual data input (MDI) mode
MEM : Automatic operation (Memory) mode
EDIT: EDIT (Memory edit) mode
#6
#5
#4
G0043
r.c
#3
#2
MD4
#1
MD2
#0
MD1
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
(2) Check diagnostic data 000 to 025 of the CNC Check an item for which
1 is displayed
No. Message
Display
000 WAITING FOR FIN SIGNAL
:0
001 MOTION
:0
002 DWELL
:0
a.003 INPOSITION CHECK
:0
004 FEEDRATE OVERRIDE 0%
:0
b.005INTERLOCK / START LOCK
:1
006SPINDLE SPEED ARRIVAL CHECK (Example) : 0
010PUNCHING
:0
011READING
:0
012WAITING FOR (UN) CLAMP
:0
c.013JOG FEEDRATE OVERRIDE 0%
:0
d.014WAITING FOR RESET, ESP, RRW OFF
:0
015EXTERNAL PROGRAM NUMBER SEARCH : 0
Items with a to d relate with manual and automatic operation and its
detail is shown below.
302
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
a. Inposition check is
being done
It shows that positioning is not yet completed. Check the contents of the
following diagnostic number. (It is 1 in the following condition)
DGN 0300 Position Error
>PARAM 1826
Inpositio width
1 Check the parameters according to the parameter list
Servo loop gain per axis
(Normal : 3000)
om
1825
2 Servo system may be abnormal. Refer to servo alarm 400, 410, and
411.
b. Interlock or start lock
signal is input
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
DIT
#2
ITX
ce
nt
e
3003
r.c
There are a plural interlock signals. Check at first which interlock signal
is used by the machine tool builder at the parameters shown below.
#1
#0
ITL
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
*IT
#1
*IT2
#0
+IT1
nc
#7
*IT8
#6
*IT7
#5
*IT6
#4
*IT5
#3
*IT4
#2
*IT3
.c
G0130
#7
#3
+MIT4
#2
+MIT3
#1
+MIT2
#0
+MIT1
G0134
MIT4
MIT3
MIT2
MIT1
#6
#5
#4
G0132
G0010
#7
*JV7
#6
*JV6
#5
*JV5
#4
*JV4
#3
*JV3
#2
*JV2
#1
*JV1
#0
*JV0
G0011
*JV15
*JV14
*JV13
*JV12
*JV11
*JV10
*JV9
*JV8
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
*JV15 . . . . . . . . .
JV0
Override
0.00%
0.01%
:
1101 1000 1110 1111
:
100.00%
:
0000 0000 0000 0001
0000 0000 0000 0000
:
655.34%
0.00%
In this case, RESET is also displayed on the status display. Check it using
the procedure of 1 above.
2. When machine
coordinate value does
not update on position
display
#6
#5
#4
MLK8
MLK7
MLK6
MLK5
#3
#2
#1
MLK
#0
MLK4
MLK3
MLK2
MLK1
ce
nt
e
G0108
r.c
#7
G0044
om
d. NC is in a reset state
.c
nc
304
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.4
JOG OPERATION
CANNOT BE DONE
Points
om
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
MD4
ce
nt
e
#7
r.c
#0
MD1
#5
+J6
#4
+J5
#3
+J4
#2
+J3
#1
+J2
#0
+J1
nc
(2) Feed axis and direction select signal is not input Check the signal using
PMCs diagnostic function (PMCDGN).
J5
J4
J3
J2
J1
G0100
G0102
#7
+J8
#6
+J7
J8
J7
J6
.c
Example)
When +X button is pressed on the operators panel, signal+J1 turns to
1.
This signal is effected at its rise. If axis selection signal is input before
JOG mode is selected, axis movement does not occur. Turn the signal
to off, then on.
305
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
(3) Check CNCs diagnostic function 000 to 015. Check the items for
which 1 is displayed at right side.
No. Message
Display
000 WAITING FOR FIN SIGNAL
:0
001 MOTION
:0
002 DWELL
:0
a. 003 INPOSITION CHECK
:0
004 FEEDRATE OVERRIDE 0%
:0
:1
b. 005 INTERLOCK / START LOCK (Example)
006 SPINDLE SPEED ARRIVAL CHECK
:0
010 PUNCHING
:0
011 READING
:0
012 WAITING FOR (UN) CLAMP
:0
c. 013 JOG FEEDRATE OVERRIDE 0%
:0
d. 014 WAITING FOR RESET, ESP, RRW OFF
:0
015 EXTERNAL PROGRAM NUMBER SEARCH : 0
Items with a to d relate with manual and automatic operation and its
detail is shown below.
306
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
a. Inposition check is
being done
It shows that positioning is not yet completed. Check the contents of the
following diagnostic number. (It is 1 in the following condition)
DGN 0300 Position Error
(Normal : 3000)
2 Servo system may be abnormal. Refer to servo alarm 400, 410, and
411.
b. Interlock or start lock
signal is input
#7
#6
#5
#4
3003
#3
DIT
#2
ITX
#1
#0
ITL
r.c
PARAM
om
There are a plural interlock signals. Check at first which interlock signal
is used by the machine tool builder at the parameters shown below.
ce
nt
e
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
*IT
#1
*IT2
#0
+IT1
#6
*IT7
#5
*IT6
nc
G0130
#4
*IT5
#3
*IT4
#2
*IT3
#7
#3
+MIT4
#2
+MIT3
#1
+MIT2
#0
+MIT1
G0134
MIT4
MIT3
MIT2
MIT1
#2
+MIT1
#1
#0
#2
+MIT1
#1
#0
.c
G0132
#6
#5
#4
T series
#6
#7
#6
X1004
#5
MIT2
#4
+MIT2
#3
MIT1
#5
MIT2
#4
+MIT2
#3
MIT1
307
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
G0010
#7
*JV7
#6
*JV6
#5
*JV5
#4
*JV4
#3
*JV3
#2
*JV2
#1
*JV1
#0
*JV0
G0011
*JV15
*JV14
*JV13
*JV12
*JV11
*JV10
*JV9
*JV8
Override
om
*JV15 . . . . . . . . .
0.00%
0.01%
:
1101 1000 1110 1111
:
100.00%
:
655.34%
0.00%
r.c
:
0000 0000 0000 0001
0000 0000 0000 0000
d. NC is in a reset state
1423
ce
nt
e
In this case, RESET is also displayed on the status display. Check it using
the procedure of 1 above.
(4) Jog feed rate setting (Parameter) is not correct
Jog feedrate per axis
#6
#5
nc
1402
#3
#2
#1
#0
.c
#4
JRV
308
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.5
HANDLE OPERATION
CANNOT BE DONE
Points
om
Causes and
Countermeasure
Consult with item 8.3 and 8.4.
(1) Check CNC status display at lower left corner of the CRT
#5
#4
#3
#2
MD4
ce
nt
e
#7
G0043
r.c
#1
MD2
#0
MD1
#6
HS2C
#5
HS2B
#4
HS2A
#3
HS1D
#2
HS1C
#1
HS1B
#0
HS1A
HS3D
nc
G0019
#7
HS2D
HS3C
HS3B
HS3A
.c
When axis select switch for manual handle feed is selected on the
machine operators panel, if the signals are input as follows, it is
normal.
Selected axis
HSnD
HSnC
HSnB
HSnA
no selection
1st axis
2nd axis
3rd axis
4th axis
5th axis
6th axis
7th axis
8th axis
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
309
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
#5
MP2
#4
MP1
#3
#2
MP2
0
0
1
1
0
10
m
Multiplication
1
7114
#
7
#5
#4
m(1 127)
r.c
7113
7102
#0
MP1
0
#1
om
#7
G0019
n(1 1000)
#3
#2
#1
#0
HNGx
7110
ce
nt
e
(1 3)
nc
MPG (JA3)
.c
w
w
w
1st MPG
#2
2nd MPG
#3
310
#1
3rd MPG
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
Manual pulse
generator
(05)
(06)
(03)
(04)
HA1
HB1
+5V
0V
1st
HA2
HB2
+5V
0V
(03)
(04)
(18)
(14)
(05)
(06)
(03)
(04)
HA2
HB2
+5V
0V
2nd
HA3
HB3
+5V
0V
(05)
(06)
(20)
(16)
(05)
(06)
(03)
(04)
HA3
HB3
+5V
0V
3rd
r.c
om
HA1
HB1
+5V
0V
shield
Connector:half pitch
20pins (HIROSE)
ce
nt
e
Screw terminal
.c
nc
+5V 0V HA HB
HA
Rotation in plus
Rotation in minus
1:1
+5V
on off
on off
0V
+5V
HB
on off
on off
0V
1:1
1/4 phase difference
311
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.6
AUTOMATIC
OPERATION
CANNOT BE DONE
Points
om
(2) Check the status of cycle start LED on machine operators manual.
(3) Check status of CNC.
When manual operation is either impossible, perform countermeasure,
based on the previous item Jog operation cannot be done.
Confirm that a correct mode is selected according to the mode select status
of CNC status display. Also, by confirming the automatic operation
status it is possible to identify cycle operation, feed hold and cycle stop
state.
r.c
#7
#6
#5
DNCI
nc
G0043
ce
nt
e
#3
#2
MD4
#1
MD2
MD4
0
MD2
0
MD1
0
Mode select
Manual data input mode
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
.c
DNCI
#0
MD1
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
G0007
#2
ST
#1
#0
#6
#5
*SP
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
2. When an automatic
operation is in progress
(Cycle start LED is lit)
a. An auxiliary function is
being executed (waiting
for FIN signal)
#7
HSIF
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
nc
3001
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
.c
#6
#5
G0004
#4
#3
FIN
#2
#1
#0
313
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
<M series>
#7
BFIN
G0005
#6
#5
#4
#0(MFIN)
#1
#0
MFIN
#3(TFIN)
#2
SFIN
#2(SFIN)
#3
TFIN
#7
BF
F0007
#6
#5
#4
#3
TF
#2
SF
#1
#0
MF
r.c
om
ce
nt
e
<T series>
#6
#5
#4
BFIN
#3
TFIN
#2
SFIN
#1
#0
MFIN
#1
#0
MF
#1
#0
#1
#0
nc
#6
#5
F0007
#4
BF
#3
TF
#2
SF
.c
#6
G0004
#5
MFIN3
#4
MFIN2
#3
#2
#6
#5
MF3
#4
MF2
#3
#2
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
Signal
End state
Finish signal
store signal
0
0
1
1
c. A dwell command is
being executed
d. Inposition check
(confirming positioning)
is being done
om
r.c
Inposition width
e. Feedrate override is at
0%
ce
nt
e
#6
*FV6
#5
*FV5
#4
*FV4
#3
*FV3
#2
*FV2
#1
*FV1
#0
*FV0
nc
G0012
.c
G0013
#7
*AFV7
#6
*AFV6
#5
*AFV5
#4
*AFV4
#3
*AFV3
#2
*AFV2
#1
*AFV1
#0
*AFV0
1 1 1
1 1 0
0 1 1
0 0 0
0 0 0
315
*AFV7@@@@@@*AFV0
0%
1%
:
100%
:
245%
0%
1 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 1
:
1 0 0 1 1
:
0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0
1 1 1
1 1 0
0 1 1
0 0 1
0 0 0
0%
1%
:
100%
:
245%
0%
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
STLK
G0007
#0
#7
#6
#5
#4
3003
#3
DIT
#2
ITX
#1
#0
ITL
r.c
om
ce
nt
e
#0 (*IT)
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
*IT
#7
*IT8
#6
*IT7
#5
*IT6
nc
G0130
#4
*IT5
#3
*IT4
#2
*IT3
#1
*IT2
#0
*IT1
*ITn When the bit is 0, the corresponding axiss interlock signal is input.
(3) Interlock signal per axis and direction(+/ MITn) is input
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
+MIT4
#2
+MIT3
G0134
MIT4
MIT3
.c
G0132
MIT2
#0
+MIT1
MIT1
#1
+MIT2
*+MITn Interlock signal is input to the corresponding axis and direction with the
signal being 0.
(4) Controlled axis detach function is running.
specified for travelling.
A detached axis is
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
MDTCH8
MDTCH7
MDTCH6
MDTCH5
MDTCH4
MDTCH3
MDTCH2
MDTCH1
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
#7
DTCH8
#6
DTCH7
#5
DTCH6
#4
DTCH5
#3
DTCH4
#2
DTCH3
#1
DTCH2
#0
DTCH1
#7
RMVx
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#0
om
#1
#7
#6
#5
G0029
#4
SAR
r.c
#2
#1
#0
ce
nt
e
#4(SAR) : When this signal is 0, spindle speed does not arrive at the specified speed.
This function is valid when PARAM 3708#0=1.
h. Manual feedrate override
is 0% (dry run)
#6
#5
nc
G0046
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
.c
1410
#7
*JV7
#6
*JV6
#5
*JV5
#4
*JV4
#3
+JV3
#2
*JV2
#1
*JV1
#0
*JV0
G0011
*JV15
*JV14
*JV13
*JV12
+JV11
*JV10
*JV9
*JV8
G0010
317
Override
0.00%
0.01%
:
100.00%
:
655.34%
0.00%
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
i. NC is in a reset state
In this case, the CNCs status display shows RESET. Refer to item 1.
(2) Only rapid traverse in positioning (G00) does not function Confirm
the following parameter and signals from the PMC.
(a) Setting value of rapid traverse rate
1420
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
ROV2
HROV
*HROV6
*HROV5
*HROV4
*HROV3
*HROV2
G0096
(HROV0)
1421
*HROV0
(HROV=1)
ROV2
0
1
1
1
Override
100%
50%
25%
Fo
*HROV6 *HROV0
1 1 1 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 1 1 0
:
0 0 1 1 0 1 1
ce
nt
e
0
1
0
1
*HROV1
Override
r.c
ROV1
#0
ROV1
om
G0014
0%
1%
:
100%
.c
nc
1422
318
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
<T series>
Whether A/B phase signals from the position coder are read
correctly, can be judged also by the spindle speed display on the
CRT screen (position screen). (However, it is not displayed
when PARAM 3105#2=0).
Main CPU
board
Option 2
board
Optical I/O
SPDLx link adapter
Optical fiber
(JA7A,B)
JD1
x:
1.2
COP1
om
Serial
spindle
AC200V
CN11A
r.c
(Note)
Spindle
motor
Position coder or
Builtin sensor
ce
nt
e
PC
Spindle
Control signal
Serial
spindle
AOUTx(JA8A, B)
nc
Main CPU
board
Option 2
board
AC200V
.c
SPDLx(JA7A, B)
x:
1.2
Position coder
Spindle
319
PC
Spindle
motor
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
Position coder
SPDLx(JA7A,B)
(01)
(02)
(05)
(06)
(07)
(08)
(09)
(18)
(20)
(12)
(14)
(16)
SC
*SC
PA
*PA
PB
*PB
(H)
+5V
(K)
Shield
G
0V
Connector:Cannon connector
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
Connector:20pins
half pitch
(B)
(P)
(A)
(N)
(C)
(R)
om
SC
*SC
PA
*PA
PB
*PB
+5V
+5V
+5V
0V
0V
0V
320
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.7
CYCLE START LED
SIGNAL HAS TURNED
OFF
(1) After cycle operation is started, then stopped, check as follows:
(2) Confirm cycle start LED on machine operators panel.
(3) Confirm CNCs diagnostic function
The reason why cycle start LED signal (STL) has turned off are displayed
on CNCs diagnostic numbers 020 to 025 as follows:
1
r.c
om
Points
024 RESET ON
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
#7
#6
#5
#4
*ESP
#3
#2
#1
#0
#7
#6
#5
#4
*ESP
#3
#2
#1
#0
X1008
G0008
*ESP=0
#7
#6
#5
#4
*ESP
#3
#2
#1
#0
#7
#6
#5
#4
*ESP
#3
#2
#1
#0
X0008
G0008
*ESP=0
321
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
#7
ERS
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
#7
#6
RRW
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
r.c
G0008
om
An automatic operation is put into a reset status when RESET key on the
MDI panel is pressed.
#6(RRW) : When this signal is 1, the reset & rewind signal is input.
ce
nt
e
This signal is usually used for a confirmation signal of M30 when an M30
is specified in a program as the end of a program.
Therefore, when M30 is executed, this signal is input.
e. Servo alarm has
generated
When any servo alarm has generated, cycle operation is put into the reset
state and operation stop.
f. Cycle operation is in a
feed hold state
The cycle operation becomes feed hold state in the following cases:
1 Modes are switched from an automatic operation mode to a manual
operation mode.
2 Feed hold signal is input.
nc
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
G0043
memory edit(EDIT)
Automatic operation
(AUTO)
Manual data input (MDI)
Jog feed (JOG)
Handle/step
TEACH IN HANDLE
TEACH IN JOG
Manual
Man al
operation
.c
Automatic
operation
p
#2
MD4
#1
MD2
#0
MD1
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
#2
#1
#0
#6
G0008
#5
*SP
#4
#3
#6
#5
G0046
#4
#3
#2
#1
SBK
#0
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.8
NOTHING IS
DISPLAYED ON CRT
Check whether it is a trouble of display or a trouble of the system.
Check whether the STATUS LED on the main board shows the following
state.
1 2
f
STATUS
om
Points
(f : on,
: off)
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
r.c
323
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000010
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
(7) (8)
r.c
(6) (7)
(8)
om
(1)
(9)
ce
nt
e
(9)
A16B32000110
(10)
A16B22020860
(1)
(10)
(8)(9)
(11)
.c
nc
324
(7) (8)
(9)
(10)
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000160
(1)
om
(8) (9)
(10)
ce
nt
e
r.c
(11)
A16B2200091X
(1)
(7)
.c
nc
(6)
2. When system is in
trouble
1 2
f
STATUS
(f : on,
: off)
When STATUS LED on the main board is other than above, check LEDs
on the main CPU board and other optional boards,identify the trouble and
make an appropriate action. See 5.4.2 for LED display.
325
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.9
ALARM 85 TO 87
(READER/PUNCHER
INTERFACE ALARM)
(START)
Alarm 85?
YES
NO
NO
r.c
NO
YES
om
Alarm 86?
ce
nt
e
YES
OFF
Is power of I/O
?
ON
nc
YES
NO
.c
Alarm 87
Countermeasures
Causes
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
<Parameter>
Value of parameter 0020
Function
Feed
0101#7
0111#7
0121#7
0131#7
0101#3
0111#3
0121#3
0131#3
Stop bit
0101#0
0111#0
0121#0
0131#0
102
112
122
132
Baud rate
103
113
Communication
method
0135#3
om
123
133
RS232C
MAIN CPU BOARD
Connector
RS422
OPTION1 BOARD
JD5B
JD5C
r.c
JD5A
JD6A
ce
nt
e
#7
NFD
0101
0111
#5
#4
#3
ASI
#2
#1
#0
SB2
nc
0121
#6
0131
.c
#7(NFD) 0 : Feed is output before and after data in data output (FANUC PPR)
1 : Feed is not output (standard).
0102
0112
0122
0132
327
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
Value
Not used
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
0103
Baud rete
0113
0123
Value
0133
10
Baud rate
4800
600
11
9600
1200
12
19200
2400
nc
13
38400
14
76800
15
86400
.c
Value
0134
#7
#6
#5
CLK
#4
NCD
#3
#2
SYN
#1
PRY
#0
#5(CLK) 0 : Internal clock is used for baud rate clock of RS422 interface.
1 : External clock is used for baud rate clock of RS422 interface.
#4(NCD) 0 : CD (signal quality detection) of RS232C interface is checked.
1 : CD (signal quality detection) of RS232C interface is not checked.
#2(SYN) 0 : In protocol B, NC reset/alarm is not informed to the host.
1 : In protocol B, NC reset/alarm is informed to the host by SYN and
NAK code.
#1(PRY) 0 : No parity bit
1 : With parity bit
328
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
0135
#7
RMS
#6
#5
#4
#3
R42
#2
PRA
#1
ETX
#0
ASC
om
0 : Always transmitted by 0.
1 : Transmitted by the contents of remote / tape switching request issued
by SET command from the CNC.
r.c
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
#0(ASC) 0 : All the communication codes except for NC data is ISO code.
1 : All the communication codes except for NC data is ASCII code.
(b) External I/O device or Host computer is in trouble
(i) Check whether the setting on communication of external I/O
device or host computer is the same as that of the CNC. (baud
rate, stop bits,etc.) If they are not the same, change the setting.
(ii) When spare I/O device presents, check whether it is possible to
realize communication using the spare I/O device.
329
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000010
r.c
(1)
om
(1)
(6) (7)
(8)
(9)
ce
nt
e
(9)
A16B32000110
(7) (8)
(10)
A16B22020860
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
(8)(9)
(10)
(11)
.c
nc
330
(7) (8)
(9)
(10)
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000160
(1)
(8) (9)
(10)
ce
nt
e
(ii)
r.c
(11)
om
(Option 1 board)
nc
(7)
(5)
.c
(6)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
331
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
R2321(JD5B)
Option 1 board
R2321(JD5C)
om
Tape reader
r.c
Host computer
R2321(JD6A)
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
Host computer
332
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
(03) RD
(06) DR
om
(05) CS
(08) CD
r.c
(02) SD
(20) ER
(04) RS
(07) SG
ce
nt
e
(01)
(02)
(03)
(04)
(05)
(06)
(07)
(08)
(09)
+24V (10)
SD
(11)
0V
(12)
ER
(13)
0V
(14)
RS
(15)
0V
(16)
(17)
(18)
+24V (19)
(20)
Punch panel
(25) +24V
(01) FG
Shield
G
Connector : Halfpitch 20pins
.c
nc
R2323 (JD5C)
RD
0V
DR
0V
CS
0V
CD
0V
(01)
(02)
(039
(04)
(05)
(06)
(07)
(08)
(09)
+24V (10)
SD
(11)
0V
(12)
ER
(13)
0V
(14)
RS
(15)
0V
(16)
(17)
(18)
+24V (19)
(20)
Connector :DBM25Ss
Host computer
(02) SD
(20) ER
(04) RS
(08) CD
(03) RD
(06) DR
(05) CS
(07) SG
(25) +24V
(01) FG
Shield
G
Connector : Halfpitch 20pins
333
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
Notes
1 When CS is not used, connect it to RS.
2 For protocol A or extended protocol A: When DR is not used,
connect it to ER. Always connect CD to ER.
Host computer
R4221(JD6A)
RD
*RD
TT
*TT
RS
*RS
TR
*TR
SG
(06)
(24)
(08)
(26)
(09)
(27)
(11)
(29)
RD
*RD
RT
*RT
CS
*CS
DM
*DM
r.c
om
(04)
(22)
(17)
(35)
(07)
(25)
(12)
(30)
(19)
ce
nt
e
RD (01)
*RD (02)
RT (03)
*RT (04)
CS (05)
*CS (06)
DM (07)
Note) *DM (09)
0V (08)
(+24V) (10)
SD (11)
*SD (12)
TT (13)
*TT (14)
RS (15)
*RS (16)
TR (17)
*TR (18)
(+24V) (19)
(20)
(01) FG
Shield
nc
G
Connector : Halfpitch 20 pins (PCR)
.c
Note
Always use a twisted pair cable.
334
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.10
REFERENCE
POSITION DEVIATES
(START)
By 1 grid ?
YES
NO
om
NO
YES
Exchange dog.
As a temporary work,
lower rapid traverse
rate in reference position return
r.c
YES
NO
ce
nt
e
NO
Confirm connection
between servo motor and machine
YES
OFF
YES
Pulse coder is
faulty
Servo control
module or servo
interface module
is faulty.
.c
nc
Is 5V of pulse
coder correct ?
335
Confirm cable
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.11
ALARM 90
(REFERENCE
POSITION RETURN IS
ABNORMAL)
Contents
om
(START)
r.c
Countermeasures
Position error
amount : 300
ce
nt
e
128 or
more
YES
NO
nc
Position error=
.c
G detection unit[m/PLUSE]
Detection unit : Move amount to a command pulse (usually 1m)
In metric machine, if the no. of digits below decimal point is 4 on the
position display screen, detection unit is 0.1 mm.
ROV1
ROV2
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Override
100%
50%
25%
Fo rate
336
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
(1)
NO
Rotated ?
Chagne the return start position.
Move the machine at faster that 128
pulses for more than one rotation to
wards RP.
om
YES
NO
ce
nt
e
YES
r.c
Hardware failure
nc
.c
Notes
1 After the pulse coder or motor is exchanged, reference
position or machines standard point may be different from
former one. Please set it correctly.
2 When the main board is exchanged, all the data stored in
memory is lost. Reset all the NC data again, referring to the
data input/output item.
A speed more than 128 pulses is required because if speed is lower that
this, onerotation signal does not function stably, causing improper
position detection.
D Reference
337
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.12
ALARM 300
(REQUEST FOR
REFERENCE
POSITION RETURN)
(1) Execute manual reference position return only for an axis for which
this alarm was generated.When manual reference position return
cannot be executed because of an another alarm, set parameter 1815#5
to 0 and release the alarm and perform manual operation.
om
Remedies
r.c
(2) Press RESET key at the end of reference position return to release the
alarm.
Execute dogless reference position setting to memorize the reference
position.
Since the reference position is different from the former one, change the
grid shift value (PRM 1850) to correct the position.
Related parameters
#7
1815
ce
nt
e
#6
#5
APC x
#4
APZx
#3
#2
#1
#0
nc
.c
AMPx
ENCx
System configuration
APCBAT
PWM signal
Servo
amp.
Power cable
Feedback signal
Battery unit 6V
PC
Servo motor
PC : pulse coder
338
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.13
1 Agitate the absolute pulse coder cable connected to the main CPU
board. If an alarm is issued, replace the cable.
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
A16B32000010
(1)
.c
nc
(1)
(6) (7)
(8)
(9)
339
(7) (8)
(9)
(10)
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000110
A16B22020860
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
om
(8)(9)
(7) (8)
(10)
(9)
(10)
r.c
(11)
ce
nt
e
A16B32000160
(1)
(10)
(8) (9)
(11)
.c
nc
340
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B22020890, 0891
(6)
ce
nt
e
r.c
(6) (7)
(1)
om
(1)
nc
.c
(1) (2)
w
w
w
341
(7)
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.14
This alarm is generated when absolute pulse coder battery becomes low.
om
Exchange the battery connected to the connector JA4A on the main CPU
board or the connector JA4B on the option 2 board.
ce
nt
e
nc
r.c
Note
Change the batteries while power of NC is supplied.
Do not change the battery (memory backup battery) for the
control unit.
.c
Thread
Lid
342
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.15
ALARM 350 (SERIAL
PULSE CODER IS
ABNORMAL)
Points
#6
CSA
0202
#5
#4
PHA
#3
RCA
#2
#1
CKA
#0
SPH
r.c
om
ce
nt
e
nc
#7
DGN
#6
#5
0204
#4
LDA
#3
PMS
#2
#1
#0
.c
#3(PMS) Pulses are not issued correctly by abnormality of serial pulse coder C or
feedback cable.
(1) #4(LDA): LED in the serial pulse coder is abnormal.
Serial pulse coder is faultyRefer to Notes
(2) #3(PMS): Pulses are not issued correctly by abnormality of
feedback cable.
1 Fault of serial pulse coder Refer to Notes
2 Feedback cable is faulty.
Note
Reference position and machines standard position are
different from the ones before, adjust and set them correctly.
343
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.16
0202
#5
#4
PHA
#3
RCA
#2
#1
CKA
#0
SPH
om
#7
DGN
r.c
ce
nt
e
Causes
.c
nc
Notes
1 After the serial pulse coder is changed, reference position
or machines standard point is different from the one before
replacement. Therefore reset and adjust it again.
2 All the data stored in memory is lost when the main board
is changed. Set NC data again, referring to chapter 3 data
input/output.
344
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.17
Points
om
ALARM 400
(OVERLOAD)
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
r.c
DGN
0200
#7
OVL
#7
ALD
1
0
#6
#5
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
ce
nt
e
DGN
nc
(START)
NO
YES
.c
Is it hot ?
345
Overheat of motor
Defective thermostat
NOTE : After the motor is changed, reference
position or machines reference point is
different from the one before replace
ment. Set it again.
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
D Overheat of servo
amplifier
[6] ?
NO
YES
[-] ?
YES
YES
(1)
NO
nc
YES
.c
NO
YES
Servo amplifier is
faulty
346
Normal ?
ce
nt
e
NO(Not light)
r.c
Is amplifier hot
?
NO
om
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.18
ALARM 401 (*DRDY
SIGNAL TURNED
OFF)
om
NO(Not lit)
[-] ?
YES
r.c
Check if 100VAC is
supplied across 5 and 6
on terminal board T1 of
the servo unit
YES
Servo amp. is
faulty
ce
nt
e
Normal ?
NO
NO
100VAC is
normal ?
YES
Check magnetics
circuit
nc
.c
Note
When the main CPU board is replaced, all the data stored
in memory is lost. Set NC data again, referring to chapter 3.
Data input/output .
AMPx
10
DV
CN1
10
*MCOM
20
RV
20
T15, 6
RV
RLY
MCC
DV
*DRDY
From 1st axis to 4th axis are main CPU board. 5th axis or
later are option 2 board.
347
AC
100V
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
Servo enable
Position, velocity
control ready (*MCON)
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
Power ON
348
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.19
ALARM 404 AND 405
(*DRDY SIGNAL
TURNED ON)
D Alarm 404
om
D Causes
r.c
ce
nt
e
Note
When the main CPU board is replaced, all the data stored
in memory is lost. Set the NC data again, referring to chapter
3 data input/output.
AMPx
10
CN1
10
DV
RV
RLY
nc
*MCOM
20
20
MCC
100
VAC
DV
*DRDY
.c
RV
T15, 6
From 1st axis to 4th axis are main CPU board. 5th axis or later are option
2 board.
The grid signal is not turned on when the automatic reference position
return by G28 is completed.
D Causes
Note
When the main CPU board is replaced, all the data stored
in memory is lost. Set the NC data again, referring to
chapter 3 data input/output.
349
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.20
ALARM 410
(EXCESSIVE
POSITION ERROR
AMOUNT DURING
STOP)
Position error amount at stop (DGN 300) exceeds a value set by parameter
No. 1829.
(START)
Is it vertical
axis?
YES
NO
r.c
NO
Correct
?
om
Check parameters 1825 and 1829 if they are correct (see parameter list attached)
YES
Set correct
parameters.
Note)
ce
nt
e
YES
'1'?
NO
Check PMC
Recovered ?
NO
YES
nc
.c
Be carefull vertical
axis does not drop.
Measure in DC range
( No power ) ON
Power supplied?
YES
Note
When the main board is replaced, all the data stored in
memory is lost. Set NC data again, referring to chapter 3
data input/output .
350
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
ALRAM 411
(EXECESSIVE
POSITION ERROR
DURING MOVE)
Position error amount during movement (DGN 300) execeeds a value set
by parameter 1828.
(START)
Moves and
alarmed?
YES (Move)
(1)
om
8.21
NO (No move)
Measure by DC voltage
ce
nt
e
r.c
Power output ?
YES
Mechanical load is
excessive
Disconnection of
power line
NO (Not output)
Confirm eachaxis
servo off signal
G126.07=1
YES
nc
1 ?
NO
Signal line between main
CPU board or option 2
board and servo amplifier is
disconnected
YES
Normal ?
NO
Servo amplifier is
faulty
.c
Check PMC suquence, release servo off and check operation again
351
Cable is faulty
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
(1)
YES
NO
Compare the value Note 1)
obtained by the following formula and
DGN 300
om
Value fluctuate ?
Measure current at
IR and IS while moving the machine
NO
ce
nt
e
Correct ?
r.c
YES
nc
Compare value of
PRM1828 and the
list Note2)
Correct ?
Servo amplifier is
faulty.
Main CPU board or option 2 board is faulty.
Mechanical load is
large. Refer to
alarm 400.
NO
Servo amplifier is
faulty
Correct parameters
Notes
Feed rate (mmmin)
1
1 Position error=
Detection unit
60 PRM1825
2 Parameter 1828yPosition error at rapid traverse
1.2
.c
YES
352
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.22
ALARM 414 (DIGITAL
SERVO SYSTEM IS
ABNORMAL)
EXAMPLE OF DISPLAY
AXIS NAME DETECTED
IS DISPLAYED
Points
om
Check details by CNCs diagnostic fucntion and LED display on the servo
amplifier.
1
#6
LV
0200
#4
HCA
#3
HVA
#2
DCA
#1
FBA
#0
OFA
ce
nt
e
#5
OVC
r.c
#7
DGN
STATUS
nc
#7
DGN
0204
.c
#7
#5
MCC
#4
#3
#2
#1
#0
#6
LV
#5
OVC
#4
HCA
#3
HVA
#2
DCA
#1
FBA
#0
OFA
DGN
#6
OFS
353
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
D #6(LV):Insufficient
voltage alarm
YES
om
Voltage is
normal ?
NO
ce
nt
e
r.c
Servo amplifier is
faulty
Is voltage
normal ?
NO
Input voltage is
abnormal
YES
Servo amplifier is
faulty
YES
Breaker off ?
NO
Turn off breaker and
check again
.c
nc
(START)
Is voltage
normal ?
YES
Servo amplifier
is faulty
354
NO
Input voltage
is abnormal
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
D #5(OVC):Over current
detection by software
(START)
YES
ce
nt
e
r.c
NO
Larger than
1.4 times ?
om
Check current at check terminal IR and IS at servo amplifier and compare with rated
current of motor
Within rated
current ?
NO
YES
.c
nc
Machine load is
large. Check load
at machine side.
Correct ?
YES
Servo amplifier is
faulty
Main CPU or option
2 board is faulty.
NO
Correct parameters.
355
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
D #4(HCA):Abnormal
current alarm
(Servo amp. LED:[8]
lights)
(START)
NO
om
Alarmed ?
YES
r.c
YES
Alarmed ?
ce
nt
e
NO
.c
nc
356
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
D #3(HVA):Over voltage
alarm (Servo amp.LED
[1] lights)
NO
r.c
YES
NO
om
Is voltage
normal ?
ce
nt
e
YES
YES
nc
NO
.c
357
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
D #2(DCA):Discharge alarm
Generate at
power on ?
YES
NO
Generate during
deceleration ?
om
YES
Check frequency of
acceleration/deceleration
NO
NO
ce
nt
e
r.c
NO.
YES
Frequent ?
YES
.c
nc
358
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
(START)
Servo amp.
(C series)
T1
T3
15
TH 3
Generate at
power on?
YES
TH
16
ALM
0V
NO
YES
RV
Is unit hot ?
NO
om
r.c
Check resistance
across terminals
T1(15) and (16).
0 ?
NO
ce
nt
e
YES
Is larger than
rated current ?
YES
NO
.c
nc
Measure reistance
across 3 and 4 at
terminal board of
separate type discharge unit.
0 ?
Wired ?
YES
NO
YES
NO
359
Disconnection of
cable between separate type dischrge
unit and servo amp.
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
D #1(FBA):DISCONNECTIO
N ALARM
0201
#7
ALD
#6
#5
#4
EXP
#3
#2
#1
#0
ENCX
SCALEX
om
DGN
Note
r.c
Note
This alarm is related with fullclosed system.
D Causes
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
Notes
1 After the pulse coder is replaced, reference position or
machines standard position is different from former one.
Adjust and set it correctly.
2 When the main CPU board is replaced, all the data stored
in memory is lost. Set NC data again, referring to chapter 3
data input/output.
Linear scale
From 1st axis to 4th axis are main CPU board. 5th axis or later are
option 2 board.
7)#0(OFA):Overflow alarm
360
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
causes
When 1 is displayed at
DGN 204
#7
DGN
#6
OFS
0204
#5
MCC
#4
#3
#2
om
Note
When the main CPU board is replaced, all the data stored
in memory is lost. Set NC data again, referring to chapter
3 data input/output .
#1
#0
r.c
#6(OFS): A/D converter used for current feedback in the digital servo is abnormal.
#5(MCC): Contacts of electromagnetic contactor in the servo amp. is blown.LED
7 lights.
D #6(OFS):A/D converter is
abnormal
(START)
nc
D #5(MCC):Contacts of
electromagnetic
contactor is blown within
servo amp.
ce
nt
e
[7] ?
YES
.c
Check LED of
servo amplifier
YES
361
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
D LED display
Display
Meaning
Explanation
Power to the servo converter is not supplied.
NOT READY
READY
HV
Excessive
voltage alarm
LV5V
Control power
low alarm
ce
nt
e
DCSW
Abnormal regenerative control circuit
r.c
LVDC
DC link voltage
low alarm
om
Power off
OH
Servo amplifier
overheat
MCC
Electro magnetic
contactor
HCL
L axis excess
current
HCM
M axis excess
current
HCLM
Excess current
.c
nc
DCOH
Excessive regenerative discharge
D LVDC alarm
362
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
D DCSW alarm
This alarm is lit when the transistor for regenerative discharging turns on
more than 1 second.
Its causes are;
1) Mulfunction of servo amplifier such as regenerative discharge circuit.
2) Regenerative discharge energy is excessive due to cutting conditions.
D DCOH alarm
om
D Check terminals on
servo amp.
When you open the cover of the terminal board, you can see the check
terminal below LED.
r.c
D MCC alarm
ce
nt
e
Terminal name
Meaning
0V
5V
IRL
ISL
IRM
nc
OV
ISM
.c
D Current/volt
Type of unit
(A/V)
A06B6066H222
1/1
A06B6066H003
A06B6066H223
1/3
A06B6066H004
10
A06B6066H224
1/10
A06B6066H006
20
A06B6066H233
3/3
A06B6066H234
3/10
A06B6066H244
10/10
A/V
A06B6066H002
Type of unit
363
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
D Current waveform
(Servo amplifier)
Check terminal
IRM
ISL
ISM
0V
+5V
ce
nt
e
0V
r.c
om
IRL
.c
nc
Alarm display
364
Convert this
voltage into
current value
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.23
ALRAM 416
(DISCONNECTION
ALARM)
Point
#6
#5
#4
EXP
#3
#2
#1
#0
om
DGN
0201
ENCX
SCALEX
r.c
Note
ce
nt
e
Note
This alarm is related with fullclosed system.
Causes
.c
nc
Notes
1 After the pulse coder is replaced, reference position or
machines standard position is different from former one.
Adjust and set it correctly.
2 When the main board is replaced, all the data stroed in
memory is lost. Set NC data again, referring to chapter 3
Data input/output .
Linearscale
Main CPU
board or Option
2 board
PC
ENCx
SCALEx
x is an axis number
From 1st axis to 4th axis are main CPU board. 5th axis or more are option
2 board.
365
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.24
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
This data indicates the cause of servo alarm No. 417, detected by the NC. If the
alarm is detected by the servo, the PRM bit (bit 4 of DGN No. 0203) is set to
1.
#7
#6
AXS
#5
#4
DIR
#3
PLS
#2
PLC
#1
#0
MOT
nc
0280
#0(MOT) : The motor type specified in parameter No. 2020 falls outside the
predetermined range.
.c
#2(PLC) : The number of velocity feedback pulses per motor revolution, specified in
parameter No. 2023, is zero or less. The value is invalid.
#3(PLS) : The number of position feedback pulses per motor revolution, specified in
parameter No. 2024, is zero or less. The value is invalid.
#4(DIR) : The wrong direction of rotation for the motor is specified in parameter No.
2022 (the value is other than 111 or 111).
#6(AXS) : In parameter No. 1023 (servo axis number), a value that falls outside the
range of 1 to the number of controlled axes is specified. (For example, 4 is
specified instead of 3.) Alternatively, the values specified in the
parameter are not consecutive.
366
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.25
ALARM 700
(OVERHEAT AT
CONTROL SIDE)
Remedies
Check fan on the top of the control unit is operating when power is on.
ce
nt
e
YES
r.c
NO
Operating
om
(START)
High temperature ?
YES
nc
NO
.c
367
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.26
YES
r.c
Constant ?
om
NO
ce
nt
e
YES
Heavy cutting?
NO
.c
nc
Worn ?
YES
Replace tool
NO
Remedies
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.27
ALARM 749
(SERIAL SPINDLE
COMMUNICATION
ERROR)
Causes and Remedies
Improper connection between the main CPU board and the serial spindle.
The following reason is considered.
om
<Spindle module>
For Series 16 main CPU A20B29010980,0981,0982
For Series 16 option A20B29010984,0985,0986
r.c
Main
CPU
Calendar clock
RAM
Spindle control
ce
nt
e
ROM
D/A converter
Spindle
amplifier
Optical cable
nc
.c
A16B32000010
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
(1)
(6) (7)
(8)
(9)
369
(7) (8)
(9)
(10)
to
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000110
A16B22020860
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
om
(8)(9)
(10)
(7) (8)
(9)
ce
nt
e
A16B32000160
(1)
nc
(8) (9)
(11)
.c
(10)
370
(10)
r.c
(11)
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
(1)
r.c
(1)
om
A16B22020890, 0891
A16B22020400, 0401
ce
nt
e
(6) (7)
nc
.c
(1) (2)
371
(6)
(7)
to
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.28
When the spindle amplifier does not become normal state immediately
after power is turned on in the serial spindle system, this alarm is
informed.
om
This alarm does not occur once the system becomes ready including the
spindle system .
This alarm occurs during power on sequence before the system becomes
ready.
After the system becomes ready, serial spindle alarm is issued by alarm
749.
r.c
Causes
ce
nt
e
Details of Alarms
nc
DGN
#6
#5
0409
#4
#3
SPE
#2
S2E
#1
S1E
#0
SHE
.c
#3(SPE) 0 : In spindle serial control, the serial spindle parameters satisfies the
starting conditions for spindle amplifier.
1 : In spindle serial control, the serial spindle parameters do not satisfy
the starting conditions for spindle amplifier.
372
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
Remedies
om
Check the 2nd spindle parameters and connections to see whether the
spindle is mechanically and electronically connected to the spindle.
ce
nt
e
r.c
If the above settings and connections are right, the module of (4) or the
spindle amplifier itself may be defective.
(3) #1(SIE)1: When an abnormality is found in the 1st spindle at the start
of serial spindle control, exchange the unit if the following
check items are not concerned.
Check the parameters and connections at the 1st spindle to see whether
the 1st spindle is mechanically and electrically connected.
.c
nc
373
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000010
r.c
(1)
om
(1)
(6) (7)
(8)
(9)
ce
nt
e
(9)
A16B32000110
(7) (8)
(10)
A16B22020860
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
(8)(9)
(10)
(11)
.c
nc
374
(7) (8)
(9)
(10)
to
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000160
(1)
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
(11)
r.c
(8) (9)
(10)
om
375
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
(1)
r.c
(1)
om
A16B22020400, 0401
ce
nt
e
(6) (7)
.c
nc
(1) (2)
376
(6)
(7)
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.29
ALARM 751,761
(SPINDLE ALARM)
With serial spindle system, an alarm on the spindle unit is informed to the
CNC.
751 ( Alarm detection by 1st spindle )
761( Alarm detection by 2nd spindle )
The alarm contents is displayed by ALxx on the display of spindle amp.
Refer to appendix 2.3 or 2.4 for the contents.
The CNC holds an alarm number display (ALxx).
This alarm informs of trouble of spindle control unit.
Repair the spindle side by the method of remedy for each alarm.
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
D Point
377
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.30
ROM PARITY
CNC
r.c
900
om
SYSTEM ALARM
Defective file
or ROM is displayed
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
Confirm the series and versions of control software those are displayed
on upper right of the screen.
*FROM module may be written data by machine tool builder.
*Mounting position of ROM/FROM module
378
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000010
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
r.c
(6) (7)
(8)
om
(1)
(9)
ce
nt
e
(9)
A16B32000110
(7) (8)
(10)
A16B22020860
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
(8)(9)
(10)
(11)
.c
nc
379
(7) (8)
(9)
(10)
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000160
(1)
(10)
(11)
r.c
(8) (9)
om
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
380
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.31
A parity bit is prepared for writing data in memory correctly. There are
oddnumber parity and evennumber parity.
#6
0
#5
1
#4
1
#3
0
#2
1
#1
1
#0
1
#P
0
(Parity bit)
(Evennumber
parity)
om
#7
1
(1) Causes are faults of RAM on the main board or RAM module, or fault
of data memorized in RAM. When this alarm occurs immediately
after power is turned on, once turn off power, then turn on power while
and
RESET
DELETE
r.c
pushing
ce
nt
e
If parity error is not released by clearing all memory, RAM on the main
board or RAM module may be faulty. Change (4)RAM module on
main CPU board.
Set all the data again, referring to chapter 3 data input/output.
1 : SRAM module (Part program editing, parameters)
<Main CPU board>
A16B32000170
A16B32000010
(1)
nc
(10)
(1)
.c
(10)
(6) (7)
(8)
(9)
(7) (8)
(9)
(10)
381
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000110
A16B22020860
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
om
(8)(9)
(10)
(7) (8)
(9)
ce
nt
e
A16B32000160
(1)
(4)(5)(6)(7)
(8) (9)
(10)
(11)
.c
nc
(2) (3)
382
(10)
r.c
(11)
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
383
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.32
The DRAM module on the main CPU board may be faulty. Replace the
DRAM module.
om
A16B32000170
r.c
A16B32000010
(1)
ce
nt
e
(1)
(6) (7)
(8)
(9)
nc
(9)
A16B32000110
(10)
.c
A16B22020860
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
(7) (8)
(8)(9)
(10)
(11)
384
(7) (8)
(9)
(10)
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000160
(1)
(10)
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
(11)
r.c
(8) (9)
om
385
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.33
ALARM 920 TO 923
(WATCH DOG OR
RAM PARITY)
points
The timer used to monitor the operation of CPU is called the watch dog
timer. The CPU resets timer time every time a constant time has passed.
When an error occurs in CPU or peripheral device, timer is not reset but
the alarm is informed.
om
The servo module includes servo RAM, watch dog timer circuit, etc.
Defectiveness of hardware, abnormality or malfunctioning of detection
circuit or the like is considered. Therefore, replace servo module on the
main CPU board for alarm 920 and 921; replace servo module on the
option 2 board for alarm 922 and 923.
ce
nt
e
r.c
Main
CPU
ROM
Servo module
(A20B29020060, A20B29020061)
.c
nc
RAM
CPU or peripheral circuits may be faulty. Replace the main CPU board.
Software may not work properly due to failure of FROM module. Change
FROM module.
DC output voltage of power supply unit may be faulty. Replace the power
supply unit.
386
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000170
A16B32000010
(1)
om
r.c
(1)
(6) (7)
(8)
(9)
(10)
ce
nt
e
(9)
(7) (8)
A16B32000110
nc
A16B22020860
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
.c
(8)(9)
(10)
(11)
387
(7) (8)
(9)
(10)
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000160
(1)
(10)
(11)
r.c
(8) (9)
om
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
388
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B22020400,0401
(6)
ce
nt
e
r.c
(6) (7)
(1)
om
(1)
nc
A16B22020850,0851,0853
.c
(1) (2)
w
w
w
389
(7)
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.34
Note
This alarm may not occur during normal operaion.
This alarm may be generated when a PCB is changed for
maintenance.
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
<Option 2 board>
5th to 8th axis servo module
(A20B29020060 or A20B2902 0061)
Unless these boards are mounted correctly, if this alarm still generates,
change main CPU board, option 2 board and/ or servo module.
A20B29020060
A20B29020061
.c
nc
390
Standard
For Learning control
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.35
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
391
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.36
D For PMCRB
D For PMCRC
Module mounting
position
(Main CPU)
A16B32000170
ce
nt
e
A16B32000010
r.c
om
(1)
(8)
(6) (7)
(9)
.c
nc
(1)
392
(7) (8)
(9)
(10)
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B22020860
A16B32000110
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
om
(8)(9)
(10)
(7) (8)
(9)
ce
nt
e
A16B32000160
nc
(1)
.c
(8) (9)
(10)
(11)
393
(10)
r.c
(11)
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.37
(5)
PMCRC
CPU
om
PMC control
ce
nt
e
Module mounting
position
(Option 3 board)
.c
nc
(1) (2)(3)(4)(5)
(4)
r.c
(1)
394
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.38
RAM parity error or NMI has occurred in the PMC control module.
Main
CPU
<PMC module>
ROM
PMC control
RAM
FANUC
I/O
unit
r.c
PMCRA or
PMCRB user program
+24V
power
supply
ce
nt
e
om
Module mounting
position
A16B32000170
nc
A16B32000010
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
(7) (8)
.c
(6) (7)
(1)
(8)
(9)
395
(9)
(10)
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
A16B32000110
A16B22020860
(1)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
om
(8)(9)
(10)
(7) (8)
(9)
ce
nt
e
A16B32000160
(1)
(8) (9)
(11)
.c
nc
(10)
396
(10)
r.c
(11)
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.39
ALARM 971
(NMI ALARM IN SLC)
Causes and Remedies
om
Main
CPU
<PMC module>
ROM
FANUC
I/O
unit
PMC control
RAM
PMCRA or
PMCRB
user program
memory
r.c
ce
nt
e
+24V
power
supply
1
CP32
+24V
GND
Unused
.c
nc
Interface module
AF01A/AF01B
397
8. TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.40
NMI has generated in a board other than the main CPU board.
ALARM 972
(NMI ALARM)
1) Any of option boards shown below may be faulty.
Option 1 board
Option 2 board
Option 3 board
Loader control board
Change above boards in the order, in which replacement is easier.
om
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
Note
When you change option 2 board, you must input data
(parameters, programs, etc.) on sub side.
When you change loader control board, you must input data
(parameters, programs, etc.) on loader side.
398
8.TROUBLESHOOTING
B62445E/03
8.41
ALARM 973
(NMI ALARM BY
UNKNOWN CAUSE)
Causes and Remedies
om
r.c
Note
When the main CPU board is replaced, all the data in
memory is lost. Set the NC data (parameter, offset and
program etc) again.
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
Note
When you change the option 2 board, you must input data
(parameters, programs,etc.) on the sub side.
When you change loader control board, you must input data
again (parameters, programs, etc.)
399
B62445E/03
om
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
400
B62445E/03
9.1
LIST OF SERIAL
INTERFACE SPINDLE
AMPLIFIER ALARMS
For troubleshooting the listed alarms, refer to 9.2 TROUBLE
SHOOTING FOR EACH ALARM.
Alarm No.
Meanings
Description
Remedy
AL02
AL03
Excessive speed
Reset alarm.
Detects abnormal temperature rise of power Cool radiator, then reset alarm.
transistor radiator.
Overvoltage in DC link
section
Overcurrent in DC link
section
Spindle switch/output
switch alarm
Check sequence.
RAM abnormality
Excessive U phase
current detection circuit
offset
Detects excessive U phase current detection circuit offset. This check is made only
when power is turned on.
AL19
Excessive V phase
current detection circuit
offset
Detects excessive V phase current detection circuit offset. This check is made only
when power is turned on.
AL20
AL24
AL25
Disconnection of speed
detection signal for Cs
contouring control
Detects abnormality in speed detection signal for Cs contouring control (such as unconnected cable and adjustment error).
AL26
AL07
AL11
AL12
AL13
AL15
AL16
.c
AL10
AL09
nc
AL08
AL18
r.c
AL05
ce
nt
e
AL04
om
Motor overheat
AL01
401
Alarm No.
Meanings
B62445E/03
Description
Remedy
Disconnection of
position detection signal
for Cs contouring control
Short-time overload
Detects that overload has been continuously applied for some period of time (such as
restraining motor shaft in positioning).
Detects that motor cannot rotate at specified Correct cause, then reset alarm.
speed (but rotates at very slow speed or
has stopped). (This includes checking of
speed detection signal cable.)
Abnormality in RAM
internal to LSI for serial
data transfer
Insufficient DC link
section charging
Detects insufficient charging of direct current power supply voltage in power circuit
section when magnetic contactor in amplifier is turned on (such as open phase and
defective charging resistor).
AL34
AL35
AL36
AL37
AL39
AL40
AL41
AL42
AL30
AL31
AL32
.c
nc
AL33
AL43
AL46
AL47
AL48
r.c
AL29
ce
nt
e
AL28
om
AL27
402
B62445E/03
Alarm No.
Meanings
Description
Remedy
AL50
Excessive speed
command calculation
value in spindle
synchronization control
Undervoltage at DC link
section
Detects abnormality in synchronization signal (ITP signal) with CNC (such as loss of
ITP signal).
Detects abnormality in synchronization signal (ITP signal) with CNC (such as loss of
ITP signal).
AL53
AL54
.c
nc
AL55
r.c
AL52
ce
nt
e
AL51
om
AL49
403
B62445E/03
9.2
TROUBLESHOOTING
FOR EACH ALARM
AL01
Motor overheat
Cause of trouble
Overload operation
Disconnection or
loose contact of
motor overheat
signal line
AL02
Excessive speed
deviation
ce
nt
e
Remedy
r.c
Check procedure
om
Item
Cause of trouble
Overload operation
(overload)
Defective transistor
module
Speed feedback
signal abnormality
Wiring failure
(disconnection,
loose contact, etc.)
nc
Item
.c
Check procedure
Remedy
Note
How to check the speed feedback signal
Observe the speed feedback signal with an osciloscope
after turning on power and setting the rotation command off
(motor stopped and drive power set off).
Observe the test points indicated below, while turning the
motor slowly by hand.
404
B62445E/03
Test point
PA0V
Vpp=0.36 0.5V
About 2.5V
0V
PB0V
Same as above
RA0V
DC2.5V0.2V
RB0V
Same as above
PAP
ON OFF
om
PAA0V
PBA0V
(CW rotation)
0V
ON
OFF
r.c
PBP
4.5V
0V
ce
nt
e
0.4V
Blown fuse in DC
link section
AL04
This alarm indicates that the fuse (F4) in the DC link section is blown.
In this case, the transistor module may have failed.
nc
AL03
.c
Item
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
High impedance on
AC power supply
side.
Example:
Two transformers
are connected in
series, or variable
autotransformer is
connected.
Defective transistor
module
Remedy
Change power supply to
one with low impedance.
There may be loose connection of input power
cable
Example:
Open phase due to
screws not tightened
firmly
Replace transistor module
and fuse.
405
AL05
Control power
supply fuse blown
Item
1
Cause of trouble
B62445E/03
Check procedure
Defective PCB
Replace PCB.
Check AC input voltage.
voltage
See (5) above.
Item
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
Incorrect setting of
parameter for number
of speed feedback
pulses (No. 6511)
Excessive speed
Note
See Chapter 6.
AL08
Check procedure
ce
nt
e
Item
Remedy
Set correct value in
parameter.
om
(Detection by
digital value)
r.c
AL07
Remedy
Remedy
Item
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
Replace fan.
nc
Incorrect setting of
toggle switch for voltage switching.
Heat sink is
overheated
AL09
Overvoltage of DC
link circuit
(Regenerative
circuit is
faultyRegenerati
on failure)
AL11
Input power
voltage drops
AL10
AL12
Remedy
.c
Overload operation.
Overcurrent flows
to DC link circuit
Item
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
Remedy
PCB is defective.
Replace PCB.
Defective transistor
module (TM1).
Item
Cause of trouble
Output terminals or
internal circuit of motor is shorted.
Check connections.
Transistor module is
defective.
PCB is defective.
406
Check procedure
Remedy
B62445E/03
AL13
AL16
Replace PCB .
RAM abnormality
1
Program ROM
sum check error
AL18
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
Remedy
PCB defective
Replace PCB.
om
Item
Remedy
Program memory
data (ROM) defective
Item
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
r.c
Check procedure
ce
nt
e
Excessive U
phase current
detection circuit
offset
Cause of trouble
AL19
Item
Remedy
Replace PCB.
Ensure that PCB and power circuit are securely connected with each other.
nc
Excessive V
phase current
detection circuit
offset
Item
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
Replace PCB.
Ensure that PCB and power circuit are securely connected with each other.
Item
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
Remedy
Defective optical
cable for serial data
transmission
Connect securely.
Replace optical cable.
Clean optical cable transmission/reception surfaces.
Serial transfer
data error
AL24
.c
AL20
Serial data
transfer stopped
AL25
407
Remedy
Replace LSI.
Replace PCB.
Item
Cause of trouble
Position coder
signal
disconnection
Item
Cause of trouble
Remedy
Check procedure
ce
nt
e
AL27
Check procedure
om
Disconnection of
speed detection
signal for Cs
contouring
control
Parameter CAXIS1 = 0
No. 4001#5
r.c
AL26
B62445E/03
Remedy
Incorrect parameter
setting
Parameter MRDY2 = 0
No. 4001#2
nc
Disconnection of
position detection
signal for Cs
contouring
control
Item
Cause of trouble
.c
AL28
Item
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
Remedy
Check procedure
Shorttime
overload
AL29
408
Remedy
Re-examine cutting
conditions and tools.
B62445E/03
Item
Cause of trouble
AL31
Speed detection
signal
disconnection
motor restraint
alarm
Defective of power
transistor used for
power
Defective of power
regeneration circuit
Item
w
w
AL35
Remedy
Defective motor
speed feedback
signal
Remove cause.
Defective motor
speed feedback
signal cable
ce
nt
e
Item
Cause of trouble
Item
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
Check procedure
Remedy
Replace LSI.
Replace PCB.
Remedy
Replace amp.
.c
Parameter data
setting beyond
allowable range
of values
AL34
Check procedure
Remove cause.
nc
Insufficient DC
link section
charging
Replace PCB.
AL33
Remedy
Replace power transistor.
Motor constrained
Abnormality in
RAM internal to
LSI for serial data
transfer
Cause of trouble
AL32
Check procedure
Check power transistor.
om
Input circuit
overcurrent
r.c
AL30
Excessive gear
ratio data setting
Item
1
Cause of trouble
Incorrect parameter
setting
Check procedure
Remedy
Item
1
Cause of trouble
Parameter data of
gear ratio and position gain are too
large.
409
Check procedure
Check gear ratio and
position gain data.
Remedy
Change to suitable values.
AL37
Speed detector
parameter setting
error
B62445E/03
AL41
Alarm for
indicating failure
in detecting
position coder
1rotation signal
Item
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
Item
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
No occurrence of
1-rotation signal
among Cs contouring
control feedback
signals, or 1-rotation
signal offset adjustment error
Cause of trouble
om
Remedy
Remedy
Check procedure
Remedy
Incorrect setting of
parameter for number
of position coder signal pulses (No.
4003#4,6,7).
Incorrect amplitude
and offset of position
coder feedback signal, or noise on same
feedback signal.
Item
Cause of trouble
Check procedure
Remedy
Incorrect setting of
parameter for number
of position coder signal pulses
(No. 4003#4,6,7).
Incorrect amplitude
and offset of position
coder feedback signal, or noise on same
feedback signal.
nc
Item
Remedy
Set correct value in
parameter.
r.c
Alarm for
indicating
1rotation signal
for Cs contouring
control not
detected
ce
nt
e
AL40
Check procedure
Incorrect setting of
parameter for number
of speed feedback
pulses (No. 6511)
Alarm for
indicating failure
in detecting
1rotation signal
for Cs contouring
control
Cause of trouble
AL39
Item
Position coder
signal
abnormality
AL47
.c
410
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
(ANALOG INTERFACE SPINDLE)
B62445E/03
10
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
MODULE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421
411
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
(ANALOG INTERFACE SPINDLE)
B62445E/03
10.1
AL01
(MOTOR OVERHEAT)
Model 6S to 22S (A20B10030010)
(Start)
PCB
R11
ALM
NO
RV
0V
r.c
24V
(contact open)
?
om
+24V
YES
ce
nt
e
Model 1S to 3S (A16B11000200)
PCB
(Start)
+15V
.c
nc
RV
2
CN4
9 Inside unit
TH
NO
YES
10
0V
Contact open ?
ALM
412
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
(ANALOG INTERFACE SPINDLE)
B62445E/03
10.2
AL02
(EXCESSIVE
DEVIATION OF
SPEED)
YES
NO
Regenerative discharge
circuit is faulty
Regenerative transistor
module is faulty
Load inertia is large
PCB is faulty
NO (No rotation)
ce
nt
e
YES
Refer to 10.10
Confirmation of
Transistor Module
r.c
Does it occur
during deceleration?
om
(Start)
* Under AL02
not generated
Command about
10 rpm speed.
nc
YES
NO
Check voltage of
RA and RB
w
w
w
NO
PCB is faulty
Transistor module is faulty
(Disconnection across C and E)
Unit is faulty (Check Ch.VDC)
YES
.c
Is the speed
displayed?
Disconnection of
power line
Motor is defective
Machine load is large
Normal output at
terminal U, V, W?
NO
(2.5V 0.2V)
Does PA and
PB change?
YES
NO
PCB is faulty
If current limitter is operating,
machine load is excessive
(more than 4. 2V at IU)
413
PCB is faulty
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
(ANALOG INTERFACE SPINDLE)
B62445E/03
10.3
AL06, 07
(OVER SPEED)
(Start)
Does it exceed
rated speed?
NO (115% or less)
YES
* Unused for 1S to 3S
r.c
om
Check specification of
ROM
PCB is faulty
YES
ce
nt
e
DA2?
Measure ER under
emergency stop state
NO
(Normal)
PCB is faulty
NO
nc
Nearly 0V?
YES
PCB is faulty
.c
YES
PCB is faulty
414
S analog voltage is in
error or adjustment is
required
NC side PCB is faulty
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
(ANALOG INTERFACE SPINDLE)
B62445E/03
10.4
AL09
(UNIT OVERHEAT /
6S TO 26S ONLY)
(Start)
PCB
ALM
NO
0V
YES
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
RV
r.c
om
+24V
415
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
(ANALOG INTERFACE SPINDLE)
B62445E/03
10.5
AL10
(LOW INPUT
VOLTAGE)
SDC : 5V / 500V
Terminal DTDC for 1S to 3S
NO
r.c
1.5V or less?
YES
ce
nt
e
om
(Start)
NO
* No fuse for 1S to 3S
YES
nc
.c
416
Instantaneous power
interruption
PCB is faulty
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
(ANALOG INTERFACE SPINDLE)
B62445E/03
10.6
AL11
(DC LINK EXCESSIVE
VOLTAGE)
(Start)
VDC : 5V/500V
om
Measure voltage at
test point VDC
YES
r.c
4.5V or more
NO
NO
ce
nt
e
YES
nc
Shorted?
NO
.c
417
Replace transistor
module and PCB
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
(ANALOG INTERFACE SPINDLE)
B62445E/03
10.7
AL12
(DC LINK EXCESSIVE
CURRENT)
(Start)
NO
YES
r.c
Shortcircuited
across C and E?
om
Replace transistor
module and PCB
ce
nt
e
YES
AL12?
NO
NO
YES
NO
PCB is faulty (vibration)
Current feedback signal
is abnormal
Is power line
shortcircuited
or grounded?
.c
nc
PCB is faulty
418
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
(ANALOG INTERFACE SPINDLE)
B62445E/03
10.8
ABNORMAL SOUND
AND VIBRATION
DURING ROTATION
YES
ce
nt
e
YES
NO
nc
NO
.c
Is there any
relation?
r.c
Check waveform
with synchroscope
during rotation
TSA
ER
Is abnormality
confirmed?
om
(Start)
Is abnormal
sound heard?
YES
Problem of machine
NO
+5V
YES
PAP
Check incorrect signal
of pulse generator
Failure of machine
PCB is faulty
Check parameters F21,
22, 25, and 26
0V
+5V
PBP
0V
1/2
419
1:1
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
(ANALOG INTERFACE SPINDLE)
B62445E/03
10.9
NO ROTATION OR
INCORRECT SPEED
(Start)
NO
om
Is power supplied to
PCB correctly?
YES
Is VCMD normal?
ce
nt
e
YES
r.c
YES
nc
NO
(0V)
.c
Forward
Reverse
w
w
MCC is off
Check following signals :
*ESP signal
MRDY signal
Speed zero signal (SSTP)
NO
PCB is faulty
Is voltage normal?
Is voltage at
DA2 normal?
Orientation
PCB is faulty
Caution
1 Whille you are checking above items, if the system may
recover, the spindle may suddenly start its rotation.
Therefore, take enough care when you access the spindle
or its peripherals.
420
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
(ANALOG INTERFACE SPINDLE)
B62445E/03
10.10
B1
B3
B5
B3
B1
B4
B6
()
N
Uo
(+)
B2
Vo
Wo
ce
nt
e
Uo
B4
B5
Vo
(+)
P
Wo
B6
r.c
B2
om
CONFIRMATION OF
TRANSISTOR
MODULE
N
()
Tester
Normal
Abnormal
C:+
100 ohms
Short, infinity
C:
Infinity
C:+
100 ohms
Short, infinity
C:
Infinity
B:+
100 ohms
Short, infinity
B:
100 ohms
Short, infinity
CE
nc
CB
.c
BE
Collector (C)
Base (B)
Emittor (E)
421
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
om
APPENDIXES
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
om
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
425
APPENDIX
SYSTEM
CONFIGURATION
Master
FS16/18
Base 1
I/O UNIT
I/O UNIT
I/O UNIT
Group 0
Group 1
om
A.1
B62445E/03
r.c
Group 2
ce
nt
e
Group 15
nc
* The number and types of slave units that can be connected for each
group are as follows :
Up to two I/O Units
One Power Mate
One Operatorspanel connection unit
One Series 0C
A.2
Base unit
(ABU05A or ABU10A)
.c
HARDWARE
CONFIGURATION
Label
(indicating the
specifications)
Input /Output modules
Interface module (AIF01A or AIF01B)
426
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
A.3
LED INDICATION
AIF01A
Symbol
Description
fPWR
fLINK
LINK
BA0
BA1
fBA1
fBA0
AIF01A
om
PWR
BA1
Base #0
Base #1
Base #2
Base #3
ce
nt
e
r.c
fPWR
AIF01B
F:On
f:Off
fLINK
AIF01B
.c
nc
Symbol
Description
PWR
LINK
A01234567
Afffff
Symbol
Description
A0 - 7
B0 - 7
B01234567
427
APPENDIX
A.4
B62445E/03
FUSES
Module
Indication
of whether
a fuse has
blown
Rated current
PWR off
A60L00010290#LM32
3.2A
A60L00010290#LM32
3.2A
F on
A60L00010260#5R00
5A
F on
A60L00010260#5R00
5A
F on
A60L00010276#3.15
3.15A
F on
A60L00010276#3.15
3.15A
F on
A60L00010276#3.15
3.15A
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
PWR off
428
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
A.5
REMOVING A
PRINTED CIRCUIT
BOARD
D Removing a
terminalboxtype
input/output module
om
LED cap
(2)
Terminal
box
ce
nt
e
r.c
(1)
nc
Claw
.c
Connector
Claw
4 As shown on the right, insert a screwdriver into the gap between the
module case and the connector of the terminal box. To remove the
printed circuit board, push the connector in the direction indicated by
arrow B while pushing the screwdriver in the direction indicated by
arrow A
Underside of the module
Connector
429
APPENDIX
D Removing a
connectortype
input/output module
B62445E/03
Connector
om
Cover
r.c
2 To remove the LED cap, pull it in the direction indicated by the arrow.
ce
nt
e
LED cap
Connector
Screwdriver
Claw
.c
nc
Connector
Claw
430
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
ALARM LIST
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
431
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
B.1
LIST OF ALARM
CODES
(1) Program errors /Alarms on program and operation (P/S alarm)
Number
Message
Contents
A parameter which requires the power off was input, turn off power.
001
TH PARITY ALARM
002
TV PARITY ALARM
003
004
A numeral or the sign was input without an address at the beginning of a block. Modify the program .
005
The address was not followed by the appropriate data but was followed by another address or EOB code. Modify the program.
006
Sign input error (Sign was input after an address with which
it cannot be used. Or two or more signs were input.)
Modify the program.
007
Decimal point . input error (A decimal point was input after an address with which it can not be used. Or two decimal points were input.)
Modify the program.
009
010
IMPROPER GCODE
011
NO FEEDRATE COMMANDED
In variable lead threading, the lead incremental and decremental outputted by address K exceed the maximum command value or a command such that the lead becomes a negative value is given.
Modify the program.
ce
nt
e
020
nc
.c
014
015
r.c
om
000
An attempt has been made to move the tool along more than the
maximum number of simultaneously controlled axes. Alternatively,
no axis movement command or an axis movement command for two
or more axes has been specified in the block containing the command for skip using the torque limit signal (G31 P99/98). The command must be accompanied with an axis movement command for a
single axis, in the same block.
In circular interpolation (G02 or G03), difference of the distance between the start point and the center of an arc and that between the
end point and the center of the arc exceeded the value specified in
parameter No. 3410.
432
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Number
Message
Contents
An axis not included in the selected plane (by using G17, G18, G19)
was commanded in circular interpolation. Modify the program.
022
NO CIRCLE RADIUS
The command for circular interpolation lacks arc radius R or coordinate I, J, or K of the distance between the start point to the center of
the arc.
023
025
CANNOT COMMAND F0 IN
G02/G03 (M series)
F0 (fast feed) was instructed by F1 digit column feed in circular interpolation. Modify the program.
027
NO AXES COMMANDED IN
G43/G44 (M series)
No axis is specified in G43 and G44 blocks for the tool length offset
type C.
Offset is not canceled but another axis is offset for the tool length
offset type C. Modify the program.
028
In the plane selection command, two or more axes in the same direction are commanded.
Modify the program.
030
r.c
ce
nt
e
029
om
021
The offset number specified by D/H code for tool length offset or cutter compensation is too large. Modify the program.
The offset number in T function specified for tool offset is tool large.
Modify the program.
In setting an offset amount by G10, the offset number following address P was excessive or it was not specified.
Modify the program.
032
NO SOLUTION AT CRC
(T series)
034
NO SOLUTION AT CRC
(M series)
.c
033
nc
031
035
036
037
CAN NOT CHANGE PLANE IN CRC G40 is commanded on the plane other than offset plane in cutter
(M seires)
compensation B. The plane selected by using G17, G18 or G19 is
changed in cutter compensation C mode. Modify the program.
CAN NOT CHANGE PLANE IN NRC The offset plane is switched in tool nose radius compensation.
(T seires)
Modify the program.
433
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
Number
Message
B62445E/03
Contents
Overcutting will occur in cutter compensation C because the arc start
point or end point coincides with the arc center.
Modify the program.
INTERFERENCE IN CIRCULAR
BLOCK (T series)
039
040
INTERFERENCE IN G90/G94
BLOCK (T series)
INTERFERENCE IN CRC
(M seires)
INTERFERENCE IN NRC
(T seires)
042
043
044
G27G30 NOT ALLOWED IN FIXED One of G27 to G30 is commanded in canned cycle mode.
CYC (M sries)
Modify the program.
046
Other than P2, P3 and P4 are commanded for 2nd, 3rd and 4th reference position return command.
047
Two or more parallel axes (in parallel with a basic axis) have been
specified upon startup of threedimensional tool compensation or
threedimensional coordinate conversion.
048
050
CHF/CNR NOT ALLOWED IN THRD Optional chamfering or corner R is commanded in the thread cutting
BLK (M series)
block.
Modify the program.
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
041
r.c
038
om
INTERFERENCE IN CIRCULAR
BLOCK (M seires)
Startup of threedimensional tool compensation or threedimensional coordinate conversion has been attempted, but the three basic
axes used when Xp, Yp, or Zp is omitted are not set in parameter No.
1022.
CHF/CNR NOT ALLOWED IN THRD Chamfering or corner R is commanded in the thread cutting block.
BLK(T series)
Modify the program.
051
052
434
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Number
Message
Contents
054
For systems without the arbitary angle chamfering or corner R cutting, a comma was specified. For systems with this feature, a comma
was followed by something other than R or C Correct the program.
NO TAPER ALLOWED AFTER CHF/ A block in which chamfering in the specified angle or the corner R
CNR
was specified includes a taper command. Modify the program.
In the arbitrary angle chamfering or corner R block, the move distance is less than chamfer or corner R amount.
056
Neither the end point nor angle is specified in the command for the
block next to that for which only the angle is specified (A). In the
chamfering comman, I(K) is commanded for the X(Z) axis.
057
058
r.c
ce
nt
e
055
om
060
SEQUENCE NUMBER NOT FOUND Commanded sequence number was not found in the sequence number search. Check the sequence number.
061
062
nc
059
.c
063
SEQUENCE NUMBER NOT FOUND The sequence number specified by address P in G70, G71, G72, or
(T series)
G73 command cannot be searched. Modify the program.
064
SHAPE PROGRAM NOT MONOTO- A target shape which cannot be made by monotonic machining was
NOUSLY (T series)
specified in a repetitive canned cycle (G71 or G72).
435
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
Number
065
Message
B62445E/03
Contents
An unallowable G code was commanded beween two blocks specified by address P in G71, G72, or G73. Modify the program.
067
069
070
NO PROGRAM SPACE IN
MEMORY
071
072
073
074
075
PROTECT
076
077
078
r.c
ce
nt
e
The number of programs to be stored exceeded 63 (basic), 125 (option), 200 (option), 400 (option) or 1000 (option). Delete unnecessary
programs and execute program registeration again.
nc
.c
079
om
066
In the automatic tool compensation function (G36, G37), the measurement position reach signal (XAE or ZAE) is not turned on within
an area specified in parameter 6254 (value ).
This is due to a setting or operator error.
080
436
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Message
Contents
081
In automatic tool compensation (G36, G37), an invalid axis was specified or the command is incremental. Modify the program.
085
COMMUNICATION ERROR
When entering data in the memory by using Reader / Puncher interface, an overrun, parity or framing error was generated. The number
of bits of input data or setting of baud rate or specification No. of I/O
unit is incorrect.
086
DR SIGNAL OFF
087
BUFFER OVERFLOW
088
089
090
091
Manual reference position return cannot be performed when automatic operation is halted.
092
r.c
ce
nt
e
When entering data in the memory by using Reader / Puncher interface, the ready signal (DR) of reader / puncher was turned off.
Power supply of I/O unit is off or cable is not connected or a P.C.B. is
defective.
When entering data in the memory by using Reader / Puncher interface, though the read terminate command is specified, input is not
interrupted after 10 characters read. I/O unit or P.C.B. is defective.
File data transfer via OSIETHERNET has been stopped due to a
transfer error.
File data transfer via OSIETHERNET has been stopped due to a
transfer error.
nc
094
.c
083
082
om
Number
095
096
P TYPE NOT ALLOWED (WRK OFS P type cannot be specified when the program is restarted. (After the
CHG)
automatic operation was interrupted, the workpiece offset amount
changed.)
Perform the correct operation according to the operators manual.
437
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
Number
Message
B62445E/03
Contents
P type cannot be directed when the program is restarted. (After power ON, after emergency stop or P / S 94 to 97 reset, no automatic
operation is performed.) Perform automatic operation.
098
A command of the program restart was specified without the reference position return operation after power ON or emergency stop,
and G28 was found during search.
Perform the reference position return.
099
100
On the PARAMETER(SETTING) screen, PWE(parameter writing enabled) is set to 1. Set it to 0, then reset the system.
101
The power turned off while rewriting the memory by program edit operation. If this alarm has occurred, press <RESET> while pressing
<PROG>, and only the program being edited will be deleted.
Register the deleted program.
109
P/S ALARM
110
DATA OVERFLOW
The absolute value of fixed decimal point display data exceeds the
allowable range. Modify the program.
111
112
DIVIDED BY ZERO
113
IMPROPER COMMAND
114
115
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
097
.c
nc
116
118
438
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Number
Message
Contents
ILLEGAL ARGUMENT
122
123
CAN NOT USE MACRO COMMAND Macro control command is used during DNC operation.
IN DNC
Modify the program.
124
125
126
In DOn, 1x n
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
Small section data is erroneous in external alarm message or external operator message. Check the PMC ladder diagram.
ce
nt
e
r.c
nc
135
om
119
Without any spindle orientation , an attept was made for spindle indexing. Perform spindle orientation.
.c
137
136
The total distribution amount of the CNC and PMC is too large during
superimposed control of the extended functions for PMC axis control.
141
142
143
144
138
139
439
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
Number
Message
B62445E/03
Contents
146
IMPROPER G CODE
G codes which cannot be specified in the polar coordinate interpolation mode was specified. See section II4.4 and modify the program.
148
149
150
151
152
The number of tools within one group exceeds the maximum value
registerable. Modify the number of tools.
153
154
155
In the machining program, M06 and T code in the same block do not
correspond to the group in use. Correct the program.
r.c
ce
nt
e
om
145
In tool life data registration, a T code was not specified where one
should be. Correct the program.
Group No. which is specified with T 88 of the machining program do not included in the tool group in use. Correct the program.
157
158
The tool life to be set is too excessive. Modify the setting value.
159
During executing a life data setting program, power was turned off.
Set again.
.c
160
161
nc
156
169
175
163
440
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Number
Message
Contents
Any of the following G codes which cannot be specified in the cylindrical interpolation mode was specified.
1) G codes for positioning: G28,, G73, G74, G76, G81 G89,
including the codes specifying the rapid traverse cycle
2) G codes for setting a coordinate system: G52,G92,
3) G code for selecting coordinate system: G53 G54G59
Modify the program.
Any of the following G codes which cannot be specified in the cylindrical interpolation mode was specified.
1) G codes for positioning: G28, G76, G81 G89, including the
codes specifying the rapid traverse cycle
2) G codes for setting a coordinate system: G50, G52
3) G code for selecting coordinate system: G53 G54G59
Modify the program.
177
178
179
180
COMMUNICATION ERROR
(REMOTE BUF)
181
182
G83 (C axis servo lag quantity offset) was instructed though synchronization by G81 has not been instructed. Correct the program. (hobbing machine)
183
184
185
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
186
176
om
190
194
441
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
Number
Message
B62445E/03
Contents
197
CAXIS COMMANDED IN SPINDLE The program specified a movement along the Csaxis when the sigMODE
nal CON(DGN=G027#7) was off. Correct the program, or consult the
PMC ladder diagram to find the reason the signal is not turned on.
199
200
201
202
In the rigid tap, spindle distribution value is too large. (System error)
203
204
205
Rigid mode DI signal is not ON when G84 or G74 for M series (G84
or G88 for T series) is executed though the rigid M code (M29) is
specified.Consult the PMC ladder diagram to find the reason the DI
signal (DGNG061.1) is not turned on.
206
210
211
G31 (HIGH) NOT ALLOWED IN G99 G31 is commanded in the per revolution command when the high
speed skip option is provided. Modify the program.
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
195
.c
nc
212
442
Number
213
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Message
Contents
Movement is commanded for the axis to be synchronously controlled.
Any of the following alarms occurred in the operation with the simple
synchronization control.
1) The program issued the move command to the slave axis.
2) The program issued the manual continuous feed/manual handle
feed/incremental feed command to the slave axis.
3) The program issued the automatic reference position return
command without specifying the manual reference position return
after the power was turned on.
4) The difference between the position error amount of the master
and slave axes exceeded the value specified in parameter
NO.8313.
A move command has been specified for an axis subject to synchronous control.
214
217
218
219
220
221
Polygon machining synchronous operation and axis control or balance cutting are executed at a time. Modify the program.
222
Reference position return has not been performed before the automatic operation starts. Perform reference position return only when
bit 0 of parameter 1005 is 0.
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
SYNCHRONOUS/MIXED CONTROL This alarm is generated in the following circumstances. (Searched for
ERROR
during synchronous and mixed control command.
T series (At twopath)
1 When there is a mistake in axis number parameter setting.
2
ILLEGAL COMMAND IN SYNCHRO A travel command has been sent to the axis being synchronized in
MODE T series (At twopath)
synchronous mode. Modify the program or the parameter.
226
.c
224
225
om
CAN NOT KEEP SYNCHROSTATE This alarm is generated in the following circumstances.
229
(T series)
The infeed quantity R has not been instructed for the G161 block. Or
the R command value is negative. Correct the program.
443
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
Number
231
Message
B62445E/03
Contents
Any of the following errors occurred in the specified format at the programmableparameter input.
1 Address N or R was not entered.
2 A number not specified for a parameter was entered.
3 The axis number was too large.
4 An axis number was not specified in the axistype parameter.
om
Three or more axes (in the normal direction control mode two or more
axes) were specified as helical axes in the helical interpolation mode.
233
DEVICE BUSY
When an attempt was made to use a unit such as that connected via
the RS232C interface, other users were using it.
239
BP/S ALARM
While punching was being performed with the function for controlling
external I/O units ,background editing was performed.
240
BP/S ALARM
241
242
ILLEGAL COMMAND IN
G02.2/G03.2
(M series)
243
244
P/S ALARM
(T series)
245
One of the G codes, G50, G10, and G04, which cannot be specified
in the same block as a T code, was specified with a T code.
250
A value for the Zaxis has been specified in a block for the tool exchange command (M06T_) on a system with DRILLMATE ARC
installed.
ATC ERROR
(M series)
ce
nt
e
The end point is not on the involute curve which includes the start
point and thus falls outside the range specified with parameter No.
5610.
nc
.c
251
r.c
232
In the skip function activated by the torque limit signal, the number of
accumulated erroneous pulses exceed 32767 before the signal was
input. Therefore, the pulses cannot be corrected with one distribution.
Change the conditions, such as feed rates along axes and torque
limit, and try again.
444
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Number
Message
Contents
253
Alarm details
Binary input operation using highspeed remote buffer (G05) or high
speed cycle machining (G05) has been specified in advance control
mode (G08P1). Execute G08P0; to cancel advance control mode,
before executing these G05 commands.
5000
The specified code was incorrect in the highprecision contour control (HPCC) mode.
5003
5004
5006
5007
5009
5010
END OF RECORD
5011
5012
Function category:
Highprecision contour control
Alarm details:
G05 P10000 has been specified in a mode from which the system
cannot enter HPCC mode.
5013
HPCC: CRC OFS REMAIN AT CAN- G05P0 has been specified in G41/G42 mode or with offset remaining.
CEL (M series)
5014
5015
(M series)
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
252
ILLEGAL COMBINATION OF M
CODE
5018
Function category:
Polygon turning
Alarm details:
In G51.2 mode, the speed of the spindle or polygon synchronous
axis either exceeds the clamp value or is too small. The specified
rotation speed ratio thus cannot be maintained.
.c
5016
5030
The end command (G110) was specified before the registratioin start
command (G101, G102, or G103) was specified for the Baxis.
5031
5032
NEW PRG REGISTERED IN BAXS While the machine was moving about the Baxis, at attempt was
MOVE (T series)
made to register another move command.
5033
5020
Commands for movement about the Baxis were not registered because of insufficient program memory.
445
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
Number
B62445E/03
Message
Contents
Multiple movements were specified with the G110 code for the B
axis.
5035
NO FEEDRATE COMMANDED B
AXS (T series)
A feedrate was not specified for cutting feed about the Baxis.
5036
Point R was not specified for the canned cycle for the Baxis.
5037
ADDRESS Q NOT DEFINED IN G83 Depth of cut Q was not specified for the G83 code (peck drilling
(T series)
cycle). Alternatively, 0 was specified in Q for the Baxis.
5038
More than six M codes for starting movement about the Baxis were
specified.
5039
An attempt was made to execute a program for the Baxis which had
not been registered.
5040
The machine could not move about the Baxis because parameter
No.8250 was incorrectly specified, or because the PMC axis system
could not be used.
5041
5043
5044
5046
5050
ILLCOMMAND IN CHOPPING
MODE
(M series)
A command for switching the major axis has been specified for circular threading. Alternatively, a command for setting the length of the
major axis to 0 has been specified for circular threading.
5052
5053
5054
5055
5057
5058
A command for switching the major axis has been specified for circular threading. Alternatively, a command for setting the length of the
major axis to 0 has been specified for circular threading.
5059
A radius exceeding nine digits has been specified for circular interpolation with the center of the arc specified with I, J, and K.
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
5034
5051
.c
nc
446
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Number
Message
Contents
Function category:
Workpiece thickness measurement
Alarm details
The position counter was not preset before the start of workpiece
thickness measurement. This alarm is issued in the following cases:
(1) An attempt has been made to start measurement without first
establishing the origin.
(2) An attempt has been made to start measurement without first
presetting the position counter after manual return to the origin.
5064
5065
DIFFERENT AXIS UNIT (PMC AXIS) Axes having different increment systems have been specified in the
(M series)
same DI/DO group for PMC axis control. Modify the setting of parameter No. 8010.
5066
Sequence number 7xxx has been read during search for the next
sequence number at program restart for the return/restart function.
5068
No movement axis or more than one movement axis has been specified.
5073
NO DECIMAL POINT
5074
The same address has been specified two or more times in a single
block. Alternatively, two or more G codes in the same group have
been specified in a single block.
5082
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
5063
No decimal point has been specified for an address requiring a decimal point.
.c
nc
Note
HPCC : High precision contour control
447
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Message
Contents
BP/S alarm
BP/S alarm occurs in the same number as the P/S alarm that occurs in
ordinary program edit. (070, 071, 072, 073, 074 085,086,087 etc.)
140
BP/S alarm
om
???
Note
Alarm in background edit is displayed in the key input line of the background edit screen instead
of the ordinary alarm screen and is resettable by any of the MDI key operation.
Number
r.c
Contents
Manual reference position return is required for the nthaxis (n=1 8).
301
302
303
304
305
306
307
.c
nc
308
ce
nt
e
300
APC ALARM:
n AXIS ZRN IMPOSSIBL
309
nthaxis (n=1 8) axis APC battery voltage reaches a level where the
battery must be renewed.
APC alarm. Replace the battery.
nthaxis (n=1 8) APC battery voltage has reached a level where the
battery must be renewed (including when power is OFF).
APC alarm .Replace battery.
Return to the origin has been attempted without first rotating the motor
one or more times. Before returning to the origin, rotate the motor one
or more times then turn off the power.
Message
Contents
350
The n axis (axis 18) pulse coder has a fault. Refer to diagnosis display
No. 202 and No. 204 for details.
351
SPC ALARM: n AXIS COMMUNICA- n axis (axis 18) serial pulse coder communication error (data transmisTION
sion fault)
Refer to diagnosis display No. 203 for details.
448
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
#7
#6
CSA
202
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
#4
PHA
#3
PCA
#2
BZA
#1
CKA
#0
SPH
om
#6 (CSA)
#5 (BLA)
#4 (PHA)
#3 (PCA)
#2 (BZA)
#1 (CKA)
#0 (SPH)
#5
BLA
#7
DTE
#6
CRC
#5
STB
#4
#3
#2
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
449
#1
#0
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Contents
400
The nth axis (axis 18) overload signal is on. Refer to diagnosis display No. 201 for details.
401
The nth axis (axis 18) servo amplifier READY signal (DRDY) went off.
Refer to procedure of trouble shooting.
404
Even though the nth axis (axis 18) READY signal (MCON) went off,
the servo amplifier READY signal (DRDY) is still on. Or, when the power
was turned on, DRDY went on even though MCON was off.
Check that the servo interface module and servo amp are connected.
405
407
409
410
The position deviation value when the nth axis (axis 18) stops is larger than the set value.
Refer to procedure of trouble shooting.
411
The position deviation value when the nth axis (axis 18) moves is
larger than the set value.
Refer to procedure of trouble shooting.
413
The contents of the error register for the nth axis (axis 18) exceeded
"231 power. This error usually occurs as the result of an improperly set
parameters.
414
Nth axis (axis 18) digital servo system fault. Refer to diagnosis display No. 200 and No.204 for details.
415
A speed higher than 511875 units/s was attempted to be set in the nth
axis (axis 18). This error occurs as the result of improperly set CMR.
416
Position detection system fault in the nth axis (axis 18) pulse coder
(disconnection alarm). Refer to diagnosis display No. 201 for details.
417
This alarm occurs when the nth axis (axis 18) is in one of the conditions listed below. (Digital servo system alarm)
1) The value set in Parameter No. 2020 (motor form) is out of the
specified limit.
2) A proper value (111 or 111) is not set in parameter No.2022
(motor revolution direction).
3) Illegal data (a value below 0, etc.) was set in parameter No. 2023
(number of speed feedback pulses per motor revolution).
4) Illegal data (a value below 0, etc.) was set in parameter No. 2024
(number of position feedback pulses per motor revolution).
5) Parameters No. 2084 and No. 2085 (flexible field gear rate) have
not been set.
6) A value outside the limit of {1 to the number of control axes} or
a noncontinuous value (Parameter 1023 (servo axis number) con
tains a value out of the range from 1 to the number of axes, or an
isolated value (for example, 4 not prceded by 3).was set in parame
ter No. 1023 (servo axisnumber).
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
Number
450
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Number
Message
Contents
420
421
The difference between the errors in the semiclosed loop and closed
loop has become excessive during dual position feedback. Check the
values of the dual position conversion coefficients in parameters No.
2078 and 2079.
D Details of servo
alarm No.414
#7
OVL
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
#7
204
#3
HVA
#2
DCA
#1
FBA
#0
OFA
#5
MCC
#4
LDA
#3
PMS
#2
#1
#0
.c
D Details of servo
alarms No. 400 and
No.416
:
:
:
:
#4
HCA
nc
#6 (OFS)
#5 (MCC)
#4 (LDA)
#3 (PMS)
#5
OVC
r.c
#7 (OVL)
#6 (LV)
#5 (OVC)
#4 (HCA)
#3 (HVA)
#2 (DCA)
#1 (FBA)
#0 (OFA)
#6
LV
ce
nt
e
200
om
The details of servo alarm No. 414 are displayed in the diagnosis display
(No. 200 and No.204) as shown below.
The details of servo alarms No. 400 and No. 416 are displayed in the
diagnosis display (No. 201) as shown below.
201
#7
ALD
#6
#5
#4
EXP
#3
#2
#1
#0
When OVL equal 1 in diagnostic data No.200 (servo alarm No. 400 is
being generated):
#7 (ALD) 0 : Motor overheating
1 : Amplifier overheating
When FBAL equal 1 in diagnostic data No.200 (servo alarm No. 416 is
being generated):
ALD
EXP
451
Alarm details
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Message
Contents
OVER TRAVEL : +n
Exceeded the nth axis (axis 18) + side stored stroke limit I.
(Parameter No.1320 or 1326 Notes)
501
OVER TRAVEL : n
Exceeded the nth axis (axis 18) side stored stroke limit I.
(Parameter No.1321 or 1327 Notes)
502
OVER TRAVEL : +n
Exceeded the nth axis (axis 18) + side stored stroke limit II.
(Parameter No.1322 )
503
OVER TRAVEL : n
Exceeded the nth axis (axis 18) side stored stroke limit II.
(Parameter No.1323)
504
OVER TRAVEL : +n
Exceeded the nth axis (axis 18) + side stored stroke limit III.
(Parameter No.1324 )
505
OVER TRAVEL : n
Exceeded the nth axis (axis 18) side stored stroke limit III.
(Parameter No.1325 )
506
OVER TRAVEL : +n
507
OVER TRAVEL : n
508
INTERFERENCE: +n
(T series (twopath control))
A tool moving in the positive direction along the n axis has fouled another tool post.
509
INTERFERENCE: n
(T series (twopath control))
510
OVER TRAVEL: +n
511
OVER TRAVEL: n
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
500
A tool moving in the negative direction along the n axis has fouled another tool post.
Alarm for stroke check prior to movement. The end point specified in a
block falls within the forbidden area defined with the stroke limit in the
positive direction along the N axis. Correct the program.
nc
Alarm for stroke check prior to movement. The end point specified in a
block falls within the forbidden area defined with the stroke limit in the
negative direction along the N axis. Correct the program.
.c
Note
Parameters 1326 and 1327 are effective when EXLM(stroke limit switch signal) is on.
700
Message
Number
Contents
Control unit overheat
Check that the fan motor operates normally, and clean the air filter.
The fan motor on the top of the cabinet for the contorl unit is overheated.
Check the operation of the fan motor and replace the motor if necessary.
704
OVERHEAT: SPINDLE
701
452
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Message
Contents
The positional deviation of the stopped spindle has exceeded the set
value during rigid tapping.
741
The positional deviation of the moving spindle has exceeded the set value during rigid tapping.
742
An LSI overflow has occurred for the spindle during rigid tapping.
om
740
Message
Contents
750
ce
nt
e
r.c
749
751
.c
nc
This alarm is generated when the spindle control unit is not ready for
starting correctly when the power is turned on in the system with the
serial spindle.
The four reasons can be considered as follows:
1) An improperly connected optic cable, or the spindle control units
power is OFF.
2) When the NC power was turned on under alarm conditions other
than SU01 or AL24 which are shown on the LED display of the
spindle control unit.
In this case, turn the spindle amplifier power off once and perform
startup again.
3) Other reasons (improper combination of hardware)
This alarm does not occur after the system including the spindle control unit is activated.
4) The second spindle (when SP2, bit 4 of parameter No. 3701, is 1)
is in one of the above conditions 1) to 3).
See diagnostic display No. 409 for details.
752
754
761
762
453
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Number
Message
Contents
764
771
772
SPINDLE3 MODE CHANGE EROR Same as alarm No. 752 (for the third spindle)
774
om
The details of spindle alarm No. 750 are displayed in the diagnosis display
(No. 409) as shown below.
#7
#6
#5
#4
#3
SPE
#2
S2E
#1
S1E
#0
SHE
r.c
409
ce
nt
e
#3 (SPE) 0 : In the spindle serial control, the serial spindle parameters fulfill the
spindle unit startup conditions.
1 : In the spindle serial control, the serial spindle parameters do not fulfill
the spindle unit startup conditions.
#2 (S2E) 0 : The second spindle is normal during the spindle serial control startup.
1 : The second spindle was detected to have a fault during the spindle
serial control startup.
#1 (S1E) 0 : The first spindle is normal during the spindle serial control startup.
1 : The first spindle was detected to have a fault during the spindle axis
serial control startup.
.c
nc
454
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Contents
ROM PARITY
910
RAM parity error in the tape memory RAM module. Clear the memory
or replace the module.
After this operation, reset all data including the parameters.
911
RAM parity error in the tape memory RAM module. Clear the memory
or replace the module.
After this operation, reset all data including the parameters.
912
RAM parity error in the tape memory RAM module. Clear the memory
or replace the module.
After this operation, reset all data including the parameters.
913
RAM parity error in the tape memory RAM module. Clear the memory
or replace the module.
After this operation, reset all data including the parameters.
914
915
A RAM parity error occurred in RAM for part program storage or additional SRAM. Clear the memory, or replace the main CPU board or additional SRAM. Then, set all data, including parameters, again.
916
DRAM PARITY
920
Servo alarm (1st to 4th axis). A watchdog alarm or a RAM parity error
in the servo module occurred.
Replace the servo control module on the main CPU board.
922
Servo alarm (5th to 8th axis). A watchdog alarm or a RAM parity error
in the servo module occurred.
Replace the servo control module on the option 2 board.
924
926
Servo alarm (1st to 6th axis). A watch dog alarm was issued, or a RAM
parity error occurred in the servo module. Replace the servo control
module on the main CPU board.
930
CPU INTERRUPUT
950
Fault occurred in the PMC.The PMC control module on the main CPU
board or option 3 board may be faulty.
951
r.c
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
970
om
900
971
An alarm condition occurred in the interface with an I/O unit. For PMC
RA1, PMCRA2, and PMCRB, check that the PMC control module on
the main CPU board is conneted to the I/O unit securely. For PMCRC,
check that the PMC control module on the option 3 board is connected
to the I/O unit is supplied with power and that the interface module is intact.
972
973
974
FBUS ERROR
975
455
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
B.2
LIST OF ALARMS
(PMC)
(1) Alarm messages (PMC)
Message
The PMC model setting of the sequence program is not corresponding to an actual
model.
(solution)
Please change the PMC model setting by the offline programmer.
r.c
ce
nt
e
(solution)
nc
om
ALARM NOTHING
Both ROM for sequence program and the debugging RAM do not exist (PMCRC
only)
There is no step number option of LADDER.
.c
The parity error occurred on ROM for sequence program or the debugging RAM.
(solution)
ROM: The deterioration of ROM may be deteriorated
Please exchange ROM for the sequence program
RAM: Please edit the sequence program once on PMC
Still the error occurs, exchange the debugging RAM.
Transferring the sequence program from offline programmer was interrupted by the
power off etc.
(solution)
Please clear the sequence program and transfer the sequence program
again.
Editing the LADDER was interrupted by the power off or by the switch to the CNC
screen by the function key etc.
(solution)
Please edit LADDER once on PMC.
Or, please input LADDER again.
456
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Message
Editing the message data was interrupted by the power off or the switch to the CNC
screen by the function key etc.
(solution)
Please edit message data once on PMC.
Or, please input message data again.
Any DI/DO unit of I/O Unit or the connection unit etc. is not connected. When builtin
I/O card is connected, this message is not displayed.
(solution)
When builtin I/O card is used:
Please confirm whether the builtin I/O card is certainly connected with.
When I/O Link is used:
Please confirm whether the DI/DO units turning on. Or please confirm
the connection of the cable.
The number of the output data in the xx group exceeded the max. The data, which
exceed 32 bytes, become ineffective.
(solution)
Please refer to the following for the number of the data for each group.
FANUC I/O UnitMODEL A connecting and maintenance manual
(B61813E)
FANUC I/O UnitMODEL B connecting manual(B62163E)
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
ER20 SYMBOL/COMMENT
DATA ERROR
The number of the input data in the xx group exceeded the max. The data, which
exceed 32 bytes, become ineffective.
(solution)
Please refer to the following for the number of the data for each group.
FANUC I/O UnitMODEL A connecting and maintenance manual
(B61813E)
FANUC I/O UnitMODEL B connecting manual(B62163E)
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
Message
B62445E/03
Some user tasks are stopped by break point of the debugging function.
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
.c
458
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Message
The code segment type is illegal. The code segment of RENAMESEG in the binding
control file is wrong.
(solution)
Please correct the entry of the code segment in the link control
statement to correspond to the entry in the build file.
WN28 DATA SEG TYPE ERROR The data segment type is illegal. The data segment of RENAMESEG in the binding
control file is wrong.
(solution)
Please correct the entry of the code segment in the link control
statement to correspond to the entry in the build file.
The segment type of common memory is illegal. The segment of RENAMESEG in
the building control file of the common memory is wrong.
(solution)
Please correct the entry of common memory in the link control
statement to correspond to the entry in the build file.
The memories for the data and stack etc. cannot be allocated.
(solution)
Please confirm whether the value of code segment in build file and
USER GDT ADDRESS in link control statement is correct or not.
Or please reduce the value of MAX LADDER AREA SIZE of the system
parameter and the size of the stack in link control statement at the least
STATUS LED lL
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
STATUS LED VL
STATUS LED VL
459
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
Message
B62445E/03
STATUS LED HL
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
PC160 FBUS ERROR xxxx yyy- The BUS error (access to disabled address) occurred.
yyy
xxxx
: Segment selector where system error occurred.
STATUS LED LV
yyyyyy
: Offset address where system error occurred
PC199 ROM PARITY eeeeeeee
STATUS LED Ll
nc
STATUS LED (green) are LED1, LED2 on PMCRC. CAPII is LED3 and LED4.
V : OffH : OnlL : Blinking
.c
Notes
1 The system error on PMCRA1, RA2, RA3, RB,RB2 and RB3 is displayed as a system error
on the CNC side. (Refer to the FANUC Series 16/18MA Operators Manual(B61874E) or
FANUC Series 16/18TA Operators Manual(B61804E).)
2 Error information is needed to investigate on FANUC, please take notes of it.
Message
Functional instruction END1,END2,END3 and END do not exist. Or, there are error
net in END1,END2,END3,END.
Or, order of END1,END2,END3, and END is not correct.
460
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Message
Because the power had been turn off while editing LADDER, some net under editing
was cleared.
ILLEGAL OPERATION
SYMBOL UNDEFINED
INPUT INVALID
LADDER BROKEN
LADDER is broken.
LADDER ILLEGAL
r.c
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
IMPOSSIBLE WRITE
om
PARAMETER NOTHING
461
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
Message
B62445E/03
om
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
The data transferred to the address out of the PMC debugging RAM area.
xxxxxx : Transferred address.
(solution) Please confirm the address of the transferring data.
LADDER
: Please confirm the model setting.
C language : Please confirm setting the address in the link control statement
and build file.
462
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
B.3
SPINDLE ALARMS
(SERIAL SPINDLE)
Message
Note
Erxx is not displayed on CRT.
Contents
Countermeasure
Er02
Er03
Er04
Er05
Although option parameter for orientation is not set, the Confirm the parameter setting of orientation.
orientation command (ORCM) is input.
Er06
Er07
Er08
Er09
Er10
Er13
Er14
Er15
Cs contouring control command is entered when differ- Check parameter setting and control input signal.
ential speed control function is enabled by parameter
setting (No.6500#5=1).
Er12
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
Er11
om
Er01
463
Confirm the parameter setting for output switching and power line status signal.
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
Message
B62445E/03
Contents
Countermeasure
Er17
Er18
Er19
Although the command for orienting the magnetic sensor system was entered, another mode was issued.
Er20
Er21
The slave mode command (SLV=1) was entered under Enter the slave mode command in the normal
position control (servo mode, orientation,etc.).
operation mode.
Er22
The position control command (servo mode, orientation,etc.) was entered in the slave operation mode
(SLV=1).
Er23
Er24
To perform continuous indexing in the mode for orienting the position coder system, incremental operation(INCMD=1) was first performed, then the absolute
position command (INCMD=0) was entered.
Meaning
nc
Alarm
No.
r.c
ce
nt
e
om
Er16
Description
Remedy
AL01
Motor
overheat
AL02
.c
A
Program ROM abnormality
display (not installed)
AL03
AL04
Detects blown fuse (F1 to F3), open phase or momentary failure of power (models 30S and 40S).
AL05
Detects that control power supply fuse AF2 or AF3 Check for control power
is blown (models 30S and 40S).
supply short circuit .
Replace fuse.
AL07
Excessive speed
464
Reset alarm.
Meaning
Description
Remedy
AL09
AL10
Alarm
No.
Meaning
Description
AL11
Detects abnormally high direct current power supply voltage in power circuit section.
AL12
AL13
AL15
AL16
RAM abnormality
Detects abnormality in RAM for external data. This Remove cause, then reset
check is made only when power is turned on.
alarm.
AL18
AL19
AL20
AL24
Detects serial transfer data error (such as NC pow- Remove cause, then reset
er supply turned off, etc.)
alarm.
AL25
AL26
Disconnection of speed
detection signal for Cs contouring control
AL27
AL28
Disconnection of position
detection signal for Cs contouring control
AL29
Shorttime overload
Detects that overload has been continuously applied for some period of time (such as restraining
motor shaft in positioning).
AL30
om
AL08
Alarm
No.
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Remedy
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
465
Check sequence.
B. ALARM LIST
Alarm
No.
APPENDIX
Meaning
B62445E/03
Description
Remedy
AL32
AL33
Detects insufficient charging of direct current power supply voltage in power circuit section when
magnetic contactor in amplifier is turned on (such
as open phase and defectifve charging resistor).
AL34
AL35
Alarm
No.
Meaning
Description
Remedy
AL36
AL37
AL39
AL40
Alarm for indicating 1rotation Detects that 1rotation signal has not occurred in
signal for Cs contouring con- Cs contouring control.
trol not detected
AL41
AL43
Alarm for indicating disconnection of position coder signal for differential speed
mode
AL46
Detects failure in detecting position coder 1rotation signasl in thread cutting operation.
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
AL42
om
AL31
466
Alarm
No.
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Meaning
Description
Remedy
AL49
Calculate differential
speed by multiplying
speed of other spindle by
gear ratio. Check if calculated value is not greater
than maximum speed of
motor.
AL50
AL51
AL52
AL53
AL54
AL55
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
AL47
.c
467
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
B.4
SPINDLE ALARMS
(ANALOG
INTERFACE)
(S SERIES AC
SPINDLE)
Alarm
No.
Meaning
Description
om
Exchange ROM
AL01
Motor
overheat
AL02
AL03
Defective regenerative
current
AL04
Not used
AL05
Not used
AL06
Reset alarm.
AL07
Reset alarm.
AL08
AL09
Not used
AL10
AL11
AL12
Check transistor and motor coils for their grounding, remove cause, then
reset alarm.
AL13
Exchange PCB.
AL14
ROM abnormality
AL15
Not used
AL16
AL17
NVRAM abnormality
Exchange NVRAM or
PCB.
AL18
AL23
Exchange PCB.
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
A
Program ROM abnormality
display (not installed)
Detects abnormally high direct current power supply voltage in power circuit section.
.c
468
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Description
Remedy
Exchange ROM
AL01
Motor
overheat
AL02
AL03
*
AL04
AL05
Not used
AL06
AL07
AL08
AL09
Overheat of radiator
AL10
AL11
AL12
AL13
Exchange PCB.
AL14
ROM abnormality
AL15
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
A
Program ROM abnormality
display (not installed)
Alarm
No.
Detects abnormally high direct current power supply voltage in power circuit section.
.c
AL16
AL17
NVRAM abnormality
Exchange NVRAM or
PCB.
AL18
AL23
Exchange PCB.
469
B. ALARM LIST
APPENDIX
D Method of resetting
alarm
Press
MODE
and
DATA
SET
B62445E/03
Note
om
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
470
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
471
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
C.1
MAINTENANCE
PARTS
Maintenance Parts
Consumables here refer to the parts which are not reused after
replacement. Rank : AA>A>BB>B>CC>C
Name
Fan motor
Drawing number
Compati-
Remarks
bility
Ra
nk
A90L00010378
2.4W
A90L00010385#A
1.7W
Battery
Fuse
om
A98L00310012
For AI
A60L00010075#3.2
F4 (5AS)
A60L00010245#GP75
F1 (7.5A)
A60L00010075#5.0
F3 (5A)
A60L00010046#5.0
F4 (5AS)
A86L00010171#ST2
Usable units
A02B0120C041#TA
A02B0120C042#TA
A02B0120C043#TA
A02B0120C121#TA
A86L00010171#ST2R
Usable units
A02B0120C041#TAR
A02B0120C043#TAR
A02B0120C121#TAR
A86L00010171#ST2S
Usable units
A02B0120C041#TAS
A02B0120C043#TAS
A02B0120C121#TAS
A86L00010171#SM2
Usable units
A02B0120C041#MA
A02B0120C042#MA
A02B0120C121#MA
A86L00010171#SM2R
Usable units
A02B0120C041#MAR
A02B0120C121#MAR
A86L00010171#SM2S
Usable units
A02B0120C041#MAS
A02B0120C121#MAS
ce
nt
e
TB
.c
nc
Small
keyboard
F3 (3.2A)
A60L00010046#5.0
For BI
F1(7.5A)
MB
r.c
A60L00010245#GP75
472
B
B
B
B
Name
Standard
keyboard
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Drawing number
TB
Remarks
Compatibility
Ra
nk
B
A86L00010172#HT2R
Usable units
A02B0120C051#TAR
A02B0120C122#TAR
A86L00010172#HT2S
Usable units
A02B0120C051#TAS
A02B0120C122#TAS
A86L00010172#HM2
Usable units
A02B0120C051#MA
A02B0120C052#MA
A02B0120C122#MA
A86L00010172#HM2R
Usable units
A02B0120C051#MAR
A02B0120C122#MAR
r.c
ce
nt
e
MB
Usable units
A02B0120C051#TA
A02B0120C052#TA
A02B0120C122#TA
om
A86L00010172#HT2
A86L00010172#HM2S
A86L00010173#HT2
Usable units
A02B0200C061#TBR
A02B0200C065#TBR
Usable units
A02B0200C061#TBS
A02B0200C065#TBS
A86L00010173#HF1
Usable units
A02B0200C061#TFB
A02B0200C065#TFB
A86L00010173#HF1R
Usable units
A02B0200C061#TFBR
A02B0200C065#TFBR
A86L00010173#HF1S
Usable units
A02B0120C061#TFBS
A02B0120C065#TFBS
A86L00010173#HM2
Usable units
A02B0200C061#MB
A02B0200C065#MB
A86L00010173#HM2R
Usable units
A02B0200C061#MBR
A02B0200C065#MBR
A86L00010173#HM2S
Usable units
A02B0200C061#MBS
A02B0200C065#MBS
nc
.c
With TB
CAPII
Usable units
A02B0200C061#TB
A02B0200C065#TB
A86L00010173#HT2S
TB
A86L00010173#HT2R
Keyboard for
horizontal
9.5 LCD/
MDI
Usable units
A02B0120C051#MAS
A02B0120C122#MAS
MB
473
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
Name
APPENDIX
Drawing number
Key board
TB
for horizontal
14 CRT/
MDI
B62445E/03
Remarks
Compatibility
Ra
nk
B
A86L00010174#HT2R
Usable units
A02B0200C071#TBR
A86L00010174#HT2S
Usable units
A02B0200C071#TBS
A86L00010174#HF1
Usable units
A02B0120C071#TF
A02B0120C071#TF
A02B0200C071#TFB
A02B0200C074#TFB
A86L00010174#HF1R
Usable units
A02B0200C071#TFBR
A86L00010174#HF1S
Usable units
A02B0200C071#TFBS
A86L00010174#HM2
Usable units
A02B0120C071#MA
A02B0200C071#MB
A86L00010174#HM2R
Usable units
A02B0200C071#MBR
A86L00010174#HM2S
Usable units
A02B0200C071#MBS
r.c
ce
nt
e
With TB
CAPII
Usable units
A02B0120C071#TA
A02B0120C074#TA
A02B0200C071#TB
A02B0200C074#TB
om
A86L00010174#HT2
.c
nc
MB
474
Name
Keyboard for
vertical 9.5
LCD/MDI
and 14
CRT/MDI
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Drawing number
TB
Remarks
Compatibility
Ra
nk
B
A86L00010175#VT2R
Usable units
A02B0200C062#TBR
A02B0200C066#TBR
A86L00010175#VT2S
Usable units
A02B0200C062#TBS
A02B0200C066#TBS
A86L00010175#VF1
Usable units
A02B0120C072#TF
A02B0200C062#TFB
A02B0200C066#TFB
A86L00010175#VF1R
Usable units
A02B0200C062#TFBR
A02B0200C066#TFBR
r.c
ce
nt
e
With TB
CAPII
Usable units
A02B0120C072#TA
A02B0200C062#TB
A02B0200C066#TB
om
A86L00010175#VT2
A86L00010175#VF1S
Usable units
A02B0120C072#MA
A02B0200C062#MB
A02B0200C066#MB
A86L00010175#VM2R
Usable units
A02B0200C062#MBR
A02B0200C066#MBR
Usable units
A02B0200C062#MBS
A02B0200C066#MBS
nc
A86L00010175#VM2
MB
Usable units
A02B0200C062#TFBS
A02B0200C066#TFBS
.c
A86L00010175#VM2S
475
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Drawing number
2SLOT
Remarks
A02B0200C001
Compatibility
Ra
nk
C
A02B0200C021
For power C
A02B0200C002
6SLOT
A02B0200C003
8SLOT
A02B0200C004
4SLOT
A02B0200C010
6SLOT
A02B0200C011
8SLOT
A02B0200C012
2SLOT
A02B0129C001
C
C
r.c
A02B0129C021
For power C
ce
nt
e
Series 18
control rack
(without
MMCIV)
4SLOT
Series 16
control rack
(with MMC
IV)
A02B0200C005
om
3SLOT
C
C
C
A02B0129C005
4SLOT
A02B0129C002
6SLOT
A02B0129C003
Series 18
control rack
(with MMC
( ith MMC
IV)
4SLOT
A02B0129C010
6SLOT
A02B0129C011
AI
BI
Main CPU
board
Series 16
nc
3SLOT
A16B12120870
Series 18
B
B
.c
A16B12120900
A20B10050420
A16B32000010
B
MAINA, 4 axes
A16B32000170
B
B
A16B32000110
MAINB, 6 axes
A16B22020860
4axis specification
A16B32000160
6axis specification
476
Name
Option 1
board
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Drawing number
Remarks
Compatibility
Ra
nk
B
Graphic+ DNC1
A16B22000916
Remote
buffer
A16B22000913
DNC1
A16B22000914
Graphic
A16B22000919
Series 16 with
subCPU
Option 2
board
A16B22000918
A16B22020400
om
Graphic+
remote buffer
MAINA specification,
4 axes
A16B22020890
B
B
Series 16 with
subCPU
A16B22020850
Series 16 without
subCPU
A16B22020851
Series 18 with
subCPU
A16B22020853
PMCRC
+CAPII
A16B32000055
PMCRC
A16B32000054
CAPII
Loader control board
Series 16
A16B22020891
MAINB specification
ce
nt
e
A16B22020560
MAINA specification
A16B22020880
MAINB specification
A16B22020852
MAINB specification,
6 axes
A16B32000057
.c
Series 18
MAINA specification,
4 axes
nc
Option 3
board
A16B22020401
r.c
Series 16 without
subCPU
477
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
Name
I/O card
(sink type
output)
APPENDIX
Drawing number
B62445E/03
Remarks
Without highspeed skip signal input
Compatibility
Ra
nk
B(80/56)
A16B22000957
C(104/72)
A16B22000956
D(156/120)
A16B22000955
A20B90010480
E(40/40)
A16B22000953
F(80/56)
A16B22000952
G(104/72)
A16B22000951
H(156/120)
A16B22000950
A20B90010480
A16B22000954
A(40/40)
A16B22000988
r.c
A16B22020728
B(80/56)
ce
nt
e
I/O card
(source type
output)
A16B22000958
om
A(40/40)
A16B22000987
A16B22020727
A16B22020725
A20B80010150
nc
E(40/40)
A16B22020726
D(156/120)
A16B22000986
C(104/72)
A16B22000983
A16B22020723
B
B
A16B22000981
A16B22020721
.c
A16B22000982
A16B22020722
F(80/56)
H(156/120)
A16B22020720
A20B80010150
Operators
panel connection unit
(sink type
output)
A(64/32)
A16B22000661
B(94/64)
A16B22000660
Operators
panel connection unit
(source type
output)
A(64/32)
A16B22020731
B(94/64)
A16B22020730
A16B22010110
G(104/72)
478
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Name
Drawing number
Remarks
bility
Ra
nk
Serial/DMA
addon
board
4CH
A20B22000010
2CH
A20B22000011
Graphic
addon
board
For 2 paths
A20B82000010
For 1 path
A20B82000011
PMC control
module
For PMCRE
A20B29000140
Loader control,
with SLC
A20B29000142
Loader control,
without SLC For
PMCRC3
A20B29000143
For PMC
RB3/RC3, with
SLC
A20B29010960
For PMC
RB3/RC3, without SLC
A20B29010961
Analog I/O +
highspeed skip
DI
A20B29000280
Highspeed skip
DI
A20B29000281
A20B29000290
768KB
Graphic control module
om
r.c
A20B29000291
A20B29000311
A20B29000350
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
Highspeed
DI, analog
I/O module
Compati-
A20B29000541
A20B29000580
A20B29000991
A20B29010390
DRAM/SRAM module
A20B29010413
DRAM module
6MB
A20B29010940
4MB
A20B29010941
2MB
A20B29010942
479
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
Name
Spindle control module
APPENDIX
Drawing number
B62445E/03
Remarks
For main CPU board
Compatibility
Ra
nk
Serial +
analog
A20B29010980
Serial
A20B29010981
Analog
A20B29010982
Serial +
analog
A20B29010984
Serial
A20B29010985
Analog
A20B29010986
B
B
A20B29010060
r.c
A20B29010061
FROM/
SRAM module
om
A20B29020081
FROM 2MB
A20B29020082
FROM 8MB
SRAM 2MB
A20B29020090
FROM 8MB
A20B29020091
FROM 6MB
A20B29020092
FROM 8MB
SRAM 512KB
A20B29020093
nc
ce
nt
e
A20B29020080
FROM 4MB
FROM/
SRAM module
FROM 4MB
SRAM 512KB
B
B
DRAM module
A20B29020094
512KB+2MB
A20B29020191
.c
FROM 6MB
SRAM 512KB
A20B29020192
512KB+
512KB
A20B29020193
512KB
A20B29020194
2MB
A20B29020196
1MB
A20B29020197
A20B29020198
A20B29020250
512KB+1MB
512KB
480
Name
CRT control
module
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Drawing number
Remarks
When MMC is not provided
Compatibility
Ra
nk
A20B29020272
A20B29020273
For LCD
A20B29020275
For 9CRT
A20B29020276
For LCD
A20B29020277
For 14CRT
A20B29020278
FROM 4MB
SRAM 256KB
A20B29020341
FROM 4MB
SRAM 256KB
A20B29020343
256KB
A20B29020350
256KB+
512KB
A20B29020351
256KB+2MB
A20B29020352
FROM 8MB
SRAM 256KB
A20B29020410
FROM 6MB
SRAM 256KB
A20B29020411
2SLOT
om
B
When MMC is not provided
B
B
ce
nt
e
r.c
A20B20000630
A20B20010870
B
B
B
B
For I/O card with power supply
A20B20000620
4SLOT
A20B20000640
6SLOT
A20B20000650
8SLOT
A20B20000610
4SLOT
A20B20010490
6SLOT
A20B20010652
8SLOT
A20B20010662
2SLOT
A20B20020090
.c
3SLOT
nc
Series 16
control rack
(without
MMCIV)
For 14CRT
FROM/
SRAM module
A20B29020271
For LCD
SRAM module
A20B29020270
For 9CRT
FROM/
SRAM module
For 14CRT
Series 16
control rack
(with MMC
IV)
Series 18
control rack
(without
MMCIV)
A20B20020110
3SLOT
A20B20020020
4SLOT
A20B20010200
A20B20010190
6SLOT
481
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
Name
Series 18
control rack
( ith MMC
(with MMC
IV)
APPENDIX
Drawing number
B62445E/03
Remarks
Compatibility
Ra
nk
A20B20020100
6SLOT
A20B20020120
A13B0154B001
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
4SLOT
482
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Maintenance Parts
Name
9 CRT/MDI
(Small key
key,
monochrome)
Drawing number
TB
Compati-
Remarks
bility
A02B0120C041#TA
Ra
nk
B
A02B0120C041#TAS
A02B0120C043#TA
A02B0120C043#TAR
A02B0120C043#TAS
MB
om
A02B0120C041#TAR
A02B0120C041#MA
A02B0120C041#MAR
A02B0120C041#MAS
TB
A02B0120C042#TA
MB
A02B0120C042#MA
9 CRT/MDI
(Standard key
key,
monochrome)
TB
A02B0120C051#TA
r.c
9 CRT/MDI
(Small key,
color)
ce
nt
e
A02B0120C051#TAR
B
B
B
A02B0120C051#TAS
A02B0120C051#MA
A02B0120C051#MAR
A02B0120C051#MAS
MB
TB
A02B0120C052#TA
MB
A02B0120C052#MA
9 PDP/MDI
(Standard key
key,
monochrome)
TB
A02B0120C081#TA
A02B0200C101#TBR
nc
9 CRT/MDI
(Small key,
color)
A02B0200C101#TBS
B
B
A02B0120C111
.c
A02B0200C101#MBS
monochrome
9 separate
type CRT unit
A02B0120C081#MA
A02B0200C101#MBR
MB
color
A02B0120C112
monochrome
A02B0120C113
color
A02B0120C100
8.4 separate
type LCD unit
color
A02B0200C050
7.2 separate
type LCD unit
monochrome
A02B0200C081
9 separate
type PDP unit
483
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
APPENDIX
Name
Separate type
MDI unit
(small key)
Drawing number
TB
B62445E/03
Compati-
Remarks
bility
A02B0120C121#TA
Ra
nk
B
A02B0120C121#TAS
TB
B
B
A02B0120C121#MAS
Separate type
MDI unit
(standard key)
A02B0120C121#MA
A02B0120C121#MAR
MB
A02B0120C122#TA
om
A02B0120C121#TAR
A02B0120C122#TAR
A02B0120C122#TAS
MB
A02B0120C122#MA
B
B
r.c
A02B0120C122#MAR
A02B0120C122#MAS
9.5 LCD/MDI
unit horizontal
TB
A02B0200C061#TB
A02B0200C061#TBR
B
B
B
B
B
B
A02B0200C062#TB
B
B
A02B0200C062#TBS
A02B0200C062#TFB
A02B0200C062#TFBR
A02B0200C062#TFBS
A02B0200C062#MB
A02B0200C062#MBR
.c
A02B0200C061#MB
A02B0200C062#TBR
TB With
CAPII
CAP II
A02B0200C061#MBS
TB
A02B0200C061#MBR
9.5 LCD/MDI
unit vertical
A02B0200C061#TFBR
A02B0200C061#TFBS
MB
A02B0200C061#TFB
nc
TB With
CAPII
CAP II
ce
nt
e
A02B0200C061#TBS
MB
A02B0200C062#MBS
A02B0120C071#TA
TB With
CAPII
A02B0120C071#TF
A02B0120C071#MA
TB
A02B0120C074#TA
TB With
CAPII
A02B0120C074#TF
TB
A02B0120C072#TA
TB With
CAPII
A02B0120C072#TF
MB
A02B0120C072#MA
TB
MB
14 CRT/MDI
horizontal
14 CRT/MDI
vertical
484
Name
14 CRT/MDI
horizontal
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Drawing number
TB
Compati-
Remarks
bility
A02B0200C071#TB
Ra
nk
B
A02B0200C071#TBS
A02B0200C071#TFBR
A02B0200C071#TFBS
A02B0120C071#MB
MB
A02B0200C071#TFB
TB With
CAPII
CAP II
A02B0200C071#MBR
A02B0200C071#MBS
TB
A02B0200C072#TB
A02B0200C072#TBR
A02B0200C072#TBS
TB With
CAPII
CAP II
r.c
14 CRT/MDI
vertical
om
A02B0200C071#TBR
A02B0200C072#TFB
A02B0200C072#TFBR
B
B
B
ce
nt
e
A02B0200C072#TFBS
A02B0200C072#MBR
A02B0200C072#MBS
A02B0200C065#TB
A02B0200C065#TBR
A02B0200C065#TBS
A02B0200C065#TFB
A02B0200C065#TFBR
A02B0200C065#TFBS
A02B0120C065#MB
A02B0200C065#MBR
A02B0200C065#MBS
9.5 LCD/MDI
horizontal
A02B0120C072#MB
nc
MB
TB
TB With
CAPII
CAP II
TB
A02B0200C066#TB
A02B0200C066#TBR
9.5 LCD/MDI
vertical
.c
MB
A02B0200C066#TBS
w
w
8.4 separate
type LCD unit
color
A02B0200C066#TFBR
A02B0200C066#TFBS
A02B0120C066#MB
B
B
A02B0200C066#MBS
MB
A02B0200C066#TFB
A02B0200C066#MBR
TB With
CAPII
CAP II
A02B0200C051
A61L00010093
Usable unit
A02B0120C041#TA,#MA
A02B0120C051#TA,#MA
A02B0120C111
485
For
system
without
MMC
IV
C. LIST OF MAINTENANCE
PARTS
APPENDIX
Name
Drawing number
B62445E/03
Compati-
Remarks
bility
For
system
without
MMC
IV
Ra
nk
A61L00010093#A
Usable unit
A02B0120C043#TA
A61L00010095
Usable unit
A02B0120C041#TA,#MA
A02B0120C052#TA,#MA
A02B0120C112
9Iplasma display
A61L00010116
Usable unit
A02B0120C081#TA,#MA
A02B0120C113
14Icolor,CRT display
A61L00010094#A
Usable unit
A02B0120C071#TA,#MA
#TF,#WA
A02B0120C072#TA,#MA
#TF,#MC
A02B0120C074#TA,#TF
A61L00010138
Usable unit
A02B0200C061#TB,#TFB
#MB
A02B0200C062#TB,#TFB
#MB
A02B0200C065#TB,#TFB
#MB
A02B0200C066#TB,#TFB
#MB
A61L00010139
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
.c
nc
Usable unit
A02B0200C050
A02B0200C051
486
It is not
relative
whether with
MMC
IV or
not
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
BOOT SYSTEM
D.1OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 488
om
PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 490
D.3ERROR MESSAGES AND REQUIRED
.c
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
ACTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 504
487
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
D.1
B62445E/03
The boot system load the CNC system software (flash RAMDRAM),
then starts it so that software can be executed.
The boot system provides the following maintenance functions for the
CNC:
OVERVIEW
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
This manual describes the activation of the boot system, as well as the
screen displays and operation for the functions listed above.
.c
nc
D.1.1
Hold down the two keys until the boot system screen appears.
2 When the flash memory does not contain a file required to start the
CNC
Immediately after the CNC is turned on, the boot system starts
transferring files from flash memory to DRAM. If, for some reason,
a file required to start the CNC (NC basic) is not in flash memory or
has been destroyed, the boot system is automatically started.
488
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
D.1.2
System Files and User
Files
The boot system organizes files in flash memory into two main groups :
system files and user files. These two file types have the following
characteristics :
CNC and servo control software provided by FANUC
D User files
D.1.3
When the CNC includes OPT2 board or LCB, we have to access to flash
memory or SRAM that mounted on additional board. So, the boot system
displays BOOT SLOT CONFIGURATION screen that to select a access
board.
r.c
Boot Slot
Configuration Screen
om
D System files
D Screen configuration
(2)
NO.
0.
1.
2.
3.
60M102
ce
nt
e
(1)
nc
BOARD
MAIN
OPT2
OPT3
LCB
SRAM
1.0MB
1.0MB
128KB
512KB
][
DOWN
.c
(3)
FROM
4MB
6MB
Press the [ UP ] or [DOWN] soft key to move the cursor, and select board
to press the [SELECT] soft key.
D Operation
1 : Screen title.
2 : Flash memory size and SRAM size of each board.
3 : Message
489
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
D.2
SCREEN
CONFIGURATION
AND OPERATING
PROCEDURE
B62445E/03
When the boot system is first started, the MAIN MENU screen is
displayed. This screen is described below :
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
60M1-01
r.c
om
(1)
(9)
ce
nt
e
9. END
(10
)
][
DOWN
nc
1 : Screen title. The series and edition of the boot system appear at
the right end.
2 : Function for writing data to flash memory.
3 : Function for checing the edition of a file in ROM.
4 : Function for deleting a file from flash memory.
5 : Function for making a backup copy of the data stored on the memory
card.
.c
6 :
7 :
8 :
9 :
10 :
D Operating procedure
Press the [UP] or [DOWN] soft key to select the desired function. After
positioning the cursor to the desired function, press the [SELECT] soft
key. Before executing a function, the system my request confirmation
from the operator by having him/her press the [YES] or [NO] soft key.
D Basic operation
Position the
cursor.
NUPO
NDOWNO
Select a
function
NSELECTO
Return to
original state
490
Check the
selection
NYESO
NNOO
Execute
the
Select END
function
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
D.2.1
System Data Loading
Screen
D Description
This screen is used to read a system or user file from a memory card into
flash memory.
(2)
FILE DIRECTORY
D101E10. ROM
D101E11. ROM
END
ce
nt
e
(3)
1/1
r.c
(1)
om
D Screen configuration
(4)
][
DOWN
1 : Screen title. The page number (n) and total number of pages (m)
are displayed, in n/m format, at the right end.
nc
.c
4 : Message
D Operating procedure
1 Position the cursor to the file to be read from the memory card and
written to flash memory. Then, press the [SELECT] soft key.
A single page can list up to eight file names. If the memory card
contains nine or more files, the remaining files are displayed on
another page.
To display the next page, press the
To display the previous page, press the
is displayed on the last page.
soft key.
soft key. The END option
491
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
3 To start loading, press the [YES] soft key. To cancel, press the [NO]
key.
*** MESSAGE ***
LOADING FROM MEMORY CARD.
om
D Others
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
Note
that these file names may be changed without notice.
File name
NC BASIC
DG SERVO
GRAPHIC
NCj OPTN
PMCj****
PCD ****
CEX ****
PMC - ****
PMC@****
Contents
Basic
Servo
Graphic
Optional
PMC control software, etc.
PCODE macro file/ OMM
Clanguage executor
Ladder software
Ladder software for the loader
File type
System file
System file
System file
System file
System file
User file
User file
User file
User file
D.2.2
System Data Check
Screen
492
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
D Description
This screen is used to list files in flash memory, together with the
corresponding numbers of 128KB management units in each file and the
series and edition of the software.
D Screen configuration
(4)
ce
nt
e
(5)
1/1
om
(3)
r.c
(1)
(2)
][
DOWN
.c
nc
1 : Screen title
2 : Names of accessing board
3 : Names of files in flash memory The number of management units
constituting each file appears in parentheses to the right of the file
name.
4 : Returning to the previous menu
5 : Message
493
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
D Operating procedure
801B
802B
841B
842B
881B
882B
8C1B
8C2B
000
001
002
003
004
005
006
007
.c
nc
D Others
Internal managementunit
number
ROM number and edition
Sries
r.c
B1A1
B1A1
B1A1
B1A1
B1A1
B1A1
B1A1
B1A1
ce
nt
e
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
om
1 Select the file whose details are required. For example, select 1 NC
BASIC (8).
2 The numbers of management units in the selected file are listed,
together with the series and edition of the software in each
management unit. After checking the listed data, select the
[SELECT] soft key to return to the file selection screen.
494
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
D.2.3
System Data Delete
Screen
D Description
D Screen configuration
(4)
ce
nt
e
(5)
1/1
om
(3)
r.c
(1)
(2)
][
DOWN
nc
1 : Screen title
2 : Names of accessing board
3 : Names of files in flash memory The number of management units
constituting each file appears in parentheses to the right of the file
name.
4 : Returning to the previous menu
5 : Message
1 Position the cursor to the name of the file to be deleted. Press the
[SELECT] soft key.
2 The system displays the following confirmation message :
.c
D Operating procedure
3 To start the deletion, press the [YES] key. To cancel, press [NO].
*** MESSAGE ***
DELETING ROM FILE IN FLASH MEMORY.
495
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
D Others
System files and user files on SYSTEM DATA DELETE screen The
SYSTEM DATA DELETE screen guards against system files being
accidentally deleted by the operator. User files, however, are not
protected. Protected system files can be overwritten from the
SYSTEM DATA LOADING screen.
om
D.2.4
SYSTEM DATA SAVE
Screen
D Description
B62445E/03
r.c
This screen is used to write a user file in flash memory to a memory card.
Only user files can be saved from flash memory to a memory card.
System files cannot be saved.
D Screen configuration
ce
nt
e
(1)
(2)
(3)
nc
(4)
(5)
.c
w
DOWN
1 : Screen title
2 : Names of accessing board
3 : Names of files in flash memory The number of management units
constituting each file appears in parentheses to the right of the file
name.
4 : Returning to the previous menu
5 : Message
][
496
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
D Operating procedure
Position the cursor to the name of the file to be deleted. Press the
[SELECT] soft key.
om
ce
nt
e
r.c
D Others
.c
nc
Memory card
PMCRA
PMCRB
PMC 0.5M
PMC 1.0M
PMC 1.5M
CEX1.0M
CEX 2.0M
PMC_RA. XXX
PMC_RB. XXX
PCD_0.5M.XXX
PCD_10M.XXX
PCD_15M.XXX
CEX_10M.XXX
CEX_20M.XXX
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
D.2.5
SRAM DATA BACKUP
Screen
This screen is used to collectively save and restore parameters, programs,
and other data, retained after the CNC power is turned off, to and from a
memory card.
D Screen configuration
om
D Description
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
:
:
0.5MB (BASIC)
SRAM0_5A. FDB
ce
nt
e
SRAM SIZE
FILE NAME
r.c
(7)
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
Screen title
Names of accessing board
Menu
Returning to the previous menu
Size of SRAM mounted on the CNC
File name
Message
.c
nc
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
498
][
DOWN
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
D Operating procedure
[Backing up data]
1 Select 1. SRAM BACKUP. The following confirmation message is
displayed. Press [YES] to start backup.
*** MESSAGE ***
BACKUP SRAM DATA OK ? HIT YES OR NO.
SRAM SIZE
FILE NAME
: 128K (BASIC)
: SRAM128K. 000
om
2 The name of the file being written to the memory card is displayed in
the FILE NAME: field.
MEMORY CARD
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
499
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
D Others
B62445E/03
Number of
files
SRAM256A.FDB
1.5MB
SRAM0_5A.FDB
1.0MB
SRAM1_0A.FDB
SRAM1_0B.FDB
1.5MB
SRAM1_5A.FDB
SRAM1_5B.FDB
SRAM1_5C.FDB
2.5MB
SRAM2_5A.FDB
SRAM2_5B.FDB
SRAM2_5C.FDB
r.c
256KB
om
SRAM size
SRAM2_5D.FDB
SRAM2_5E.FDB
2 When the OPT2, OPT3, or LCB board is installed in addition to the main
ce
nt
e
board
The backup file for SRAM on the OPT2, OPT3, or LCB board will have the
following extension:
MAIN
OPT2
OPT3
LCB
Extension
FDB
OP2
OP3
LCB
.c
nc
Board
500
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
D.2.6
MEMORY CARD FILE
DELETE Screen
D Description
om
D Screen configuration
(1)
(2)
ce
nt
e
r.c
(3)
1/1
(4)
][
DOWN
nc
1 : Screen title. Tlhe current page number (n) and the total number
of pages (m) are displayed, in n/m format, at the right end.
2 : Files on the memory card
3 : Option for returning to the previous menu
4 : Message
1
Press the [SELECT] key to select the name of the file to be deleted
from the memory card.
.c
D Operating procedure
D Others
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
D.2.7
MEMORY CARD
FORMAT Function
This function is used to format a memory card. Memory cards must be
formatted before they can be used for the first time or before they can be
reused after their data has been destroyed or lost because of, for example,
battery failure.
D Operating procedure
om
D Description
r.c
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
4 When a card has been formatted normally, the system display the
following message.
Press the [SELECT] key.
502
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
D.2.8
LOAD BASIC SYSTEM
Function
The function is used to terminate the boot system and activate the CNC.
D Operating procedure
From the MAIN MENU screen, select 9. END. The system displays
the ARE YOU SURE? HIT YES OR NO message. To terminate the
boot system and activate the CNC, press the [YES] soft key. Pressing
the [NO] key cancels this operation.
*** MESSAGE ***
ARE YOU SURE ? HIT YES OR NO.
YES
][
NO
][
UP
][
DOWN
r.c
[ SELECT ][
om
D Description
ce
nt
e
YES
][
NO
][
UP
][
DOWN
nc
.c
YES
][
NO
][
UP
][
DOWN
If the contents of the NC BASIC SYSTEM file are found to have been
damaged or destroyed, the system returns to the processing selection
state, in exactly the same way as when the [NO] soft key is pressed.
2 If the [NO] soft key is pressed, the system returns to the processing
selection state as shown below :
*** MESSAGE ***
SELECT MENU AND HIT [SELECT] KEY.
[ SELECT ][
503
YES
][
NO
][
UP
][
DOWN
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
D.3
ERROR MESSAGES
AND REQUIRED
ACTIONS
Message
D
B62445E/03
Invalid data has been found in the RAM area. If the RAM was not
cleared after being installed, subsequently attempting backup may
stop the BOOT SYSTEM and cause this message to be output.
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
DELETE ERROR.
HIT SELECT KEY.
There is insufficient free flash memory to store the selected file. Delete any unnecessary files from flash memory.
The flash memory module is not mounted on that CNC system. Put
the flash memory module on the board.
The selected file cannot be read into flash memory. The selected file
or the header information for flash memory may have been damaged
or destroyed.
LOADING ERROR.
HIT SELECT KEY.
.c
nc
504
Message
M
D. BOOT SYSTEM
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
The memory card is full. Delete any unnecessary files from the
memory card. Alternatively, replace the memory card with another
card having sufficient free space.
The memory card could not be accessed. Check that the memory
card is normal.
The memory card is not inserted into its slot. Check that the memory
card is pushed fully home.
Although writing to the memory card was selected, the write inhibit
switch is set. Disable the write inhibit switch.
Access to the memory card has failed. Check whether the memory
card is defective.
It is not possible to delete only specific files from a flash memory card,
due to the characteristics of the memory used. To delete a file it is
necessary to delete all files on the card, by using the FORMAT function.
nc
ce
nt
e
r.c
om
.c
505
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
English key
CAN
ce
nt
e
CANCEL key
POS
POSITION key
PROGRAM key
PROG
OFFSET/
SETTING key
OFFSET
nc
SETTING
CUSTOM key
.c
SYSTEM key
CUSTOM
MESSAGE key
GRAPH key
CNC/MMC key
SYSTEM
MESSAGE
GRAPH
CNC
MMC
SHIFT key
SHIFT
506
Symbolic key
r.c
Name
om
Series 16/18/160/180MODEL B have two types of MDI keypads : English type and Symbolic type.
The table below shows correspondence between English keys and Symbolic keys.
This manual uses English type in the text.
Therefore when a user uses Symbolic type MDI keypads and encounters an English key in the text, please refer
to the correspondence table shown below.
APPENDIX
B62445E/03
Name
English key
ALTER key
ALTER
INSERT key
INSERT
DELETE key
DELETE
PAGE UP key
ce
nt
e
PAGE
om
INPUT
r.c
INPUT key
Symbolic key
PAGE
HELP key
HELP
RESET key
CUSTOM/GRAPH key
nc
RESET
CUSTOM
.c
GRAPH
507
INDEX
B62445E/03
Number
18TB/MB, 97
Alarm display, 27
Alarm history screen, 27
Alarm list, 431
Address, 213
Adjusting reference position, 256
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
Configuration of PCBs, 24
.c
Contents displayed, 54
CRT/MDI unit, 99
i1
INDEX
B62445E/03
I/O cards with power supply (power c) (source type output), 157
om
r.c
ce
nt
e
F
For lathe, 262
Intermachine connection, 99
General of hardware, 91
General of interface, 211
.c
nc
Hardware, 89
Help function, 51
List of operations, 82
Help screen, 19
i2
INDEX
B62445E/03
POSITION screen, 3
Message screen, 19
om
r.c
Related manual, 2
Modules, 164
ce
nt
e
Removing, 172
N
NC state display, 68
nc
O
Offset/setting screen, 13, 15
.c
Operating monitor, 80
Soft key transition triggered by the function key PROG (When the soft
key [BGEDT] is pressed in all modes), 11
i3
INDEX
B62445E/03
Soft key transition triggered by the function key PROG in the EDIT
mode, 6
Soft key transition triggered by the function key PROG in the HNDL,
JOG, or REF mode, 9
Soft key transition triggered by the function key PROG in the MDI
mode, 8
System screen, 16
Soft key transition triggered by the function key PROG in the MEM
mode, 4
Soft key transition triggered by the function key PROG in the TJOG or
THDL mode, 10
T
Table of test points, 263, 284
Soft keys, 2
Specification, 212
Troubleshooting, 294
r.c
om
ce
nt
e
.c
nc
i4
Jan., 95
Nov., 94
Apr., 94
Date
03
02
01
Edition
Contents
Edition
Date
Contents
om
(B62445E)
r.c
ce
nt
e
nc
.c
Revision Record